1. Which of the following cont ain s one funda m e n t a l and one derive d unit? A. amp e r e kilogr a m B. amp e r e coulom b C. joule newt o n D. joule coulom b (Tot al 1 mar k ) 2. The cur r e n t , I, throu g h a resis to r is me a s u r e d with a digital am m e t e r to be 0.10 A. The unce r t ai n t y in the calcul a t e d value of I 2 will be A. 1 %. B. 2 %. C. 5 %. D. 20 %. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 3. A skydive r of mas s 80 kg falls vertic ally with a const a n t spee d of 50 m s –1 . The upw a r d force acting on the skydive r is appr oxi m a t e ly A. 0 N. B. 80 N. C. 800 N. D. 4000 N. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 1 4. Joseph runs along a long str aig h t tra ck. The varia tion of his spe e d v with time t is show n below. After 25 secon d s Josep h has run 200 m. Which of the following is cor r e c t at 25 secon d s ? Ins t a n t a n e o u s sp e e d / m s –1 Aver a g e spe e d / m s –1 A. 8 m s –1 8 m s –1 B. 8 m s –1 10 m s –1 C. 10 m s –1 8 m s –1 D. 10 m s –1 10 m s –1 (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 2 5. A car of mas s 1000 kg accel e r a t e s on a str ai g h t , flat, horizon t a l roa d with an accele r a t i o n a = 0.3 m s –2 . The driving force F on the car is oppos e d by a resis tive force of 500 N. The net (result a n t ) force on the car is A. 200 N. B. 300 N. C. 500 N. D. 800 N. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 3 6. A tennis ball of mas s m moving horizon t a lly with spe e d u strike s a vertic al tenni s racke t. The ball bounc e s back with a horizon t al spe e d v . The mag ni t u d e of the chan g e in mom e n t u m of the ball is A. m (u + v ). B. m (u – v ). C. m (v – u ). D. zero. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 7. A brot h e r and sister take the sam e time to run up a set of step s. The siste r has a grea t e r mas s than her brot h e r . Which of the following is corr e c t ? Has don e the mo s t work Has dev e l o p e d the gre a t e s t pow e r A. brot h e r brot h e r B. brot h e r siste r C. siste r brot h e r D. siste r siste r (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 4 8. A nucle a r power station prod u c e s 10 GW of elect ric al powe r . The powe r gen e r a t e d by the nuclea r reaction s in the core of the rea c t o r is 25 GW. The efficiency of the powe r station is A. 15 %. B. 35 %. C. 40 %. D. 60 %. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 9. A cyclist rides arou n d a circul a r tra ck at a unifor m spe e d. Which of the following corr e c tly gives the net horizont a l force on the cyclist at any given insta n t of time? Net horiz o n t a l forc e alo n g dire c t i o n of mot i o n Ne t horiz o n t a l forc e nor m a l to dire c t i o n of mo t i o n A. zero zero B. zero non zero C. non zero zero D. non zero non zero (Tot al 1 mar k ) 10. A solid piece of tungs t e n melts into liquid withou t a cha n g e in tem p e r a t u r e . Which of the following is corr ec t for the molec ul e s in the liquid pha s e comp a r e d with the molec ul e s in the solid pha s e ? Kin e t i c en e r g y Pot e n t i a l en e r g y A. sam e gre a t e r B. sam e sa m e C. grea t e r gre a t e r D. grea t e r sa m e (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 5 11. What is the mas s of car bo n- 12 tha t cont ai n s the sam e num b e r of atom s as 14 g of silicon- 28? A. 6 g B. 12 g C. 14 g D. 24 g (Tot al 1 mar k ) 12. A heat e r of const a n t powe r heat s a liquid of mass m and specific hea t capacity c . The grap h below shows how the tem p e r a t u r e of the liquid varies with time. The gra di e n t of the gra p h is k and no ene r gy is lost to the surr o u n d i n g s . What is the powe r of the heat e r ? A. km c B. k mc C. mc k D. 1 km c (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 6 13. A tran sv e r s e wave travels from left to right. The diagr a m below show s how, at a particul a r insta n t of time, the displa c e m e n t of particle s in the medi u m varies with position. Which arrow rep r e s e n t s the direc tion of the velocity of the particle mar k e d P? (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 7 14. The gra p h shows how the displa c e m e n t varies with time for an objec t unde r g oi n g simple har m o ni c motion. Which gra p h shows how the object’s accel e r a ti o n a varies with time t ? (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 8 15. Light travels from air into glass as show n below. What is the refr ac tive index of glas s? A. s in P s in S B. s inQ s in R C. s in P s in R D. s inQ s in S (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 9 16. Which of the following elect r o m a g n e t i c waves has a freq u e n c y gr e a t e r than that of visible light? A. Ultraviolet B. Radio C. Microw av e s D. Infra r e d (Tot al 1 mar k ) 17. One elect r o nv olt is equ al to A. 1.6 × 10 –19 C. B. 1.6 × 10 –19 J. C. 1.6 × 10 –19 V. D. 1.6 × 10 –19 W. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 10 18. A batt e r y of inter n al resis t a n c e 2 Ω is conn e c t e d to an exte r n a l resist a n c e of 10 Ω. The cur r e n t is 0.5 A. What is the emf of the bat t e r y? A. 1.0 V B. 5.0 V C. 6.0 V D. 24.0 V (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 11 19. In the circuit below, which of the following will caus e the gre a t e s t incr e a s e in the readi n g of the voltm e t e r ? A. An incr e a s e in tem p e r a t u r e B. An incr e a s e in light inten sity C. A decr e a s e in tem p e r a t u r e D. A decr e a s e in light intensi ty (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 12 20. A sphe ric al plan e t of unifor m density has thr e e time s the mas s of the Eart h and twice the aver a g e radius. The mag nit u d e of the gravit a tio n al field str e n g t h at the surface of the Eart h is g . What is the gravit a tion al field stre n g t h at the surfa c e of the plane t ? A. 6 g B. 2 g 3 C. 3 g 4 D. 3 g 2 (Tot al 1 mar k ) 21. An elect r o n pass e s the nort h pole of a bar mag n e t as show n below. What is the direction of the ma g n e t i c forc e on the elect r o n ? A. Into the pag e B. Out of the page C. To the left D. To the right (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 13 22. Which of the following gives the corr e c t num b e r of proton s and neut r o n s in 14 a nucleu s of car bo n- 14 ( 6 C )? Prot o n s Ne u t r o n s A. 8 6 B. 6 8 C. 14 6 D. 6 14 (Tot al 1 mar k ) 23. A fres hly prep a r e d sam pl e cont ain s 4.0 μg of iodine- 131. After 24 days, 0. 5 μg of iodine- 131 rem ai n. The best estim a t e of the half- life of iodine- 131 is A. 8 days. B. 12 days. C. 24 days. D. 72 days. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 24. Which of the following caus e s the gre a t e s t num b e r of ioniza tion s as it pass e s throu g h 1 cm of air? (The total ener gy of the ionizing radia tio n is the sam e .) A. An alpha particle B. A bet a particle C. A gam m a- ray D. An X-ray (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 14 25. What is the pheno m e n o n that best explains why gre e n h o u s e gas e s absor b infrar e d radiation? A. Reson a n c e B. Interf e r e n c e C. Refrac tion D. Diffractio n (Tot al 1 mar k ) 26. In which of the following places will the albe do be gre a t e s t ? A. A forest B. A gras sl a n d C. An ocea n D. A polar ice cap (Tot al 1 mar k ) 27. A wind tur bin e produ c e s a powe r P whe n the wind spe e d is v . Assumin g that the efficiency of the turbi n e is const a n t , the best estim a t e for the powe r prod u c e d when the wind spe e d beco m e s 2 v is A. 2 P. B. 4 P. C. 6 P. D. 8 P. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 15 28. A sphe ric al black body has absolut e tem p e r a t u r e T 1 . The sur r o u n di n g s are kept at a lower absolut e tem p e r a t u r e T 2 . What is the net powe r per unit are a lost by the body? A. σT 1 4 B. σT 2 4 C. σ( T 1 4 – T 2 4 ) D. σ( T 1 4 + T 2 4 ) (Tot al 1 mar k ) 29. The desig n of a nuclea r powe r station includ e s an elect ric a l gen e r a t o r . The function of the gene r a t o r is to conve r t A. nuclea r ener gy to kinetic ene r gy. B. kinetic ener gy to ther m al ene r gy. C. ther m al ener gy to elect ric a l ene r gy. D. kinetic ener gy to elect ric al ene r gy. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 30. What is the unit of surfac e heat capa city? A. J kg –1 K–1 B. J K –1 C. J m –2 K–1 D. J m –3 K–1 (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 16 31. Data analysis ques tion. The photog r a p h below shows a mag nifie d imag e of a dark cent r a l disc sur r o u n d e d by conce n t r i c dark rings. These rings wer e prod u c e d as a res ult of interfe r e n c e of monoc h r o m a t i c light. The gra p h below shows how the ring diam e t e r D varies with the ring num b e r n. The inner m o s t ring corr e s p o n d s to n = 1. The corr e s p o n d i n g dia m e t e r is labelled in the photo g r a p h . Erro r bars for the diam e t e r D are show n. IB Questionbank Physics 17 (a) Stat e on e piece of eviden c e tha t shows that D is not propo r tio n a l to n . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (b) On the gra p h above, draw the line of bes t- fit for the data points. (2) (c) Theory sugg e s t s that D 2 = kn . A grap h of D 2 agains t n is show n below. Error bar s are show n for the first and last data points only. IB Questionbank Physics 18 (i) Using the first grap h, calcul a t e the perc e n t a g e unc e r t a i n t y in D 2 , of the ring n = 7. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) Based on the secon d gra p h, stat e on e piec e of evide nc e that suppo r t s the relation s hi p D 2 = kn . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (iii) Use the secon d grap h to dete r m i n e the value of the cons t a n t k, as well as its unce r t a i n t y. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 19 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (4) IB Questionbank Physics 20 (iv) Stat e the unit for the const a n t k . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (Tot al 11 mark s ) 32. This ques tion is abou t motion in a ma gn e t i c field. An elect r o n, that has been accele r a t e d from rest by a pote n ti al differ e n c e of 250 V, ent e r s a region of ma gn e t i c field of stre n g t h 0.12 T that is direct e d into the plane of the pag e. (a) The elect r o n’s path while in the region of mag n e ti c field is a qua r t e r circle. Show that the (i) spee d of the elect r o n afte r accele r a t i o n is 9.4 × 10 6 m s –1 . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 21 ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 22 (ii) radi us of the pat h is 4.5 × 10 –4 m. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (b) The diagr a m below shows the mom e n t u m of the elect r o n as it ent e r s and leaves the region of ma gn e t i c field. The mag ni t u d e of the initial mom e n t u m and of the final mom e n t u m is 8.6 × 10 –24 N s. (i) On the diagr a m above, draw an arro w to indica t e the vector repr e s e n t i n g the cha n g e in the mom e n t u m of the elect r o n . (1) (ii) Show that the magni t u d e of the cha n g e in the mom e n t u m of the elect r o n is 1.2 × 10 –23 Ns. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 23 (1) IB Questionbank Physics 24 (iii) The time the elect r o n spe n d s in the region of mag n e ti c field is 7.4 × 10 –11 s. Estim a t e the magni t u d e of the aver a g e force on the elect r o n . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (Tota l 7 mark s ) 33. This ques tion is abou t circula r motion. A ball of mas s 0.25 kg is attac h e d to a string and is ma d e to rota t e with cons t a n t spee d v along a horizon t al circle of radius r = 0.33 m. The string is att ac h e d to the ceiling and make s an angle of 30° with the vertical. (a) (i) On the diagr a m above, draw and label arrow s to repr e s e n t the forces on the ball in the position show n. (2) (ii) Stat e and explain whet h e r the ball is in equilibri u m . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 25 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (b) Deter m i n e the spee d of rota tio n of the ball. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tota l 7 mark s ) 34. This ques tion is abou t a nuclea r rea c t o r . (a) Uraniu m is used as a fuel in a small res e a r c h nucle a r rea c t o r. The 235 conce n t r a t i o n of 9 2 U in a sam pl e of ura ni u m mus t be incr e a s e d befor e it can be used as a fuel. Stat e the nam e of the proc e s s by which the conc e n t r a t i o n of incr e a s e d . 235 92 U is ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (b) The reac t o r produ c e s 24 MW of powe r. The efficiency of the reac t o r is 32 %. In the fission of one ura ni u m- 235 nucle u s 3.2 × 10 –11 J of ene r gy is relea s e d . Deter m i n e the mass of ura ni u m- 235 that unde r g o e s fission in one year in this react o r . IB Questionbank Physics 26 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (4) (c) Explain what would happ e n if the mode r a t o r of this reac t o r wer e to be rem ove d. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (d) During its nor m al oper a tio n, the following set of reac tio n s take s plac e in the reac t o r . 1 0n 29328U 239 92U 239 9 2U (I) 239 0 9 3N p –1 e v (II) 239 239 0 9 3 N p 9 4P u –1e v IB Questionbank Physics (III) 27 (i) Stat e the nam e of the proc e s s repr e s e n t e d by reac tio n (II). ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Com m e n t on the inte r n a t i o n a l implic atio n s of the prod u c t of thes e reac tion s . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tot al 11 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 28 35. This ques tion is abou t simple har m o ni c oscillations . A longit u di n al wave travels throu g h a mediu m from left to right. Grap h 1 show s the variation with time t of the displa c e m e n t x of a particle P in the mediu m . Grap h 1 (a) For par ticle P, (i) stat e how gra p h 1 shows that its oscillation s are not dam p e d . ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) calcula t e the mag nit u d e of its maxim u m accele r a ti o n. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 29 (2) IB Questionbank Physics 30 (iii) calcula t e its speed at t = 0.12 s. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (iv) stat e its directio n of motion at t = 0.12 s. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (b) Grap h 2 shows the variatio n with position d of the displa c e m e n t x of particl es in the mediu m at a partic ul a r insta n t of time. Grap h 2 Deter m i n e for the longit u di n a l wave, using gra p h 1 and gra p h 2, IB Questionbank Physics 31 (i) the frequ e n cy. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) the spee d. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) Grap h 2 – repr o d u c e d to assist with answ e ri n g (c)(i). (c) The diagr a m shows the equilibriu m positions of six par ticle s in the medi u m . IB Questionbank Physics 32 (i) On the diagr a m above, draw cros s e s to indic at e the positions of thes e six particle s at the insta n t of time whe n the displa c e m e n t is given by grap h 2. (3) (ii) On the diagr a m above, label with the lette r C a par ticl e that is at the cent r e of a com p r e s s i o n. (1) (Tot al 14 mark s ) 36. This ques tion is abou t mech a ni c s and the r m a l physic s. The gra p h shows the variation with time t of the spe e d v of a ball of mas s 0.50 kg, that has been relea s e d from rest above the Eart h’s surfa c e . The force of air resist a n c e is not negligible. Assum e that the accel e r a t io n of free fall is g = 9.81 m s –2 . (a) Stat e, witho u t any calcula tion s , how the gra p h could be use d to dete r m i n e the dista n c e fallen. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 33 (b) (i) In the spac e below, dra w and label arrow s to rep r e s e n t the forces on the ball at 2.0 s. (1) (ii) Use the grap h opposit e to show that the accel e r a t io n of the ball at 2.0 s is appr oxi m a t e ly 4 m s –2 . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (iii) Calculat e the magni t u d e of the force of air resis t a n c e on the ball at 2.0 s. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 34 (iv) Stat e and explain whet h e r the air resist a n c e on the ball at t = 5.0 s is smaller than, equal to or gre a t e r tha n the air resist a n c e at t = 2.0 s. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (c) After 10 s the ball has fallen 190 m. (i) Show that the sum of the pot e n ti al and kinetic ene r gi e s of the ball has decr e a s e d by 780 J. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (ii) The specific heat capa city of the ball is 480 J kg –1 K–1 . Estim a t e the incr e a s e in the tem p e r a t u r e of the ball. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... IB Questionbank Physics 35 .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 36 (iii) Stat e an assu m p t i o n mad e in the esti m a t e in (c)(ii). ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (Tot al 14 mark s ) 37. This ques tion is abou t nuclea r physics. (a) (i) Define bindin g ener g y of a nucle u s. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) 239 The mas s of a nucle u s of plutoniu m ( 9 4 P u ) is 238.99 0 3 9 6 u. Deduc e that the bindin g ene r gy per nucle on for pluto ni u m is 7.6 MeV. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) IB Questionbank Physics 37 (b) The grap h shows the variatio n with nucle on num b e r A of the bindin g ener gy per nucleon. 239 Plutoni u m ( 9 4 P u ) und e r g o e s nucle a r fission accor di n g to the rea c tion given below. 239 1 9 4P u 0 n (i) 91 146 1 3 8S r 5 6Ba x 0 n Calculat e the num b e r x of neut r o n s prod u c e d . ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Use the grap h to estim a t e the ene r gy rele a s e d in this rea c tion. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 38 ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 39 (c) Stable nuclei with a mass num b e r gre a t e r tha n about 20, cont ai n mor e neut r o n s than proton s . By refe r e n c e to the prope r ti e s of the nucle a r force and of the elect r o s t a t i c force, sugg e s t an explan a ti o n for this obse rv a tio n. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (4) (Tot al 11 mark s ) 38. This ques tion is abou t elect ri c circ uit s. (a) Define (i) electro m o ti v e force (emf ) of a batt e r y. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) electrical resista n c e of a condu c t o r . ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 40 ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 41 (b) A batt e r y of emf ε and negligibl e inter n al resist a n c e is conne c t e d in series to two resisto r s . The cur r e n t in the circuit is I. (i) Stat e an equa tio n giving the total powe r delive r e d by the batt e r y. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) The poten ti al differ e n c e acros s resisto r R 1 is V 1 and that acros s resis to r R 2 is V 2 . Using the law of the cons e rv a tio n of ene r gy, ded uc e the equ a tio n below. ε = V1 + V2 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 42 (c) The grap h shows the I-V cha r a c t e r i s ti c s of two cond uc t o r s , X and Y. On the axes below, sketc h gra p h s to show the variatio n with pote n ti al differ e n c e V of the resist a n c e of cond u c t o r X (label this gra p h X) and cond u c t o r Y (label this gra p h Y). You do not nee d to put any num b e r s on the vertical axis. (3) IB Questionbank Physics 43 (d) The condu c t o r s in (c) are conn e c t e d in serie s to a batt e r y of emf ε and negligible inter n al resis t a n c e . The powe r dissip a t e d in eac h of the two resisto r s is the sam e . Using the grap h given in (c), (i) det e r m i n e the emf of the batt e r y. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) calcula t e the total powe r dissipa t e d in the circ uit. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tot al 12 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 44 39. This ques tion is abou t the ene r gy bala nc e of the Ear t h. (a) The inten sity of the Sun’s radia tio n at the position of the Eart h is appr oxi m a t ely 1400 W m –2 . Sugg e s t why the aver a g e powe r receive d per unit are a of the Eart h is 350 W m –2 . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) The diagr a m shows a simplifie d model of the ene r gy bala nc e of the Eart h’s surfac e. The diagr a m shows radi ation ent e ri n g or leaving the Eart h’s surfa c e only. The aver a g e equilibri u m tem p e r a t u r e of the Ear t h’s surfa c e is T E and that of the atmo s p h e r e is T A = 242 K. (i) Using the data from the diagr a m , stat e the emissivity of the atm os p h e r e . ......................................................................................................... IB Questionbank Physics 45 .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 46 (ii) Show that the intensity of the radia tio n radia t e d by the atm os p h e r e towar d s the Eart h’s surfa c e is 136 W m –2 . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (iii) By refer e n c e to the ene r gy bala n c e of the Eart h’s surfa c e , calcula t e T E . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (c) (i) Outline a mec h a ni s m by which part of the radia tion radi at e d by the Eart h’s surfa c e is abso r b e d by gre e n h o u s e gas e s in the atm os p h e r e . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 47 (3) (ii) Sugg e s t why the incomi n g solar radia tio n is not affect e d by the mech a ni s m you outline d in (c)(i). ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (iii) Carbo n dioxide (CO 2 ) is a gre e n h o u s e gas. Stat e on e sour c e and on e sink (object that re move s CO 2 ) of this gas. Sourc e: ............................................................................................ .................. Sink: ................................................................................................ .................. (2) (Tot al 13 mark s ) 40. This ques tion is abou t stan di n g (station a r y) wave s. (a) Descri b e two ways that sta n di n g waves are differ e n t from travelling waves. 1. ............................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... 2. ............................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) An expe ri m e n t is car ri e d out to mea s u r e the spe e d of sound in air, IB Questionbank Physics 48 using the appa r a t u s show n below. A tube that is open at both ends is plac e d vertic ally in a tank of wate r , until the top of the tube is just at the surfa c e of the wate r . A tunin g fork of freq u e n cy 440 Hz is soun d e d above the tube. The tube is slowly rais e d out of the wat e r until the loudn e s s of the soun d reac h e s a maxim u m for the first time, due to the form a tio n of a sta n di n g wave. IB Questionbank Physics 49 (i) Explain the form a tio n of a sta n di n g wave in the tube. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) Stat e the position in the tube tha t is always a node. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (iii) The tube is raise d a little furt h e r . Explain why the loudn e s s of the soun d is no longe r at a maxim u m . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) IB Questionbank Physics 50 (c) The tube is rais e d until the loudn e s s of the soun d rea c h e s a maxim u m for a secon d time. Betwe e n the two positions of maxim u m loudn e s s , the tube has bee n raise d by 36.8 cm. The frequ e n c y of the sound is 440 Hz. Estim a t e the spee d of sound in air. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tot al 10 mark s ) 41. This ques tion is abou t the Dopple r effect. The sound emitt e d by a car’s hor n has frequ e n c y f, as me a s u r e d by the driver. An observ e r moves towa r d s the station a r y car at const a n t spe e d and meas u r e s the frequ e n c y of the soun d to be f ′. (a) Explain, using a diagr a m , any differ e n c e betw e e n f ′ and f. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 51 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 52 (b) The frequ e n c y f is 3.00 × 10 2 Hz. An obse rv e r moves towa r d s the station a r y car at a const a n t spe e d of 15.0 m s –1 . Calcula t e the obse rv e d frequ e n cy f ′ of the sound. The spee d of soun d in air is 3.30 ×1 0 2 m s –1 . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 5 mark s ) 42. This ques tion is abou t optical resolution and accom m o d a t i o n. A woma n is walking along a straig h t pat h, which is at right angl es to a telep h o n e line, as show n in the diagr a m below. Two birds are perc h e d on the line, 0.40 m apar t. (diagra m not to scale) The diam e t e r of the pupil of the wom a n’s eye is 2.5 mm and the aver a g e wavele n g t h of visible light is 550 nm. (a) Use the Rayleigh criterion to estim a t e the dista n c e D at which the wom a n will just be able to see two sepa r a t e birds. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 53 ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (b) The wom a n looks down at her watc h and is able to focus on it clea rly. Explain how her eyes are able to focus on nea r object s as well as far object s. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 5 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 54 43. This ques tion is abou t the photo el e c t r i c effect. In an experi m e n t to inves tig a t e the photoel e c t ri c effect, light of freq u e n c y f is inciden t on the met al surface A, show n in the diagr a m below. A pote n t i al differ e n c e is applied betw e e n A and B. The photoel e c t ri c cur r e n t is meas u r e d by a sensitive am m e t e r . (Note: the comple t e elect ric al circ uit is not show n.) When the frequ e n cy of the light is reduc e d to a cert ai n value, the cur r e n t meas u r e d by the am m e t e r beco m e s zero. Explain how Einst ei n’s photo el e c t r i c theo ry accou n t s for this obse rv a ti o n. ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... (Tota l 4 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 55 44. This ques tion is abou t atomic spec t r a . Diagr a m 1 shows some of the ene r gy levels of the hydrog e n atom. Diagr a m 2 is a rep r e s e n t a t i o n of part of the emission spec t r u m of atomic hydrog e n . The lines show n rep r e s e n t tran si tion s involving the –3.40 eV level. (a) Deduc e that the ene r gy of a photon of wavel e n g t h 658 nm is 1.89 eV. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 56 (b) (i) On dia g r a m 1 , dra w an arrow to show the elect r o n tran si tion bet w e e n ene r gy levels that gives rise to the emission of a photon of wavelen g t h 658 nm. Label this arro w with the lette r A. (1) (ii) On dia g r a m 1 , draw arrow s to show the elect r o n tra n si tion s betw e e n ene r gy levels that give rise to the emis sion of photo n s of wavele n g t h s 488 nm, 435 nm and 411 nm. Label thes e arro w s with the lette r s B, C and D. (1) (c) Explain why the lines in the emission spe ct r u m of atomic hydro g e n , show n in dia g r a m 2 , beco m e close r toge t h e r as the wavele n g t h of the emitt e d photo n s decr e a s e s . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tota l 8 mark s ) 45. This ques tion is abou t radioa ctive dec ay. Iodine- 124 (I-124) is an uns t a bl e radioisot o p e with proton num b e r 53. It unde r g o e s bet a plus decay to form an isotop e of telluriu m (Te). (a) Stat e the reaction for the dec ay of the I-124 nuclide. ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 57 (b) The grap h below show s how the activity of a sam pl e of iodine- 124 chan g e s with time. (i) Stat e the half- life of iodine- 124 ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Calculat e the activity of the sam pl e at 21 days. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 58 (3) IB Questionbank Physics 59 (iii) A sam pl e of an unkno w n radioisoto p e has a half- life twice tha t of iodine- 124 and the sam e initial activity as the sam pl e of iodine124. On the axes opposit e , dra w a gra p h to show how the activity of the sam pl e would cha n g e with time. Label this grap h X. (1) (iv) A secon d sam pl e of iodine- 124 has half the initial activity as the origin al sam pl e of iodine- 124. On the axes opposit e, dra w a grap h to show how the activity of this sam pl e would cha n g e with time. Label this grap h Y. (1) (Tota l 8 mark s ) 46. This ques tion is abou t analog u e and digital stor a g e . As part of a physics lesson, Isobel and Claire eac h make an audio recor di n g of their teac h e r . They then comp a r e the quality of their recor di n g s . Isobel’s reco r di n g is in analog u e form a t whe r e a s Claire’s recor di n g is digital and stor e d on a CD. (a) Stat e on e possible analog u e met h o d of stor a g e use d by Isobel. ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (b) The first time the reco r di n g s are playe d, their qualitie s are identic al. Outline whet h e r the quality of eac h recor di n g is expe c t e d to rem a i n the sam e after many uses. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 60 (c) Use the following infor m a ti o n to dete r m i n e the num b e r of bits use d in Clair e’s digit al recor di n g. Total time of recor di n g = 30 minut e s Sam plin g freq u e n c y = 40 kHz For m a t of recor di n g = Ste r e o (2 cha n n e l s ) Num b e r of bits per sam pl e = 16 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 5 mark s ) 47. This ques tion is abou t char g e- couple d device s (CCDs). An imag e of the surfac e of the Eart h is recor d e d by a digital cam e r a from an aero pl a n e. Each imag e cover s 144 km 2 of the Eart h’s surfa c e and is reco r d e d by a squa r e CCD of are a 36 cm 2 . (a) Calcula t e the mag nifica tio n of the syste m . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) The CCD cont ai n s 1.0 × 10 8 pixels. Deduc e the minim u m dista n c e betw e e n two points on Eart h that can be resolve d by this cam e r a . ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 61 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 62 (c) It is propos e d to improve the qua n t u m efficiency of the CCD. Sta t e the effect, if any, on the resolution of the syst e m . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (Tota l 5 mark s ) 48. This ques tion is abou t a Schmit t trigg e r . The diagr a m below show s a Sch mit t trigg e r circ uit bas e d on an oper a t io n a l amplifie r (op- amp). The outpu t of this Schmit t trigg e r is positive satu r a ti o n (+13 V) or nega tive satu r a ti o n (–13 V). (a) Stat e two prop e r t i e s of an ideal op- amp. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 63 (b) Deter m i n e the input value tha t will caus e the outpu t to switc h from – 13 V to +1 3 V. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (c) Explain how a Schmit t trigg e r can be use d to res h a p e a digital puls e. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tota l 8 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 64 49. This ques tion is abou t a mobile phon e netwo r k. Erin is a pass e n g e r on a train making a call to a sta n d a r d fixed telep h o n e line (“landline”) from her mobile phon e. The train move s Erin betw e e n adjac e n t com m u ni c a t io n cells. Outline the cha n g e s , if any, tha t take place in the (a) cellular excha n g e . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (b) public switch e d telep h o n e netwo r k (PSTN). ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (Tota l 2 mark s ) 50. This ques tion is abou t lengt h contr a c ti o n and simult a n e i ty. (a) Define proper lengt h. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (b) A space s hi p is travelling to the right at spe e d 0.75 c, thro u g h a tunn el which is open at both ends. Obse rv e r A is sta n di n g at the cent r e of one side of the tunn el. Obse rv e r A, for whom the tunn el is at rest, mea s u r e s the lengt h of the tunn el to be 240 m and the lengt h of the space s hi p to be 200 m. The diag r a m below shows this situa tion from the pers p e c t ive of obse rv e r A. IB Questionbank Physics 65 Observ e r B, for whom the spac e s hi p is station a r y, is sta n di n g at the cent r e of the spac e s hi p. (i) Calculat e the Lorent z factor, γ, for this situa tion. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Calculat e the lengt h of the tunn el accor di n g to obs e rv e r B. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (iii) Calculat e the lengt h of the spa c e s hi p accor di n g to obse rv e r B. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (iv) Accor din g to obse rv e r A, the spa c e s hi p is compl e t e ly inside the tunn el for a shor t time. Sta t e and explain whet h e r or not, accor di n g to obs erv e r B, the spac e s hi p is eve r compl e t ely inside the tunn el. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 66 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 67 (c) Two sour ce s of light are locat e d at eac h end of the tunn el. The diagr a m below show s this situa tion from the pers p e c tiv e of obse rv e r A. Accordi n g to observ e r A, at the insta n t whe n obse rv e r B pas s e s obse rv e r A, the two sour c e s of light emit a flash. Obse rv e r A see s the two flashe s simult a n e o u s ly. Discus s whet h e r or not obse r v e r B sees the two flashe s simult a n e o u s ly. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (4) (Tot al 10 mark s ) 51. This ques tion is abou t meso n s . (a) Stat e what is mea n t by an exch a n g e par ticle. IB Questionbank Physics 68 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 69 (b) In 1935, the physicist Hide ki Yukawa pre dic t e d that the stron g inter a c ti o n betw e e n nucleon s was medi a t e d by particle s calle d meson s . Given that the rang e of the stron g inte r a c t io n is appr oxi m a t ely 1.5 × 10 –15 m, calcula t e a possible value for the res t mas s of a meso n. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (c) A meson called the pion was det e c t e d in cosmic ray reac tio n s in 1947 by Powell and Occhialini. The pion com e s in thr e e possible cha r g e stat e s: π + , π – and π 0 The Feyn m a n diagr a m below rep r e s e n t s a possible reac tion in which a pion particip a t e s . Stat e and explain whet h e r the meso n prod u c e d is a π + , π – or a π 0 . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 70 (d) Stat e the possible spin num b e r s of meso n s and explain your answ e r . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (e) Explain why, accor di n g to the qua r k model, it is not possible for a particl e to consist of two up qua r k s only. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tot al 10 mark s ) 52. A particle of mas s m is moving with const a n t spee d v in unifor m circul a r motion. What is the total work done by the cent ri p e t a l force during one revolutio n? A. Zero B. m v2 2 C. mv 2 D. 2π mv 2 (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 71 IB Questionbank Physics 72 53. Which of the following is equivale n t to the principl e of ene r gy cons e r v a t i o n? A. Newt o n’s first law B. The first law of ther m o dy n a m i c s C. Newt o n’s secon d law D. The secon d law of ther m o d y n a m i c s (Tot al 1 mar k ) 54. An ideal gas und e r g o e s the the r m o d y n a m i c cha n g e s rep r e s e n t e d in the P – V diagr a m below (P → Q → R → P). Volume / m 3 Which of the following is the net work done by the gas in a cycle? A. 4.5 × 10 5 J B. 3.0 × 10 5 J C. 1.0 × 10 5 J D. Zero (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 73 55. Light travels from air into glass as show n below. The refr ac tive index of the glas s is A. s in3 0 s in8 0 B. s in8 0 s in3 0 C. s in6 0 s in1 0 D. s in1 0 s in6 0 (Tot al 1 mar k ) 56. The funda m e n t a l (first har m o nic) frequ e n c y for a partic ul a r orga n pipe is 330 Hz. The pipe is close d at one end but open at the othe r . What is the frequ e n c y of its secon d har m o ni c ? A. 110 Hz B. 165 Hz C. 660 Hz D. 990 Hz (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 74 57. Light is diffract e d at a single slit. Which of the following gra p h s best repr e s e n t s how the inten sity I of the diffrac t e d light varies with the diffractio n angle θ? A. B. C. IB Questionbank Physics 75 D. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 58. Light of wavele n g t h λ is emitt e d by two point sour c e s . The light pass e s thro u g h a circul a r ape r t u r e of diam e t e r b and is rec eive d by an obse rv e r . The angul a r sep a r a t i o n of the sour c e s from the obse r v e r’ s position is θ. The sour c e s are not resolve d by the obse rv e r . Which of the following mat h e m a t i c al relation s hi p s applie s? A. λ θ < 1.22 b B. λ θ > 1.22 b C. λ θ = 1.22 b D. λ θ = b (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 76 59. Plane- polarize d light is incide n t nor m ally on a polariz e r which is able to rota t e in the plane per p e n di c ul a r to the light as show n below. In diagr a m 1, the intensity of the incide n t light is 8 W m –2 and the tran s mi t t e d inten si ty of light is 2 W m –2 . Diagr a m 2 show s the polariz e r rota t e d 90° from the orient a t io n in diagr a m 1. What is the new tra n s m i t t e d inten si ty? A. 0 W m –2 B. 2 W m –2 C. 6 W m –2 D. 8 W m –3 (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 77 60. A light- dep e n d e n t resis to r (LDR) and a fixed resisto r are conne c t e d in the poten ti al divider circuit show n below. The voltm e t e r read s 3.0 V. Which of the following chan g e s would caus e the readi n g on the voltm et e r to incr e a s e ? A. Swap pi n g the positions of the LDR and the fixed resisto r B. Incr e a si n g the resist a n c e of the fixed resis to r C. Incr e a si n g the amou n t of light shining on the LDR D. Decr e a s i n g the amou n t of light shining on the LDR (Tot al 1 mar k ) 61. A coil of wire has a large num b e r of turn s. It is move d relative to a fixed mag n e ti c field. The emf gen e r a t e d will be equal to the A. rat e of chan g e of magn e t i c flux linka g e . B. rat e of chan g e of the magn e ti c flux throu g h the coil. C. chan g e of mag n e t i c flux linka g e . D. chan g e of the mag n e ti c flux thro u g h the coil. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 78 62. A sinus oid al ac powe r supply has rms voltag e V and supplie s rms cur r e n t I. What is the maxim u m insta n t a n e o u s powe r delive r e d ? A. B. 2 VI 2 VI C. VI D. VI 2 (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 79 63. A positively char g e d par ticle follows a circul a r path as show n below. Which of the following elect ric fields could have caus e d the cha r g e d par ticl e to follow the above pat h? (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 80 64. A stone is throw n from a cliff and it lands in the sea as show n below. Air resis t a n c e is negligible. Which of the following stat e m e n t s is corr e c t whilst the stone is in motion? A. The vertic al compo n e n t of the stone’s displa c e m e n t is const a n t . B. The horizont al compo n e n t of the stone’s displa c e m e n t is const a n t . C. The vertic al compo n e n t of the stone’s velocity is const a n t . D. The horizont al compo n e n t of the stone’s velocity is cons t a n t . (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 81 65. Which of the diag r a m s below bes t rep r e s e n t s the equipot e n t i al surfa c e s arou n d two identical point mas s e s ? (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 82 66. Which of the following grap h s repr e s e n t s how the total ene r gy E of an orbitin g sat ellite varies with orbital radius r? A. B. C. IB Questionbank Physics 83 D. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 67. The diagr a m below show s a circ uit involving a photo el e c t r i c cell. Whe n UV light is shon e onto the met al catho d e , elect r o n s are emitt e d esta blis hi n g a photoc u r r e n t . Which of the following chan g e s could caus e the photoc u r r e n t to stop? A. Incr e a si n g the poten ti al differe n c e of the powe r supply. B. Incr e a si n g the frequ e n c y of the UV light. C. Incr e a si n g the intensity of the UV light. D. Chan gi n g the met al surfac e to one with a smalle r work function. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 84 68. Elect r o n s are accel e r a t e d from rest thro u g h a pote n ti al differ e n c e V . Their de Broglie wavel en g t h is λ. The accel e r a t i n g pote n ti al differ e n c e is incr e a s e d to 2 V . Which of the following gives the new de Broglie wavele n g t h ? A. 2λ 2λ B. λ 2 C. D. λ 2 (Tot al 1 mar k ) 69. Which of the following ene r gy level diag r a m s bes t rep r e s e n t s the kine tic ene r gy E K of the “elect r o n in a box” model, whe r e an elect r o n is confine d to move in one dim en sio n ? The varia bl e n is an inte g e r (1, 2, 3, 4 etc. ). A. B. IB Questionbank Physics 85 C. D. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 70. A proton is confine d within a nucle u s. What is the orde r of ma gni t u d e of the unce r t a i n t y in its mom e n t u m ? A. 10 –30 Ns B. 10 –20 Ns C. 10 –10 Ns D. 1 Ns (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 86 71. Differe n t nuclides spont a n e o u s ly und e r g o radioa c tive dec ay, emittin g eithe r α, β or γ radi ation. Which of the following cor r e c tly identifies all the emission s tha t do not have discr e t e ener gi e s ? A. α B. β C. γ D. α and γ (Tot al 1 mar k ) 72. The half- life of a radioac tive isotop e is 10 days. What is the perc e n t a g e of the sam pl e rem ai ni n g after 25 days? A. 0 % B. 18 % C. 25 % D. 40 % (Tot al 1 mar k ) 73. Which of the following fuels has the highe s t ene r gy density? A. Coal B. Gas C. Oil D. Uraniu m (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 87 74. The decim al num b e r 18 is rep r e s e n t e d in bina ry by a five bit digital num b e r . Which of the following cor r e c tly identifies the least- significa n t bit (LSB) and the most- significan t bit (MSB) of the bina ry num b e r ? LSB MS B A. 0 0 B. 0 1 C. 1 0 D. 1 1 (Tot al 1 mar k ) 75. A CD stor e s digital inform a t io n with a serie s of bum p s (lands) and pits. The dept h of each pit is d . Which of the following is the most appr o p ri a t e wavele n g t h of laser light to recove r the infor m a ti o n? A. d 2 B. d C. 2d D. 4d (Tot al 1 mar k ) 76. Which of the following digital device s is least likely to use a char g e- couple d device (CCD) in its const r u c t io n? A. Fax machin e B. Cam e r a C. Watch D. X-ray machi n e (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 88 77. Data analysis ques tion. The photog r a p h below shows a mag nifie d imag e of a dark cent r a l disc sur r o u n d e d by conce n t r i c dark rings. These rings wer e prod u c e d as a res ult of interfe r e n c e of monoc h r o m a t i c light. The gra p h below shows how the ring diam e t e r D varies with the ring num b e r n. The inner m o s t ring corr e s p o n d s to n = 1. The corr e s p o n d i n g dia m e t e r is labelled in the photo g r a p h . Erro r bars for the diam e t e r D are show n. IB Questionbank Physics 89 (a) Stat e on e piece of eviden c e tha t shows that D is not propo r tio n a l to n . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (b) On the gra p h opposit e, dra w the line of best- fit for the data points. (2) (c) It is sugg e s t e d that the rela tion s hi p betw e e n D and n is of the form D = cn p whe r e c and p are const a n t s . Explain what grap h you would plot in orde r to det e r m i n e the value of p. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 90 (d) 1 Theory sugg e s t s that p = 2 and so D 2 = kn (whe r e k = c 2 ). A grap h of D 2 agains t n is show n below. Error bar s are show n for the first and last data points only. (i) Using the first grap h, calcul a t e the perc e n t a g e unc e r t a i n t y in D 2 , of the ring n = 7. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) Based on the secon d gra p h, stat e on e piec e of evide nc e that suppo r t s the relation s hi p D 2 = kn . IB Questionbank Physics 91 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (iii) Use the secon d grap h to dete r m i n e the value of the cons t a n t k, as well as its unce r t a i n t y. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (4) (iv) Stat e the unit for the const a n t k . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (Tot al 14 mark s ) 78. This ques tion is abou t a prob e in orbit. A prob e of mas s m is in a circul a r orbit of radius r arou n d a sphe ri c al plane t of mas s M . IB Questionbank Physics 92 (diagra m not to scale) IB Questionbank Physics 93 (a) Stat e why the work done by the gravit a tio n a l force durin g one full revolution of the prob e is zero. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (b) Deduc e for the prob e in orbit that its (i) spee d is v = GM r . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) total ener gy is E = GM m 2r . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 94 (c) It is now requi r e d to place the prob e in anot h e r circul a r orbit furth e r away from the plane t. To do this, the prob e’s engin e s will be fired for a very short time. Stat e and explain whet h e r the work done on the prob e by the engin e s is positive, neg ative or zero. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 7 mark s ) 79. This ques tion is abou t polarizatio n. (a) Stat e what is mea n t by polariz e d light. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 95 (b) Unpola rize d light is incide n t on the surfa c e of a plastic. The angle of inciden c e is θ. The reflect e d light is viewe d thro u g h an analys e r whos e tra n s m i s sio n axis is vertical. The variatio n with θ of the inte n si ty I of the tra n s m i t t e d light is show n in the grap h. (i) Explain why ther e is an angle of incide n c e , for which the inten si ty of the tran s mi t t e d light is zero. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 96 (ii) Calculat e the refr ac tive index of the plastic. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (c) Unpola rize d light from a sour c e is split, so that the r e is a path differ e n c e of half a wavel e n g t h betw e e n the two bea m s . A lens brings the light to focus at point P on a scre e n . The lens does not introd u c e any addition a l path differ e n c e . Stat e and explain whet h e r any light would be obse rv e d at P, in the case in which the polarize r s have their tra n s m i s sio n axes (i) par allel. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 97 ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 98 (ii) at right angles to each othe r. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tota l 9 mark s ) 80. This ques tion is abou t ther m o dy n a m i c s . The P–V diagr a m shows the expa n sio n of a fixed mas s of an ideal gas, from stat e A to stat e B. The tem p e r a t u r e of the gas in stat e A is 400 K. (a) Calcula t e the tem p e r a t u r e of the gas in stat e B. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 99 (b) (i) Calculat e the work done by the gas in expa n di n g from stat e A to stat e B. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) Dete r mi n e the amou n t of the r m a l ene r gy tra n sf e r r e d during the expa n sio n from stat e A to sta t e B. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (c) The gas is isoth e r m a lly comp r e s s e d from stat e B back to stat e A. (i) Using the P–V diagr a m axes above, dra w the variation of pres s u r e with volum e for this isoth e r m a l comp r e s s io n. (1) (ii) Stat e and explain whet h e r the ma gni t u d e of the the r m a l ene r gy tran sf e r r e d in this case would be less tha n, equ al to or gre a t e r than the ther m a l ene r gy tra n sf e r r e d in (b)(ii). ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... IB Questionbank Physics 100 .................. (2) (Tota l 8 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 101 81. This ques tion is abou t circula r motion. A ball of mas s 0.25 kg is attac h e d to a string and is ma d e to rota t e with cons t a n t spee d v along a horizon t al circle of radius r = 0.33 m. The string is att ac h e d to the ceiling and make s an angle of 30° with the vertical. (a) (i) On the diagr a m above, draw and label arrow s to repr e s e n t the forces on the ball in the position show n. (2) (ii) Stat e and explain whet h e r the ball is in equilibri u m . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 102 (b) Deter m i n e the spee d of rota tio n of the ball. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tota l 7 mark s ) 82. This ques tion is abou t char g e- couple d device s (CCDs) and photon s . (a) Stat e on e factor that affect s the resolutio n of an imag e obtain e d with a CCD. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (b) Stat e on e adva n t a g e of a CCD imag e, comp a r e d to an imag e on ordina ry photo g r a p h i c film. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 103 (c) Light of inten si ty 5.3 × 10 –3 W m –2 and frequ e n c y 3.9 × 10 14 Hz is inciden t on a pixel of a CCD. The are a of the pixel is 4.2 × 10 –12 m 2 and the quan t u m efficiency is 80 %. The capacit a n c e of the pixel is 14 pF. (i) Show that the num b e r of photon s incide n t on the pixel of the CCD per secon d is 8.6 × 10 4 . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (ii) Calculat e the char g e that acc u m ul a t e s in the pixel durin g a time of 25 ms. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (iii) Dete r mi n e the poten ti al differ e n c e at the ends of the pixel. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 104 (iv) Calculat e the mom e n t u m of one of the incide n t photon s . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 105 (v) Using your ans w e r to (c)(iv), estim a t e the pres s u r e exer t e d by the photon s in (c)(i) on the pixel of the CCD. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tot al 11 mark s ) 83. This ques tion is abou t simple har m o ni c oscillations . A longit u di n al wave travels throu g h a mediu m from left to right. Grap h 1 show s the variation with time t of the displa c e m e n t x of a particle P in the mediu m . Grap h 1 IB Questionbank Physics 106 (a) For par ticle P, (i) stat e how gra p h 1 shows that its oscillation s are not dam p e d . ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) calcula t e the mag nit u d e of its maxim u m accele r a ti o n. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (iii) calcula t e its speed at t = 0.12 s. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (iv) stat e its directio n of motion at t = 0.12 s. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 107 (b) Grap h 2 shows the variatio n with position d of the displa c e m e n t x of particl es in the mediu m at a partic ul a r insta n t of time. Grap h 2 Deter m i n e for the longit u di n a l wave, using gra p h 1 and gra p h 2, (i) the frequ e n cy. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) the spee d. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 108 Grap h 2 – repr o d u c e d to assist with answ e ri n g (c)(i). (c) The diagr a m shows the equilibriu m positions of six par ticle s in the medi u m . (i) On the diagr a m above, draw cros s e s to indic at e the positions of thes e six particle s at the insta n t of time whe n the displa c e m e n t is given by grap h 2. (3) IB Questionbank Physics 109 (ii) On the diagr a m above, label with the lette r C a par ticl e that is at the cent r e of a com p r e s s i o n. (1) (Tot al 14 mark s ) 84. This ques tion is abou t mech a ni c s and the r m a l physic s. The gra p h shows the variation with time t of the spe e d v of a ball of mas s 0.50 kg, that has been relea s e d from rest above the Eart h’s surfa c e . The force of air resist a n c e is not negligible. Assum e that the accel e r a t io n of free fall is g = 9.81 m s –2 . (a) Stat e, witho u t any calcula tion s , how the gra p h could be use d to dete r m i n e the dista n c e fallen. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 110 (b) (i) In the spac e below, dra w and label arrow s to rep r e s e n t the forces on the ball at 2.0 s. (1) (ii) Use the grap h opposit e to show that the accel e r a t io n of the ball at 2.0 s is appr oxi m a t e ly 4 m s –2 . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (iii) Calculat e the magni t u d e of the force of air resis t a n c e on the ball at 2.0 s. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 111 (iv) Stat e and explain whet h e r the air resist a n c e on the ball at t = 5.0 s is smaller than, equal to or gre a t e r tha n the air resist a n c e at t = 2.0 s. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (c) After 10 s the ball has fallen 190 m. (i) Show that the sum of the pot e n ti al and kinetic ene r gi e s of the ball has decr e a s e d by 780 J. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (ii) The specific heat capa city of the ball is 480 J kg –1 K–1 . Estim a t e the incr e a s e in the tem p e r a t u r e of the ball. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... IB Questionbank Physics 112 .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 113 (iii) Stat e an assu m p t i o n mad e in the esti m a t e in (c)(ii). ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (Tot al 14 mark s ) 85. This ques tion is abou t nuclea r physics. (a) (i) Define bindin g ener g y of a nucle u s. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) 239 The mas s of a nucle u s of plutoniu m ( 9 4 P u ) is 238.99 0 3 9 6 u. Deduc e that the bindin g ene r gy per nucle on for pluto ni u m is 7.6 MeV. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) IB Questionbank Physics 114 (b) The grap h shows the variatio n with nucle on num b e r A of the bindin g ener gy per nucleon. 239 Plutoni u m ( 9 4 P u ) und e r g o e s nucle a r fission accor di n g to the rea c tion given below. 239 1 94Pu 0 n (i) 91 3 8S r 15466Ba x 01 n Calculat e the num b e r x of neut r o n s prod u c e d . ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Use the grap h to estim a t e the ene r gy rele a s e d in this rea c tion. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 115 ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 116 (c) Stable nuclei with a mass num b e r gre a t e r tha n about 20, cont ai n mor e neut r o n s than proton s . By refe r e n c e to the prope r ti e s of the nucle a r force and of the elect r o s t a t i c force, sugg e s t an explan a ti o n for this obse rv a tio n. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (4) (Tot al 11 mark s ) 86. This ques tion is abou t qua n t u m aspe c t s of the elect r o n . The wav efunction ψ for an elect r o n confine d to move within a “box” of linea r size L = 1.0 × 10 –10 m, is a stan di n g wave as show n. IB Questionbank Physics 117 IB Questionbank Physics 118 (a) Stat e what is mea n t by a wavefu n c tio n. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (b) Stat e the position nea r which this elect r o n is most likely to be found. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (c) Calcula t e the mom e n t u m of the elect r o n. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (d) The ene r gy, in joules, of the elect r o n in a hydro g e n atom, is given by 2.1 81 0 1 8 n2 E = whe r e n is a positive inte g e r . Calcula t e the wavelen g t h of the photo n emitt e d in a tra n si tion from the first excit e d stat e of hydro g e n to the grou n d stat e. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 119 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 120 (e) The elect r o n stays in the first excite d stat e of hydrog e n for a time of appr oxi m a t ely ∆t = 1.0 × 10 –10 s. (i) Dete r mi n e the unce r t a i n t y in the ene r gy of the elect r o n in the first excit ed stat e. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) Sugg e s t , with refer e n c e to your answ e r to (e)(i), why the photo n s emitt e d in tran si tion s from the first excite d sta t e of hydro g e n to the grou n d stat e will, in fact, have a small rang e of wavele n g t h s . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 121 (f) Diagr a m 1 show s the thr e e lowes t ene r gy levels for an elect r o n in the hydrog e n atom. Using the ener gy axis on diagr a m 2, dra w the thr e e lowes t ene r gy levels for the elect r o n in a box model. You do not have to put any num b e r s on the vertical axis. (2) (Tot al 13 mark s ) 87. This ques tion is abou t elect ri c circ uit s. (a) Define (i) electro m o ti v e force (emf ) of a batt e r y. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) electrical resista n c e of a condu c t o r . ......................................................................................................... IB Questionbank Physics 122 .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (b) A batt e r y of emf ε and negligibl e inter n al res ista n c e is conne c t e d in series to two resisto r s . The cur r e n t in the circuit is I. (i) Stat e an equa tio n giving the total powe r delive r e d by the batt e r y. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) The poten ti al differ e n c e acros s resisto r R 1 is V 1 and that acros s resis to r R 2 is V 2 . Using the law of the cons e rv a tio n of ene r gy, ded uc e the equ a tio n below. ε = V1 + V2 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 123 (c) The grap h shows the I-V cha r a c t e r i s ti c s of two cond uc t o r s , X and Y. On the axes below, sketc h gra p h s to show the variatio n with pote n ti al differ e n c e V of the resist a n c e of cond u c t o r X (label this gra p h X) and cond u c t o r Y (label this gra p h Y). You do not nee d to put any num b e r s on the vertical axis. (3) IB Questionbank Physics 124 (d) The condu c t o r s in (c) are conn e c t e d in serie s to a bat t e r y of emf ε and negligible inter n al resis t a n c e . The powe r dissip a t e d in eac h of the two resisto r s is the sam e . Using the grap h given in (c), (i) det e r m i n e the emf of the batt e r y. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) calcula t e the total powe r dissipa t e d in the circ uit. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tot al 12 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 125 88. This ques tion is abou t the ene r gy bala nc e of the Ear t h. (a) The inten sity of the Sun’s radia tio n at the position of the Eart h is appr oxi m a t ely 1400 W m –2 . Sugg e s t why the aver a g e powe r receive d per unit are a of the Eart h is 350 W m –2 . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) The diagr a m shows a simplifie d model of the ene r gy bala nc e of the Eart h’s surfac e. The diagr a m shows radi ation ent e ri n g or leaving the Eart h’s surfa c e only. The aver a g e equilibri u m tem p e r a t u r e of the Ear t h’s surfa c e is T E and that of the atmo s p h e r e is T A = 242 K. (i) Using the data from the diagr a m , stat e the emissivity of the atm os p h e r e . ......................................................................................................... IB Questionbank Physics 126 .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 127 (ii) Show that the intensity of the radia tio n radia t e d by the atm os p h e r e towar d s the Eart h’s surfa c e is 136 W m –2 . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (iii) By refer e n c e to the ene r gy bala n c e of the Eart h’s surfa c e , calcula t e T E . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (c) (i) Outline a mec h a ni s m by which part of the radia tion radi at e d by the Eart h’s surfa c e is abso r b e d by gre e n h o u s e gas e s in the atm os p h e r e . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 128 (3) (ii) Sugg e s t why the incomi n g solar radia tio n is not affect e d by the mech a ni s m you outline d in (c)(i). ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (iii) Carbo n dioxide (CO 2 ) is a gre e n h o u s e gas. Stat e on e sour c e and on e sink (object that re move s CO 2 ) of this gas. Sourc e: ............................................................................................ .................. Sink: ................................................................................................ .................. (2) (Tot al 13 mark s ) 89. This ques tion is abou t motion in a ma gn e t i c field and elect r o m a g n e t i c inductio n An elect r o n, that has been accele r a t e d from rest by a pote n ti al differ e n c e of 250 V, ent e r s a region of ma gn e t i c field of stre n g t h 0.12 T that is direct e d into the plane of the pag e. IB Questionbank Physics 129 (a) The elect r o n’s path while in the region of mag n e ti c field is a qua r t e r circle. Show that the (i) spee d of the elect r o n afte r accele r a t i o n is 9.4 × 10 6 m s –1 . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 130 (ii) radi us of the pat h is 4.5 × 10 –4 m. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (iii) time the elect r o n spen d s in the region of ma g n e ti c field is 7.5 × 10 –11 s. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (b) The diagr a m below shows the mom e n t u m of the elect r o n as it ent e r s and leaves the region of ma gn e t i c field. The mag ni t u d e of the initial mom e n t u m and of the final mom e n t u m is 8.6 × 10 –24 Ns. (i) On the diagr a m above, draw an arro w to indica t e the vector repr e s e n t i n g the cha n g e in the mom e n t u m of the elect r o n . (1) IB Questionbank Physics 131 (ii) Show that the magni t u d e of the cha n g e in the mom e n t u m of the elect r o n is 1.2 × 10 –23 Ns. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (iii) Estim a t e the magni t u d e of the aver a g e force on the elect r o n . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (c) A squa r e loop of condu c ti n g wire is place d nea r a str ai g h t wire car ryin g a const a n t curr e n t I. The wire is in the sam e plan e as the loop. The loop is mad e to move with const a n t spe e d v towa r d s the wire. IB Questionbank Physics 132 (i) Explain, by refer e n c e to Far a d a y’s and Lenz’s laws of elect r o m a g n e t i c inductio n, why work must be done on the loop. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (ii) Sugg e s t what beco m e s of the work done on the loop. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (Tot al 12 mark s ) 90. This ques tion is abou t som e of the plane t s in the solar syste m . Four of the plane t s in the solar syste m are Mars, Venus, Jupite r and Nept u n e . (a) List thes e plane t s in orde r of incre a si n g dista n c e from the Sun. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 133 (b) List thes e plane t s in orde r of decr e a si n g diam e t e r . (2) (Tota l 4 mark s ) 91. This ques tion is abou t the Hert zs p r u n g–R u s s e ll (HR) diagr a m and using it to det e r m i n e some prop e r t i e s of sta r s. The diagr a m below show s the grid of an HR diagr a m , on which the position s of select e d star s are show n. (L S = luminosity of the Sun.) (a) (i) Draw a circle arou n d the sta r s that are red giant s. Label this circle R. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 134 (ii) Draw a circle arou n d the sta r s that are white dwarfs. Label this circle W. (1) (iii) Draw a line throu g h the sta r s tha t are main sequ e n c e sta r s. (1) (b) Explain, witho u t doing any calcul a tion, how astro n o m e r s can dedu c e that star B has a large r diam e t e r tha n sta r A. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (c) Using the following dat a and inform a ti o n from the HR diagr a m , show that star A is at a dista n c e of abou t 800 pc from Eart h. Appa r e n t brigh t n e s s of the Sun 3 1.4 × 10 W m = –2 Appa r e n t brigh t n e s s of sta r A = 4.9 × 10 –9 Wm –2 Mea n dista n c e of Sun from Eart h = 1.0 AU 1 pc = 2.1 × 10 5 AU ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 135 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (4) IB Questionbank Physics 136 (d) Explain why the dista n c e of sta r A from Eart h canno t be det e r m i n e d by the met ho d of stellar par allax. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (Tot al 11 mark s ) 92. This ques tion is abou t cosmology. (a) Stat e how the obser v e d red- shift of many galaxies is explaine d. ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (b) Explain how the cos mic micro w a v e backg r o u n d (CMB) radia tio n is consis t e n t with the Big Bang model. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (c) Calcula t e the tem p e r a t u r e of the unive r s e whe n the peak wavel e n g t h of the CMB was equal to the wavel e n g t h of red light (7.0 × 10 –7 m). ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 137 (Tota l 5 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 138 93. This ques tion is abou t the main sequ e n c e sta r Khad (Phi Orionis). The luminosity of Khad is 2.0 × 10 4 L S , whe r e L S is the luminosity of the Sun. (a) Assumin g that the expon e n t n in the mas s–lumi no si ty relation is 3.5, show that the mass of Khad is about 17 solar mas s e s . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) Outline the likely evolution of the sta r Khad afte r it leave s the main sequ e n c e . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tota l 5 mark s ) 94. This ques tion is abou t Hubbl e’s law and the age of the unive r s e . IB Questionbank Physics 139 (a) (i) Stat e Hubbl e’s law. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 140 (ii) Stat e why Hubbl e’s law cannot be use d to det e r m i n e the dista n c e from Eart h to near by galaxie s, suc h as Andro m e d a . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) 1 (i) Show that H 0 is an esti m a t e of the age of the univer s e, wher e H 0 is the Hubbl e const a n t . (b) ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) Assumi n g H 0 = 80 km s –1 M pc –1 , estim a t e the age of the univer s e in secon d s . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (Tota l 5 mark s ) 95. This ques tion is abou t modula tio n. In orde r to test a tem po r a r y radio com m u ni c a ti o n link, an audio signal is broa d c a s t using amplit u d e modul a tio n (AM). The powe r spect r u m of the res ulti ng carri e r wave is show n below. IB Questionbank Physics 141 IB Questionbank Physics 142 (a) Use the inform a t io n in the powe r spec t r u m to det e r m i n e the (i) frequ e n c y of the carri e r wave. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) frequ e n c y of the audio signal. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (iii) ban d wi d t h of this signal. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (b) (i) (FM). Disting ui s h betw e e n AM and frequ e n c y modul a tio n AM: ................................................................................................. .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. FM: .................................................................................................. ................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) Outline on e advan t a g e and on e disa dv a n t a g e of using FM as oppos e d to AM for the tra n s m i s sio n. Advant a g e : ...................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. Disadva n t a g e : ................................................................................. .................. IB Questionbank Physics 143 ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tota l 7 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 144 96. This ques tion is abou t data tran s m i s sio n syste m s . The block diagr a m below rep r e s e n t s an elect r o nic syste m , S 1 , which conver t s an analog u e input signal into a serial digital outpu t signal rea dy for tran s m i s sio n. It involves thre e sepa r a t e syste m blocks labelle d A, B and C. (a) Stat e whet h e r the signal betw e e n block A and block B is analog u e , digital or multiplex e d. ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (b) Stat e the function of syste m block A. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (c) A similar syste m , S 2 , is bas e d on the sam e syste m blocks as S 1 , but has fewer signal lines betw e e n block B and block C, as show n below. Explain what differ e n c e s , if any, the r e are betw e e n S 1 and S 2 with res p e c t to the maxim u m quality of the rep r o d u c t io n of the analog u e signal after tran s m i s sio n. ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 145 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (d) The serial digit al outp u t signal is tra n s m i t t e d using an optic al fibre link. The atte n u a t i o n per unit lengt h of the optic al fibre is –4 dB km –1 . (i) Define atten u a tio n . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) The input powe r to the fibre optic cable is 100 mW and the outp u t powe r at the end of the cable is 1 mW. Dete r m i n e the lengt h of the cable. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (iii) Stat e two proce s s e s that mus t take place in orde r for this digital signal to be tran s m i t t e d over a very long dist a n c e . 1. ..................................................................................................... .................. 2. ..................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tota l 9 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 146 97. This ques tion is abou t satellit es . A geos t a t io n a r y satellite is used by one count r y to broa d c a s t infor m a ti o n to a differ e n t count r y. (a) Stat e which part of the elect r o m a g n e t i c spe ct r u m is use d for this type of com m u ni c a t i o n. ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 147 (b) Explain two disadv a n t a g e s of using a polar satellite for this type of com m u ni c a t io n, when comp a r e d with using a geost a tio n a r y satellite. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (c) Outline on e possible ethic al issue associa t e d with this broa d c a s t . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (Tota l 4 mark s ) 98. This ques tion is abou t a Schmit t trigg e r . The diagr a m below show s a Sch mit t trigg e r circ uit bas e d on an oper a t io n a l amplifie r (op- amp). IB Questionbank Physics 148 The outpu t of this Schmit t trigg e r is positive satu r a ti o n (+13 V) or nega tive satu r a ti o n (–13 V). IB Questionbank Physics 149 (a) Stat e two prop e r t i e s of an ideal op- amp. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) Deter m i n e the input value tha t will caus e the outpu t to switc h from – 13 V to +1 3 V. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (c) Explain how a Schmit t trigg e r can be use d to res h a p e a digital puls e. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 150 (Tota l 8 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 151 99. This ques tion is abou t a mobile phon e netwo r k. Erin is a pass e n g e r on a train making a call to a sta n d a r d fixed telep h o n e line (“landline”) from her mobile phon e. The train move s Erin betw e e n adjac e n t com m u ni c a t io n cells. Outline the cha n g e s , if any, tha t take place in the (a) cellular excha n g e . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (b) public switch e d telep h o n e netwo r k (PSTN). ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (Tota l 2 mark s ) 10 0 . This ques tion is abou t dispe r sio n. (a) Stat e an appr oxi m a t e value for the wavele n g t h of visible light. ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (b) Descri b e what is mean t by dispe r si o n. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 152 (2) IB Questionbank Physics 153 (c) A nar r o w bea m , consisti n g of a mixtu r e of red and blue light, is inciden t upon a rect a n g u l a r glass block. The nor m al to the incide n t surfac e is show n. On the diag r a m above, dra w labelle d lines to show the pat h s of the red and blue bea m s , as they pass thro u g h the glass block and out to the air on the othe r side. (2) (Tota l 5 mark s ) 10 1 . This ques tion is abou t a convex lens. The diagr a m below, draw n to scale, shows a small object O plac e d in front of a thin convex (conver gi n g) lens. The focal points of the lens are show n, labelled F. The lens is repr e s e n t e d by the straig h t line XY. IB Questionbank Physics 154 (a) (i) Define the ter m focal point . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) On the diagr a m above, cons t r u c t the pat hs of two rays in orde r to locat e the position of the imag e form e d by the lens. Label the imag e I. (3) (iii) Explain whet h e r the imag e is real or virtual. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (b) A conver gi n g lens, of focal lengt h 5.0 cm, is use d as a simple magnifying glass to view an object of lengt h 0.80 cm. The obse rv e r’s eye is very close to the lens. The image is form e d at the nea r point (25 cm). (i) Dete r mi n e the dista n c e of the objec t from the lens. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 155 (ii) Dete r mi n e the lengt h of the imag e. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tot al 10 mark s ) 10 2 . This ques tion is abou t using a diffra c tio n gra tin g to view the emission spect r u m of sodiu m. Light from a sodiu m disch a r g e tube is incide n t nor m a lly upon a diffra ctio n gratin g having 8.00 × 10 5 lines per met r e . The spec t r u m cont ai n s a doubl e yellow line of wavelen g t h s 589 nm and 590 nm. (a) Deter m i n e the angul a r sepa r a t i o n of the two lines whe n viewe d in the secon d order spect r u m . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (4) IB Questionbank Physics 156 (b) Stat e why it is mor e difficult to obse rv e the doubl e yellow line whe n viewe d in the first orde r spect r u m . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (Tota l 5 mark s ) 10 3 . This ques tion is abou t X-rays. Elect r o n s are accel e r a t e d thro u g h a pote n ti al differ e n c e of 25 kV and strike a molybd e n u m targ e t . The res ulti n g X-ray spect r u m is show n below. The accel e r a t i n g pot en ti al differ e n c e is cha n g e d to 15 kV. (a) Calcula t e the minim u m wavele n g t h of the X-rays produ c e d . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 157 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) On the gra p h above, sketc h the X-ray spect r u m that would be prod u c e d . (3) (Tota l 5 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 158 10 4 . This ques tion is abou t wedg e film inte rfe r e n c e . One flat, glass slide is place d at an angle on top of a secon d identic al slide. The slides are in cont a c t along one short edge and are sepa r a t e d at the othe r edge by a thin piece of pape r, as show n below. (diagra m not to scale) A thin wedg e of air of variabl e thickn e s s , t , is tra p p e d betw e e n the two slides. The arr a n g e m e n t is viewe d nor m a lly from above, using light of wavele n g t h 590 nm. The glass plate s are coat e d, so that reflection only takes place at the botto m surfa c e of the top plat e and the top surfa c e of the botto m plate. A series of str aig h t bright and dark fringe s , equally sepa r a t e d and par allel to the shor t edge of the slides, is see n. (a) Deduc e that the thickn e s s of the air wedg e t that gives rise to a brigh t fringe, is given by 2 t = (m + 1 2 )λ. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 159 (b) The lengt h of the air wedg e , L , is 8.2 cm. The bright fringe s are each sepa r a t e d by a dista n c e of 1.2 mm. Calcula t e the thickn e s s of the pape r. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tota l 5 mark s ) 10 5 . This ques tion is abou t lengt h contr a c ti o n and simult a n e i ty. (a) Define proper lengt h. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (b) A space s hi p is travelling to the right at spe e d 0.75 c, thro u g h a tunn el which is open at both ends. Obse rv e r A is sta n di n g at the cent r e of one side of the tunn el. Obse rv e r A, for whom the tunn el is at rest, mea s u r e s the lengt h of the tunn el to be 240 m and the lengt h of the space s hi p to be 200 m. The diag r a m below shows this situa tion from the pers p e c t ive of obse rv e r A. IB Questionbank Physics 160 Observ e r B, for whom the spac e s hi p is station a r y, is sta n di n g at the cent r e of the spac e s hi p. IB Questionbank Physics 161 (i) Calculat e the Lorent z factor, γ, for this situa tio n. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Calculat e the lengt h of the tunn el accor di n g to obs e rv e r B. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (iii) Calculat e the lengt h of the spa c e s hi p accor di n g to obse rv e r B. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (iv) Accor din g to obse rv e r A, the spa c e s hi p is compl e t e ly inside the tunn el for a shor t time. Sta t e and explain whet h e r or not, accor di n g to obs erv e r B, the spac e s hi p is eve r compl e t ely inside the tunn el. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 162 (c) Two sour ce s of light are locat e d at eac h end of the tunn el. The diagr a m below show s this situa tion from the pers p e c tiv e of obse rv e r A. Accordi n g to observ e r A, at the insta n t whe n obse rv e r B pas s e s obse rv e r A, the two sour c e s of light emit a flash. Obse rv e r A see s the two flashe s simult a n e o u s ly. Discus s whet h e r or not obse r v e r B sees the two flashe s simult a n e o u s ly. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (4) (Tot al 10 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 163 10 6 . This ques tion is abou t relative velocitie s and ene r gy at rela tivistic spe e d s . Two identic al rocket s are moving along the sam e str ai g h t line as viewe d from Eart h. Rocket 1 is moving away from the Eart h at spe e d 0.80 c rela tiv e to the Eart h and rocket 2 is moving away from rocke t 1 at spe e d 0.60 c relat iv e to rock e t 1 . (a) Calcula t e the velocity of rocke t 2 rela tive to the Eart h, using the (i) Galilean tran sfo r m a t i o n equ a tio n. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) relativistic tran sfo r m a t i o n equ a tio n. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (b) Comm e n t on your ans w e r s in (a). ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 164 ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 165 (c) The rest mas s of rocke t 1 is 1.0 × 10 3 kg. Dete r mi n e the relat ivi s t i c kinetic ener gy of rocke t 1, as me a s u r e d by an obs e rv e r on Eart h. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tota l 8 mark s ) 10 7 . This ques tion is abou t the Michels o n–Mo rl ey expe ri m e n t . The diagr a m below show s the ess e n ti al feat u r e s of the app a r a t u s used in the Michelso n–Mo rl ey experi m e n t . IB Questionbank Physics 166 (a) Stat e and explain how this appa r a t u s was use d to try to mea s u r e the spee d of the Eart h relative to the ethe r . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (4) (b) Stat e the res ult of this expe ri m e n t and explain how this res ult suppo r t s the special theo ry of relativity. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 6 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 167 10 8 . This ques tion is abou t gravit a tio n a l red- shift. Two identic al laser s are situa t e d on the surfa c e of the Eart h. One is direct e d horizon t ally towa r d s obse rv e r A, who me a s u r e s the frequ e n c y to be 4.62 × 10 14 Hz. The othe r is dire c t e d vertic ally upw a r d s towa r d s obse rv e r B, who is at a height of 1.00 × 10 2 m (a) (i) Stat e how the freq u e n c y as mea s u r e d by obs e rv e r B comp a r e s with the freq u e n c y as mea s u r e d by obse rv e r A. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Calculat e the differ e n c e in freq u e n c y bet w e e n the lase r light as meas u r e d by obse rv e r s A and B. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (iii) Stat e on e assu m p ti o n tha t you ma d e in (a)(ii). ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 168 ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 169 (b) The laser s are now place d on a spa c e s hi p, which is acc el e r a t i n g upw a r d s at a const a n t rate of 9.81 m s –2 , far away from any othe r mas s e s as shown below. The dista n c e of obse rv e r D from the lase r is 1.00 × 10 2 m. Obse rv e r C is at the botto m of the spa c e s hi p. Explain, with refer e n c e to the equivale n c e principle, the frequ e n ci e s mea s u r e d by observ e r s C and D, as comp a r e d to obse rv e r s A and B. ......................................................................................................................... ............. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 6 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 170 10 9 . This ques tion is abou t soun d inte nsi ty levels. As part of a safety inspec tion of a new factory, a data logge r mea s u r e s the inten si ty of the soun d s gen e r a t e d by the mac hi n e s . The soun d inten sity levels nee d to be within acce p t a bl e limits. (a) Define intensit y and intensit y level . Inten sit y: ................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... Inten sit y level: ............................................................................................... .............. ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) The data logge r is moved betw e e n five differ e n t location s in the factory (A → E). The readi n g s are show n below. (i) Loca t i o n Rea di n g on dat a log g e r / mW m –2 A 302 B 158 C 891 D 413 E 524 Dete r mi n e the intensi ty level at the noisies t location. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 171 ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) IB Questionbank Physics 172 (ii) Using your ans w e r to (b)(i), discus s whe t h e r or not it is nece s s a r y for the mac hin e ope r a t o r s to use ear prot e c t o r s whe n workin g in this factory. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (iii) One possibl e effect on hea ri n g of long- ter m expos u r e to noise is tinnitu s . Outline what is me a n t by tinnitu s . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (Tota l 8 mark s ) 11 0 . This ques tion is abou t medic al imagin g. A patie n t is susp e c t e d of having a parti al blocka g e in his intes ti n e as it leads away from his stom a c h . Possible me dic al imagi n g tech ni q u e s includ e X-ray photo g r a p h y, ultr a s o u n d and the use of an endos c o p e . (a) When prod u ci n g the X-ray photo g r a p h , the dose is kept to a minim u m by a tech ni q u e called enh a n c e m e n t . (i) Outline why the dos e nee d s to be kept to a minim u m . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... IB Questionbank Physics 173 .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 174 (ii) Describ e on e possible enha n c e m e n t tech ni q u e . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (iii) Discus s any extr a proc e d u r e s that are nee d e d to get an app r o p r i a t e imag e of the inte s tin e in this situa tion. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (b) A succe s sf ul ultr a s o u n d scan relies on cha n g e s of acous tic impe d a n c e arou n d the struc t u r e being imag e d . (i) Define acous tic impe d a n c e . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Stat e the SI unit in which it is me a s u r e d . ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 175 (iii) Explain, in ter m s of acous tic impe d a n c e , why gel nee d s to be applied on the surfac e of the skin befor e the ultra s o u n d scan. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (c) The blocka g e is cut out and re mov e d in a proc e d u r e which involves a laser and an endos co p e . (i) Outline how it is possible to use a lase r as a scalpel (knife). ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) By refer r i n g to the role playe d by optic fibre s, disc us s how an endos co p e is used in this situa tion. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tot al 14 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 176 IB Questionbank Physics 177 11 1 . This ques tion is abou t radiation in me dicin e. A nucle a r stres s test is used to inves tig a t e the blood flow within a patie n t’s hea r t durin g exer cis e. The radioisot o p e thalliu m- 201 is inject e d into the patie n t’s blood and a gam m a- ray det ec t o r is then use d to recor d its distrib u tio n within the hea r t muscle. The following infor m a t io n about this proc e d u r e is availabl e. Mass of patien t = 75 kg Dose equivale n t for a nucle a r stre s s test = 25 mSv (a) The quality factor of the ga m m a- rays is 1. Dete r m i n e the ene r gy absor b e d by the patien t as a res ult of the thallium injection. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (b) Sugg e s t whet h e r you would expe c t the ene r gy calcula t e d in (a) to res ult in a significan t incre a s e in the patie n t’s tem p e r a t u r e . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 178 (c) On aver a g e , 1 in every 1000 patie n t s who und e r t a k e a nucle a r str e s s test go on to develop canc e r as a result of the radioa c tive dos e that they received durin g the test. (i) By refer r i n g to the conc e p t of bala n c e d risk, outline why the test may still be of benefit to the patie n t . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) The hospit al tech nicia n who admini st e r s the test could also receive an incr e a s e d dos e. Outline how film badg e s are use d to prot e c t tec hni ci a n s from receiving exces sive dos es of radia tio n. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tota l 8 mark s ) 11 2 . This ques tion is abou t meso n s . (a) Stat e what is mea n t by an exch a n g e par ticle. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 179 (b) In 1935, the physicist Hide ki Yukawa pre dic t e d that the stron g inter a c ti o n betw e e n nucleon s was medi a t e d by particle s calle d meson s . Given that the rang e of the stron g inte r a c t io n is appr oxi m a t ely 1.5 × 10 –15 m, calcula t e a possible value for the res t mas s of a meso n. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (c) A meson called the pion was det e c t e d in cosmic ray reac tio n s in 1947 by Powell and Occhialini. The pion com e s in thre e possibl e cha r g e stat e s: π + , π – and π 0 The Feyn m a n diagr a m below rep r e s e n t s a possible reac tion in which a pion particip a t e s . Stat e and explain whet h e r the meso n prod u c e d is a π + , π – or π 0 . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 180 (d) Stat e the possible spin num b e r s of meso n s and explain your answ e r . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (e) Explain why, accor di n g to the qua r k model, it is not possible for a particl e to consist of two up qua r k s only. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tot al 10 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 181 11 3 . This ques tion is abou t accel er a ti n g par ticle s. The diagr a m below show s the basic struc t u r e of a cyclotr o n. Char g e d particle s are emitt e d from a sour c e at the cent r e . They move in a vacuu m throu g h two D-shap e d cavitie s or “dee s”. Ther e is a unifor m mag n e ti c field direc t e d into the pag e, within the region of the dee s. (a) Outline why the voltag e applie d acros s the dee s must cha n g e polarity every half revolutio n. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 182 (b) Show that the frequ e n c y, f, of the applied pote n ti al differ e n c e is given by the expr e s sio n qB f = 2 πm whe r e q = char g e of particle m = mas s of particle B = mag n e t i c field stre n g t h . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (c) Stat e two disadv a n t a g e s of using a cyclotr o n rath e r tha n a synch r o t r o n to accel e r a t e particle s. 1. ............................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... 2. ............................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (d) Explain why it is nece s s a r y to acc ele r a t e particl e s to high spee d s in orde r to crea t e new par ticl e s of large mass. IB Questionbank Physics 183 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 184 (e) High ene r gy particles are used to prob e the nucle u s. Explain why alph a particle s would give bett e r resolution tha n proton s moving at the sam e spee d. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tot al 12 mark s ) 11 4 . This ques tion is abou t ener gy and cons e rv a tio n laws. Two proton s moving at the sam e spe e d in opposit e direc tio n s, collide with each othe r produ ci n g thr e e proto n s and an anti- proton, as show n below. p + p →p + p + p + p (a) Calcula t e the minim u m possibl e kinetic ene r gy of on e of the colliding proto n s . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 185 (b) Explain why the following rea c tion is not possible, even if the colliding particl es have enou g h ene r gy. p + n →p + p + p ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 4 mark s ) 11 5 . This ques tion is abou t cosmology and string s . (a) The bindin g ener gy of a helium nucle u s is abou t 28 MeV. Calcula t e the tem p e r a t u r e of the unive r s e above which helium nuclei could not have exist e d. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) Stat e two fund a m e n t a l differ e n c e s betw e e n the sta n d a r d model and the theo ry of string s. 1. ............................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... 2. ............................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 186 ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 4 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 187 11 6 . Which of the following will red uc e ran do m erro r s in an expe ri m e n t ? A. Using an instr u m e n t having a gre a t e r precision B. Checkin g the calibr a ti o n of the inst r u m e n t use d C. Checkin g for zero erro r on the instr u m e n t use d D. Repe a ti n g readi n g s (Tot al 1 mar k ) 11 7 . A body accele r a t e s from rest with a unifor m accele r a t i o n a for a time t . The unce r t ai n t y in a is 8 % and the unc e r t a i n t y in t is 4 %. The unc e r t a i n t y in the spee d is A. 32 %. B. 12 %. C. 8 %. D. 2 %. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 11 8 . Which of the following lists two scala r qua n ti tie s ? A. emf, mom e n t u m B. emf, weigh t C. impuls e, kinetic ener gy D. magn e t i c flux, kinetic ener gy (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 188 11 9 . The gra p h shows the variation with time t of the acc el e r a t io n a of an objec t. Which of the following is the cha n g e in velocity of the object in the time interv al 0 to 4 s? A. –8 m s –1 B. –4 m s –1 C. +4 m s –1 D. +8 m s –1 (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 189 12 0 . A car accele r a t e s from rest. The accele r a t i o n incr e a s e s with time. Which grap h shows the variatio n with time t of the spe e d v of the car? (Tot al 1 mar k ) 12 1 . Which of the following is the condition for a body to be in tra n sl a tio n a l equilibriu m ? A. The result a n t force on the body in any direc tio n is zero. B. The velocity of the body in any direc tion is zero. C. No exte r n al force is acting on the body. D. No work is done on the body. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 190 12 2 . A stone attac h e d to a string is moving in a horizon t a l circle. The const a n t spee d of the stone is v . The diagr a m below show s the ston e in two differ e n t positions , X and Y. Which of the following shows the direc tio n of the cha n g e of velocity of the ston e when moving from position X to position Y? (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 191 12 3 . The gra p h shows the variation with force F of the exte nsio n s of a sprin g. The work done in chan gi n g the exte n sion of the sprin g from 3.0 cm to 6.0 cm is A. 15 N cm. B. 30 N cm. C. 45 N cm. D. 60 N cm. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 12 4 . The ener gy of the molec ul e s of an ideal gas is A. ther m al only. B. ther m al and pote n ti al. C. poten ti al and kinetic. D. kinetic only. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 192 12 5 . Oil with volum e V has specific heat capa city c at tem p e r a t u r e T . The density of oil is ρ. Which of the following is the the r m a l capa ci ty of the oil? A. ρcV B. cV ρ C. ρcVT D. cV ρT (Tot al 1 mar k ) 12 6 . The volum e of an ideal gas in a cont ai n e r is incre a s e d at const a n t tem p e r a t u r e . Which of the following sta t e m e n t s is/ar e cor r e c t abou t the molecul e s of the gas? I. Their spee d rem ai n s const a n t . II. The frequ e n cy of collisions of molec ul e s with unit are a of the cont ai n e r wall decr e a s e s . III. The force betw e e n the m dec r e a s e s . A. I only B. I and II only C. I and III only D. II and III only (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 193 12 7 . A particle oscillat es with simple har m o ni c motion with period T . At time t = 0, the particl e has its maxim u m displ ac e m e n t . Which gra p h shows the variation with time t of the kinetic ene r gy E k of the par ticle? (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 194 12 8 . An object is und e r g oi n g simple har m o nic motion with light dam pi n g. The natu r al frequ e n c y of oscillation of the objec t is f 0 . A periodic force of frequ e n c y f is applied to the object. Which of the following gra p h s best shows how the amplit u d e a of oscillation of the object varie s with f? (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 195 12 9 . The gra p h shows meas u r e m e n t s of the heigh t h of sea level at differe n t times t in the Bay of Fundy. Which of the following gives the app r oxi m a t e am plit u d e and period of the tides? Amplit u d e Peri o d A. 6.5 m 6 hour s B. 13 m 12 hour s C. 6.5 m 12 hour s D. 13 m 6 hour s (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 196 λ 13 0 . Two waves meet at a point. The waves have a path differ e n c e of 4 . The phas e differe n c e betw e e n the waves is A. π 8 rad. B. π 4 rad. C. π 2 rad. D. π rad. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 13 1 . Two elect r o d e s , sepa r a t e d by a dista n c e d , in a vacuu m are maint ai n e d at a cons t a n t pote n ti al differ e n c e . An elect r o n, accel e r a t e d from one elect r o d e to the other , gains kinetic ener gy E k . The dist a n c e betw e e n the elect r o d e s 1 is now chan g e d to 3 d . What is the gain in kinetic ener gy of an elect r o n that is accele r a t e d from one elect r o d e to the other ? A. Ek 3 B. Ek C. 3 Ek D. 9 Ek (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 197 13 2 . The gra p h shows the I–V char a c t e r i s ti c s of two resisto r s . When resisto r s X and Y are conn e c t e d in serie s, the cur r e n t in the resisto r s is 2.0 A. What is the resist a n c e of the serie s com bin a tio n of X and Y? A. 7.0 Ω B. 1.3 Ω C. 1.1 Ω D. 0.14 Ω (Tot al 1 mar k ) 13 3 . The definition of the amp e r e refe r s to the A. num b e r of elect r o n s passin g a given point per secon d. B. force betw e e n par allel cur r e n t- car ryin g condu c t o r s . C. powe r dissip at e d per unit resist a n c e . D. amou n t of char g e tran sf e r r e d per secon d. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 198 13 4 . A space c r af t travels away from Eart h in a strai g h t line with its motor s shut down. At one insta n t the spee d of the spac e c r a f t is 5.4 km s –1 . After a time of 600 s, the spee d is 5.1 km s –1 . The aver a g e gravit a tio n a l field stre n g t h acting on the spac e c r af t during this time inte rv al is A. 5.0 × 10 –4 N kg –1 B. 3.0 × 10 –2 N kg –1 C. 5.0 × 10 –1 N kg –1 D. 30 N kg –1 (Tot al 1 mar k ) 13 5 . Two isol ated point char g e s , –7 μC and +2 μC, are at a fixed dist a n c e apa r t . At which point is it possible for the elect ric field str e n g t h to be zero? (not to scale) (Tot al 1 mar k ) 13 6 . A long str ai g h t wire carri es an elect ric cur r e n t per p e n di c ul a r ly out of the pap e r . Which of the following repr e s e n t s the ma gn e t i c field patt e r n due to the curr e n t ? (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 199 13 7 . Which nucleon s in a nucleu s are involve d in the Coulom b inte r a c ti o n and the stron g short- ran g e nuclea r inte r a c ti o n? Coul o m b int er a c t i o n Str o n g sh or t- ran g e int e r a c t i o n A. proton s proto n s , neut r o n s B. proton s neut r o n s C. proton s proto n s D. proton s , neut r o n s neut r o n s (Tot al 1 mar k ) 13 8 . Two sam pl e s of radioa ctiv e subs t a n c e s X and Y have the sam e initial activity. The half- life of X is T and the half- life of Y is 3 T . After a time of 3 T the ratio a c t ivit of y s u b s t a n cX e a c t ivit of y s u b s t a n cY e is A. 8. B. 4. C. 1 4. D. 1 8. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 200 13 9 . The nuclea r equ atio n below is an exa m pl e of the tra ns m u t a t i o n of mer c u r y into gold. 2 1H 18909H g 197 7 9 Au + X The particle X is a A. gam m a- ray photon. B. heliu m nucleu s . C. proto n. D. neut r o n. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 14 0 . The Sank ey diag r a m of a fossil- fuelled powe r station is show n below. Which of the following bes t identifies the the r m a l ene r gy rem ov e d by wat e r and the useful elect ric al ener gy outpu t of the station? Ther m a l en er g y re m o v e d Us e f u l el e c t r i c a l en e r g y out p u t A. 2 1 B. 2 3 C. 3 1 D. 1 2 (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 201 14 1 . World ener gy resou r c e s include coal, nucle a r fuel and geot h e r m a l ene r gy. Which of the following lists thes e resou r c e s in orde r of pri m a r y ene r gy use in the world? A. nuclea r , geot h e r m a l , coal B. nuclea r , coal, geot h e r m a l C. coal, geot h e r m a l , nuclea r D. coal, nucle a r , geot h e r m a l (Tot al 1 mar k ) 14 2 . Which of the following proce s s e s leads to the produ c tio n of a nucle u s of plutoni u m- 239 from a nucleu s of ura ni u m- 238? A. Neut r o n capt u r e by uraniu m nucle u s B. Radioa ctive decay of uraniu m nucle u s C. Elect r o n capt u r e by uraniu m nucle u s D. Nucle a r fission of urani u m nucle u s (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 202 14 3 . Wate r is cont ai n e d in a tidal basin behin d a dam. The wat e r has a dept h h at high tide and zero at low tide, as show n in the diagr a m . The gravit a tion al pote n ti al ene r gy of the wate r stor e d in the basin betw e e n a high tide and a low tide is propo r tio n a l to A. h. B. h. C. h 2. D. h 3. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 203 14 4 . Surfac e X has a tem p e r a t u r e T X and emissivity ε x . Surfa c e Y has a tem p e r a t u r e T Y and emis sivity ε y . The two surfa c e s emit radi a tion at the sam e rat e. TX What is the ratio TY ? 1 A. εy ε x 4 B. εx εy 4 4 C. εy ε x 4 D. εX εy 1 (Tot al 1 mar k ) 14 5 . Large area s of rainfor e s t s are cut down and bur n e d every year. The result of thes e actions is A. red uc e d albed o. B. red uc e d car bo n fixation. C. incr e a s e d evapo r a t io n rat e. D. incr e a s e d mas s of atmos p h e r i c met h a n e . (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 204 14 6 . Data analysis ques tion. The spee d v of waves on the surfa c e of dee p wate r dep e n d s only on the wavele n g t h λ of the waves. The dat a gath e r e d from a par tic ul a r region of the Atlantic Ocea n are plott e d below. The unce r t a i n t y in the speed v is ±0. 3 0 m s –1 and the unc e r t a i n t y in λ is too small to be show n on the diagr a m . (a) Stat e, with refer e n c e to the gra p h, (i) why v is not directly propo r tio n a l to λ. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) the value of v for λ = 39 m. ......................................................................................................... IB Questionbank Physics 205 .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 206 (b) It is sugg e s t e d that the rela tion s hi p betw e e n v and λ is of the form v = a λ whe r e a is a const a n t . To test the validity of this hypot h e s i s, values of v 2 agains t λ are plott e d below. (i) Use your answ e r to (a)(ii) to show that the absolut e unce r t a i n t y in v 2 for a wavele n g t h of 39 m is ±5 m 2 s –2 . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (ii) The absolut e uncer t a i n t y in v 2 for a wavele n g t h of 2.5 m is ±1 m 2 s –2 . Using this value and the value in (b)(i), const r u c t error bars for v 2 at the dat a points for IB Questionbank Physics 207 λ = 2.5 m and 39 m. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 208 (iii) Stat e why the plott e d dat a in (b)(ii) sugg e s t that it is likely that v is propo r tio n al to λ. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (iv) Use the grap h above to det e r m i n e the cons t a n t a . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (v) Theory shows that a = k 2 π . Dete r mi n e a value for k . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (Tot al 11 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 209 14 7 . This ques tion is abou t kine m a t i c s. Lucy stan d s on the edg e of a vertic al cliff and throw s a ston e vertic ally upwa r d s . The stone leaves her han d with a spe e d of 15 m s –1 at the insta n t her hand is 80 m above the surfac e of the sea. Air resist a n c e is negligibl e and the accele r a ti o n of free fall is 10 m s –2 . (a) Calcula t e the maxim u m heigh t rea c h e d by the ston e as me a s u r e d from the point wher e it is throw n. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 210 (b) Deter m i n e the time for the stone to rea c h the surfa c e of the sea afte r leaving Lucy’s hand. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tota l 5 mark s ) 14 8 . This ques tion is abou t inter n al ene r gy and the r m a l ene r gy (hea t). (a) Disting ui s h betw e e n inter n a l ene r gy and the r m a l ene r gy. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (b) Descri b e, with refer e n c e to the ene r gy of the molec ul e s , the differ e n c e in inter n al ener gy of a piec e of iron and the inter n al ene r gy of an ideal gas. ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 211 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 212 (c) A piece of iron is place d in a kiln until it rea c h e s the tem p e r a t u r e θ of the kiln. The iron is then quickly tra n sf e r r e d to wat e r held in a ther m ally insulat e d cont ai n e r . The wat e r is stirr e d until it rea c h e s a ste a dy tem p e r a t u r e . The following data are availa bl e. Ther m al capa city of the piece of iron K–1 Ther m al capa city of the wate r 10 3 J K –1 Initial tem p e r a t u r e of the wat e r Final tem p e r a t u r e of the wat e r = 60 J = 2.0 × = 16 °C = 45 °C The ther m al capa ci ty of the cont ai n e r and insula tion is negligible. (i) Stat e an expr e s s io n, in ter m s of θ and the above dat a, for the ene r gy tran sf e r of the iron in cooling from the tem p e r a t u r e of the kiln to the final tem p e r a t u r e of the wat e r . ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Calculat e the incre a s e in inte r n a l ene r gy of the wat e r as the iron cools in the wat e r . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (iii) Use your answ e r s to (c)(i) and (c)(ii) to det e r m i n e θ. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tota l 9 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 213 14 9 . This ques tion is abou t simple har m o ni c motion (SHM) and a wave in a string. (a) By refer e n c e to simple har m o ni c motion, stat e wha t is mea n t by amplit u d e. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (b) A liquid is cont ain e d in a U-tube. Dia g r a m 1 Dia gr a m 2 The pres s u r e on the liquid in one side of the tube is incr e a s e d so tha t the liquid is displac e d as show n in diag r a m 2. Whe n the pres s u r e is sudd e nly relea s e d the liquid oscillat e s . The dam pi n g of the oscillation s is small. (i) Describ e what is mea n t by da m pi n g. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 214 (ii) The displac e m e n t of the liquid surfa c e from its equilibri u m position is x . The accele r a ti o n a of the liquid in the tube is given by the expr e s si o n a = 2g x l wher e g is the accele r a t io n of free fall and l is the total lengt h of the liquid colum n. The total lengt h of the liquid colum n in the tube is 0.32 m. Dete r mi n e the period of oscillation. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (c) A wave is travelling along a strin g. The string can be modelle d as a single line of particles and each particl e execu t e s simple har m o ni c motion. The period of oscillation of the particle s is 0.80 s. The grap h shows the displa c e m e n t y of par t of the string at time t = 0. The dist an c e along the string is d. IB Questionbank Physics 215 (i) On the grap h, draw an arro w to show the dire c tion of motion of par ticl e P at the point mark e d on the string. (1) (ii) Dete r mi n e the mag nit u d e of the velocity of particle P. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (4) (iii) Show that the spee d of the wave is 5.0 m s –1 . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (iv) On the grap h above, label with the lette r X the position of IB Questionbank Physics 216 par ticl e P at t = 0.40 s. (1) (Tot al 15 mark s ) 15 0 . This ques tion is abou t unified atomic mass unit and a nucle a r rea c tio n. (a) Define the ter m unified atomic mas s unit . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 217 (b) The mas s of a nucleu s of rut h e rf o r di u m- 254 is 254.1 0 0 1 u. Calcula t e the mas s in GeV c –2 . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (c) In 1919, Ruthe r fo r d produ c e d the first artificial nucle a r tra n s m u t a t i o n by bomb a r di n g nitrog e n with α-par ticle s. The rea c tion is repr e s e n t e d by the following equ atio n. α+ (i) 14 7N 187 O + X Identify X. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) The following dat a are availa bl e for the rea c tio n. Rest mass of α Rest mass of 14 7N Rest mass of 17 8O = 3.742 8 GeV c –2 = 13.09 4 2 GeV c –2 + X = 16.83 8 3 GeV c –2 The initial kinetic ene r gy of the α-par ticle is 7.68 MeV. Dete r mi n e the sum of the kinetic ene r gi e s of the oxyge n nucle u s and X. (Assu m e that the nitrog e n nucle u s is station a r y.) ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) IB Questionbank Physics 218 (d) The reac tion in (c) prod u c e s oxyge n (O-17). Othe r isotop e s of oxyge n includ e O-19 which is radioa c tive with a half- life of 30 s. (i) Stat e what is mean t by the ter m isotop e s . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Define the ter m radioactiv e half- life . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (e) A nucleu s of the isotop e O-19 dec ays to a stable nucle u s of fluorin e. The half- life of O-19 is 30 s. At time t = 0, a sam pl e of O-19 cont ai n s a larg e num b e r N 0 nuclei of O-19. On the grid below, draw a gra p h to show the variation with time t of the num b e r N of O-19 nuclei rem ai ni n g in the sam pl e . You should conside r a time of t = 0 to t = 120 s. IB Questionbank Physics 219 (2) (Tot al 10 mark s ) 15 1 . This ques tion is abou t power prod u c tio n and global war mi n g. (a) In any cyclical proc es s design e d to continu o u s ly conve r t the r m a l ener gy to work, some ene r gy is always deg r a d e d . Explain what is mea n t by degr a d e d ener gy. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) A nuclea r powe r station uses ura ni u m- 235 (U- 235) as fuel. Outline the (i) proce s s e s and ener gy chan g e s that occur thro u g h which the r m a l ene r gy is produ c e d . ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 220 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (4) IB Questionbank Physics 221 (ii) role of the heat exch a n g e r of the rea c t o r and the tur bi n e in the gen e r a t io n of elect ric al ene r gy. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (c) Identify on e proce s s in the powe r station whe r e ene r gy is degr a d e d . ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (d) The maxim u m powe r outp u t of the Drax coal- fired powe r station in the UK is 4.0 GW. Dete r mi n e the minim u m mas s of pur e U-235 that would be requir e d by a nuclea r powe r sta tion to provide the sam e maxim u m annu al ener gy outpu t as the Drax powe r station. Ener gy density of U-235 = 82 TJ kg –1 1 year = 3.2 × 10 7 s ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 222 (2) IB Questionbank Physics 223 (e) The Drax powe r station produ c e s an enor m o u s amou n t of carbo n dioxide, a gas classified as a gre e n h o u s e gas. Outline, with refe r e n c e to the vibratio n al beh aviou r of molec ul e s of car bo n dioxide, wha t is mea n t by a gre e n h o u s e gas. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (f) It has bee n sugg e s t e d that the prod u c tio n of gre e n h o u s e gas e s by coal- fired powe r station s has incre a s e d global war mi n g . One piec e of eviden c e to suppo r t this sugg e s ti o n is the incre a s e in sea- level due to an incr e a s e in tem p e r a t u r e of the ocea n s . Over the past 100 yea rs it is sugg e s t e d that sea- levels have rise n by 6.4 × 10 –2 m due to volum e expan si o n. Using the following dat a, det e r m i n e the aver a g e rise in tem p e r a t u r e in the top levels of the ocea n s in the last 100 years. Mean dept h of ocea n s that is affect e d by global war mi n g 4.0 × 10 2 m Coefficien t of volum e expa n sio n of sea wat e r 5.1 × 10 –5 K–1 = = ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 224 ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tot al 18 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 225 15 2 . This ques tion is abou t elect ri c cha r g e . (a) A plastic rod XY is held at end X. The end Y is rubb e d with a piec e of cloth and, as a res ult, the end Y beco m e s elect ric ally cha r g e d . The proce d u r e is now rep e a t e d using a coppe r rod and it is found tha t the copp e r rod rem ai n s elect ric ally neut r a l. Explain thes e obse rv a tio n s in ter m s of the prop e r ti e s of cond u c t o r s and insulat o r s . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (5) IB Questionbank Physics 226 (b) Two plastic rods each have a positive char g e + q situa t e d at one end. The rods are arr a n g e d as show n. Assum e that the char g e at the end of eac h rod beha v e s as a point char g e . Draw, in the shad e d are a on the diagr a m , the elect ric field patt e r n due to the two cha r g e s . (2) (Tota l 7 mark s ) 15 3 . This ques tion is abou t power and efficie ncy. A bus is travelling at a const a n t spe e d of 6.2 m s –1 along a section of road that is incline d at an angle of 6.0° to the horizont al. IB Questionbank Physics 227 (a) (i) The bus is rep r e s e n t e d by the black dot show n below. Draw a labelled sketc h to rep r e s e n t the force s acting on the bus. ● (4) (ii) Stat e the value of the rat e of cha n g e of mom e n t u m of the bus. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (b) The total outp u t powe r of the engin e of the bus is 70 kW and the efficiency of the engin e is 35 %. Calcula t e the input powe r to the engin e. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (c) The mas s of the bus is 8.5 × 10 3 kg. Dete r mi n e the rat e of incr e a s e of gravit atio n al poten ti al ene r gy of the bus. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 228 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (d) Using your ans w e r to (c) and the dat a in (b), estim a t e the magni t u d e of the resistive forces acting on the bus. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (e) The engin e of the bus sudd e nly stops workin g. (i) Dete r mi n e the mag nit u d e of the net force opposin g the motion of the bus at the inst an t at which the engin e stops. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) Discus s, with refer e n c e to the air resis t a n c e , the cha n g e in the net force as the bus slows down. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 229 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tot al 17 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 230 15 4 . This ques tion is abou t elect ri ca l resist a n c e . (a) A resis to r of resist a n c e 1.5 Ω is mad e from copp e r wire of radi us 0 .18 mm. The resistivity of coppe r is 1.7 × 10 –8 Ω m. Dete r m i n e the lengt h of copp e r wire used to make the resisto r . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) The man uf a c t u r e r of the resisto r in (a) gua r a n t e e s tha t the resist a n c e is within 10 % of 1.5 Ω , provide d tha t the powe r dissipa tio n in the resisto r does not exce e d 1.0 W. (i) Sugg e s t why the resist a n c e of the resis to r mi ght be gre a t e r tha n 1.65 Ω if the powe r dissipa tion in the resisto r is gre a t e r tha n 1.0 W. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) Show that, for a powe r dissipa tio n of 1.0 W, the curr e n t in a resis to r of resist a n c e 1.5 Ω is 0.82 A. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 231 (1) IB Questionbank Physics 232 (iii) The 1.5 Ω resisto r is conne c t e d in series with a varia bl e resis to r and batt e r y of emf 6.0 V and inte rnal resist a n c e 1.8 Ω. Estim a t e the resist a n c e R of the variabl e resisto r that will limit the curr e n t to 0.82 A. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (Tota l 8 mark s ) 15 5 . This ques tion is abou t stan di n g (station a r y) wave s. The diagr a m repr e s e n t s a stan di n g wave of wavele n g t h λ set up on a string of lengt h L . The string is fixed at both ends. (a) For this stan di n g wave IB Questionbank Physics 233 (i) stat e the relation s hi p betw e e n λ and L. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) label, on the diag r a m , two antino d e s wher e the string is vibratin g in phas e. Label the antinod e s with the lette r A. (2) (b) The stan di n g wave has wavele n g t h λ and frequ e n c y f. Sta t e and explain, with res p e c t to a sta n di n g wave, what is rep r e s e n t e d by the prod u c t f λ. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tota l 6 mark s ) 15 6 . This ques tion is abou t the eye and resolution. A stud e n t meas u r e s the aper t u r e of the iris of one of her eyes as 2.0 mm in sunligh t and 7.0 mm in moonligh t. The inten sity at her eye of sunlight is 106 times grea t e r than the inte n si ty of moonlig h t. (a) (i) Dete r mi n e the following ratio. p ow e ro f lig h te n t e r in tgh ee yein s u n lig h t p o w e rof lig h te n t e r in tgh ee yein m o o n lig h t ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... IB Questionbank Physics 234 .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) IB Questionbank Physics 235 (ii) Sugg e s t why your answ e r in (a)(i) indica t e s that the cha n g e in diam e t e r of the iris is not the princip al mec h a ni s m by which the eye is able to adjus t to differ e n t light inte n sitie s. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (b) (i) Stat e the Rayleigh crite rion. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) Sugg e s t , with refer e n c e to the Rayleig h crite rio n, whe t h e r the ability of the eye to resolve the imag e of two object s is gre a t e r in sunligh t or in moonligh t. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (4) IB Questionbank Physics 236 (c) Outline the differ e n t functions of the rods and the cones on the retin a of the eye in their res po n s e to sunligh t and to moonligh t. Rods: ....................................................................................................... .................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... Cones: ..................................................................................................... ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (4) (Tot al 14 mark s ) 15 7 . This ques tion is abou t the photo el e c t r i c effect. (a) Stat e what is mea n t by the photo el e c t r i c effect. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 237 (b) Light of frequ e n cy 8.7 × 10 14 Hz is incide n t on the surfa c e of a met al in a photocell. The surf ac e area of the met al is 9.0 × 10 –6 m 2 and the inte n sity of the light is 1.1 × 10 –3 W m –2 . (i) Deduc e that the maxim u m possible photo el e c t r i c cur r e n t in the photoc ell is 2.7 nA. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (ii) The maxim u m kinetic ene r gy of photo el e c t r o n s rele a s e d from the met al surfac e is 1.2 eV. Calcula t e the value of the work function of the met al. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (Tota l 5 mark s ) 15 8 . This ques tion is abou t the de Broglie hypot h e si s . (a) Stat e the de Broglie hypot h e si s. ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 238 ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 239 (b) Deter m i n e the de Broglie wavele n g t h of a proto n tha t has bee n accel e r a t e d from rest thro u g h a pote n ti al differe n c e of 1.2 kV. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (c) Explain why a precis e knowle d g e of the de Broglie wavele n g t h of the proto n implies that its position cannot be obs e rv e d. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 6 mark s ) 15 9 . This ques tion is abou t radioa ctive dec ay. 13 Nitrog e n- 13 ( 7 N ) is an isotop e that is use d in medic al diagn osi s. The dec ay cons t a n t of nitrog e n- 13 is 1.2 × 10 –3 s –1 . (a) (i) Define decay cons ta n t . ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 240 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 241 (ii) A sam pl e of nitrog e n- 13 has an initial activity of 800 Bq. The sam pl e canno t be use d for diagno s ti c pur po s e s if its activity beco m e s less than 150 Bq. Dete r m i n e the time it take s for the activity of the sam pl e to fall to 150 Bq. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (b) (i) Calculat e the half- life of nitrog e n- 13 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Outline how the half- life of a sam pl e of nitrog e n- 13 can be meas u r e d in a labor a t o r y. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 242 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) IB Questionbank Physics 243 (c) Nitro g e n- 13 und e r g o e s β + dec ay. Outline the expe ri m e n t a l evide nc e that sugg e s t s anot h e r particle, the neut ri n o, is also emitt e d in the decay. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 9 mark s ) 16 0 . This ques tion is abou t digital sam plin g. (a) A comp a c t disc stor e s music in digit al form. The music is sam pl e d at a frequ e n c y of 44.1 kHz. Each sa m pl e consis t s of two 16- bit wor ds. (i) Stat e what is mean t by digital form. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) The disc stor e s music that takes one hour for playba c k. Dete r mi n e the minim u m num b e r of bits that are stor e d on the disc. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... IB Questionbank Physics 244 .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 245 (b) A pag e from a book has 45 lines of writing. Eac h line of the book has, on aver a g e , 65 lett e r s and spa c e s . The text of the book is to be stor e d on comp a c t disc whe r e eac h lette r or spac e on a line is rep r e s e n t e d by an eight- bit num b e r . Deter m i n e the num b e r of pag e s of text tha t can be stor e d on a comp a c t disc simila r to that in (a). ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 5 mark s ) 16 1 . This ques tion is abou t a digital cam e r a . (a) By refer e n c e to what is mea n t by a pixel, desc ri b e the struc t u r e of a char g e- couple d device (CCD). ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (b) The CCD in a cam e r a has an are a of 16 cm 2 and is divide d into 5.6 meg a pix els. The cam e r a is used to take a photog r a p h with a linea r ma gnific a tion of 0.030. (i) Calculat e the sepa r a t i o n of pixels on the CCD. ......................................................................................................... IB Questionbank Physics 246 .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 247 (ii) Dete r mi n e the minim u m sepa r a ti o n of two point s on an object such that they may be see n sepa r a t e ly on the imag e. Diffrac tio n effect s at the lens may be ignor e d . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tota l 7 mark s ) 16 2 . This ques tion is abou t an oper a tio n a l amplifier (op- amp) circuit. The circuit diagr a m is for a non- inver tin g amplifie r. The oper a ti o n al amplifier is ideal. Calculat e the (a) gain of the amplifier circuit. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 248 ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 249 (b) input pote n ti al V IN at which the amplifier satu r a t e s . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 4 mark s ) 16 3 . This ques tion is abou t a mobile phon e netwo r k. Describ e the role of the cellula r exch a n g e durin g the making of a call from a mobile phon e. ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... (Tota l 4 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 250 16 4 . This ques tion is abou t relativity. Carri e is in a spac es hi p that is travelling towa r d s a sta r in a str ai g h t- line at cons t a n t velocity as obse rv e d by Pete r . Pete r is at rest relative to the sta r. (a) Car ri e meas u r e s her spac e s hi p to have a lengt h of 100 m. Pete r mea s u r e s Carrie’s spac es hi p to have a lengt h of 91 m. (i) Explain why Carrie mea s u r e s the prop e r lengt h of the spa c e s hi p. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Show that Carri e travels at a spe e d of appr oxi m a t e l y 0.4 c relative to Pete r . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (b) Accordi n g to Carri e, it take s the sta r ten year s to rea c h her. Using your ans w e r to (a)(ii), calcula t e the dist a n c e to the sta r as mea s u r e d by Peter . ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 251 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 252 (c) Accordi n g to Pete r, as Carrie pas s e s the sta r she send s a radio signal. Deter m i n e the time, as mea s u r e d by Carri e, for the mes s a g e to reac h Pete r . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tota l 8 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 253 16 5 . This ques tion is abou t a light clock. Describ e the principle of a light clock. ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... (Tota l 2 mark s ) 16 6 . This ques tion is abou t qua r k s. The quar k cont e n t of a π + meso n includ e s an up qua r k. The Feyn m a n diagr a m repr e s e n t s the decay of a π + meso n. IB Questionbank Physics 254 (a) Identify the par ticles labelle d A and B. A: ............................................................................................................. .................... B: ............................................................................................................. .................... (2) (b) Stat e, with refer e n c e to their prop e r t i e s , two differ e n c e s betw e e n a photon and a W boson. 1. ............................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... 2. ............................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (c) The appr oxi m a t e rang e of the weak inte r a c ti o n is 10 –18 m. Dete r mi n e , in kg, the likely mass of the W boson. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 6 mark s ) 16 7 . This ques tion is abou t stra n g e n e s s . (a) Outline two prop e r t i e s of str a n g e n e s s . 1. ............................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 255 ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... 2. ............................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 256 (b) The following particle inte r a c ti o n is propos e d . p + π – → K– + π + In this inter a c ti o n, char g e is cons e r v e d . Stat e, in ter m s of baryo n and stra n g e n e s s cons e rv a t i o n, whet h e r the inter a c ti o n is possible. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 4 mark s ) 16 8 . This ques tion is abou t the prope r ti e s of a sta r. (a) Descri b e what is mean t by a (i) cons t ella tio n. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) stellar clust e r . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 257 (b) Some dat a for the variabl e sta r Betelg e u s e are given below. Avera g e absolut e ma gni t u d e Avera g e appa r e n t mag nit u d e Avera g e appa r e n t brigh t n e s s Radius = 790 solar radii = –5.1 = + 0.60 = 1.6 × 10 –7 W m –2 The luminosity of the Sun is 3.8 × 10 26 W and it has a surfa c e tem p e r a t u r e of 5700 K. (i) Show that the dista n c e from Eart h to Betelge u s e is about 4.0 × 10 18 m. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (ii) Dete r mi n e , in ter m s of the luminosity of the Sun, the luminosity of Betelg e u s e . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (iii) Calculat e the surfac e tem p e r a t u r e of Betelg e u s e . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... IB Questionbank Physics 258 .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (c) On the Hertzs p r u n g–R u s s e ll diagr a m above, (i) label the position of Betelg e u s e with the lette r B. (1) (ii) sketc h the position of main sequ e n c e star s. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 259 (d) Some star s, such as Betelg e u s e , are in combi n a tio n with a comp a nio n sta r formin g a spect r o s c o pi c bina ry syste m . Descri b e and explain the char a c t e r i s ti c s of a spect r o s c o pi c bina ry syste m . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tot al 15 mark s ) 16 9 . A force F is applied to a body moving along a str ai g h t line. A resis tive force f acts on the body. Both forces act along the sam e straig h t line as the motion of the body. The rat e of chan g e of mom e n t u m of the body is equal to A. F – f. B. F. C. F + f. D. f. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 260 17 0 . The diagr a m below show s a unifor m elect ri c field of str e n g t h E. The field is in a vacuu m . An elect r o n ente r s the field with a velocity v in the dire c tion show n. The elect r o n is moving in the plan e of the pape r . The path followe d by the elect r o n will be A. par a b olic. B. in the directio n of E. C. in the directio n of v . D. circul a r. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 17 1 . A space c r af t moves from point X to point Y in the gravit a tion a l field of Eart h. At point X, the gravit a tion a l pote n ti al is –14 MJ kg –1 . At point Y, the gravit a tion al poten t i al is –2 MJ kg –1 . Which of the following desc ri b e s the direction of the motion of the spac e c r a f t rela tive to Eart h and the cha n g e in gravit a tion al poten t i al? Dire c t i o n of Moti o n Chan g e in gravit a t i o n a l pot e n t i a l A. towa r d s Eart h +1 2 MJ kg –1 B. towa r d s Eart h –12 MJ kg –1 C. away from Eart h +1 2 MJ kg –1 D. away from Eart h –12 MJ kg –1 (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 261 17 2 . A space c r af t is in orbit at a dista n c e r from the cent r e of the Eart h. The engine of the space c r af t is fired and it moves to a new orbit of radi us 2 r. Which of the following desc ri b e s the varia tio n s in kine tic ene r gy and total ene r gy of the space c r af t ? Kin e t i c en e r g y Tot al en e r g y A. decr e a s e incr e a s e B. decr e a s e decr e a s e C. incr e a s e incr e a s e D. incr e a s e decr e a s e (Tot al 1 mar k ) 17 3 . The volum e of an ideal gas in a cont ai n e r is incre a s e d at const a n t tem p e r a t u r e . Which of the following sta t e m e n t s is/ar e cor r e c t abou t the molecul e s of the gas? I. Their spee d rem ai n s const a n t . II. The frequ e n cy of collisions of molec ul e s with unit are a of the cont ai n e r wall decr e a s e s . III. The force betw e e n the m dec r e a s e s . A. I only B. I and II only C. I and III only D. II and III only (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 262 17 4 . During an adiab a tic expa n sio n, a gas does 50 J of work agains t the sur r o u n di n g s . It is then cooled at cons t a n t volum e by removing 20 J of ene r gy from the gas. The mag nit u d e of the total cha n g e in inte r n a l ene r gy of the gas is A. 70 J. B. 50 J. C. 30 J. D. 20 J. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 17 5 . The diagr a m shows the pres s u r e volum e relations hi p for a fixed mas s of an ideal gas that unde r g o e s a cycle XYZ. In which part(s) of the cycle is exte r n a l work done on the gas? A. Y → Z only B. Y → Z and Z → X only C. X → Y and Z → X only D. X → Y only (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 263 17 6 . A string vibrat e s with fund a m e n t a l frequ e n c y f. The wavele n g t h of the soun d produ c e d in air is λ. Which of the following cor r e c tly gives the frequ e n c y of vibration of the fourt h har m o ni c of the string and the wavele n g t h of the sound in air? Freq u e n c y Wave l e n g t h A. f 2 λ 4 B. 4 f 4λ C. f 2 4λ D. 4 f λ 4 (Tot al 1 mar k ) 17 7 . A rada r spee d gun is used to me a s u r e the spee d of a car. The car is moving with spee d v away from the gun. The rada r emits microw av e s of frequ e n c y f and spe e d c . Which of the following is the frequ e n cy of the microw a v e s mea s u r e d at the gun afte r reflection by the car? A. 2v f c f + B. v f f + c C. 2v f f – c D. v f f – c (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 264 17 8 . An optically active subs t a n c e A. compl et ely absor b s polariz e d light. B. unpol arize s polarized light. C. polarize s unpola riz e d light. D. rotat e s the plane of polariz a tion. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 17 9 . The diagr a m below show s two identic al filame n t lamps sepa r a t e d by a small dista n c e. Light from the lamps is incide n t on a nar r o w slit behin d a gree n filter. The slit is par allel to the filame n t of eac h lamp. A photog r a p h is taken of the lamps throu g h the slit. The imag e s of the filam e n t s on the photog r a p h are just resolve d. The gre e n filter is replac e d by a red filter and the n by a violet filter. For each filter a photog r a p h is take n of the lamps throu g h the slit. Which of the following corr e c tly describ e s the resolution of the imag e s using a red and using a violet filter? Red filt er Viol e t filt e r A. resolve d resolve d B. resolve d not resolve d C. not resolve d resolve d D. not resolve d not resolve d (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 265 18 0 . Two resis to r s , of resis t a n c e R 1 and R 2 , are conn e c t e d in serie s with a cell of emf ε and negligibl e inter n al resist a n c e . Which expr e s si o n gives the pote n ti al differe n c e acros s the resis to r of resis t a n c e R 1 ? A. R1 R1 R 2 ε B. R1 R 2 R1 ε C. R2 R1 R 2 ε D. R1 R 2 R2 ε (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 266 18 1 . The gra p h shows the variation with time t of the mag n e t i c flux φ thro u g h a coil that is rotati n g in a unifor m magn e t i c field. The mag ni t u d e of the emf induc e d acros s the ends of the coil is maxim u m at time(s) A. t 1 and t 3 . B. t 2 and t 4 . C. t 3 only. D. t 4 only. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 18 2 . The rms cur r e n t ratin g of an elect ric hea t e r is 4 A. What direc t cur r e n t would produ c e the sam e powe r dissipa tio n in the elect ric hea t e r ? 4 A A. 2 B. 4 A C. 4 2A D. 8 A (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 267 18 3 . Two sam pl e s of radioa ctiv e subs t a n c e s X and Y have the sam e initial activity. The half- life of X is T and the half- life of Y is 3 T . After a time of 3 T the ratio a c t ivit of y s u b s t a n cX e a c t ivit of y s u b s t a n cY e is A. 8. B. 4. C. 1 4. D. 1 8. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 18 4 . In a fission reaction, the total mas s and the total binding ene r gy befor e the reaction are M i and E i res p e c t ively, whe r e the binding ene r gy is define d as a positive quan tity. After the rea c tion the total mas s is M f and the total bindin g ener gy is E f . Which of the following corr e c tly comp a r e s the total mas s e s and the total binding ene r gi e s ? Total ma s s Total bindi n g en e r g y A. Mf > Mi Ef < Ei B. Mf > Mi Ef > Ei C. Mf < Mi Ef < Ei D. Mf < Mi Ef > Ei (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 268 18 5 . Monoc h r o m a t i c light is incide n t on a met al surf ac e and elect r o n s are relea s e d . The intensi ty of the incide n t light is incre a s e d . What cha n g e s , if any, occur in the rat e of emission of elect r o n s and the kinetic ene r gy of the emitt e d elect r o n s ? Rat e of emi s s i o n of el e c t r o n s Kin e t i c en e r g y of th e e m i t t e d el e c t r o n s A. incr e a s e incr e a s e B. decr e a s e no cha n g e C. decr e a s e incr e a s e D. incr e a s e no cha n g e (Tot al 1 mar k ) 18 6 . An elect r o n is confine d to move in one dim e n sio n in a box of lengt h L . Which of the following gives the mom e n t u m of the elect r o n in its lowes t ene r gy stat e? A. h 4L B. h 2L C. h L D. 2h L (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 269 18 7 . The diagr a m below show s som e of the ene r gy levels availa ble to an elect r o n in a caesiu m atom. Photon s of ener gy 0.9 eV pass thro u g h a sa m pl e of low pres s u r e caesiu m vapou r . Which of the following gives the ene r gy tra n si tion of the elect r o n when a photon is abso r b e d ? A. From –3.9 eV to 0 B. From –2.5 eV to –1.6 eV C. From –1.6 eV to –2.5 eV D. From 0 to –3.9 eV (Tot al 1 mar k ) 18 8 . The mag ni t u d e of the unce r t a i n t y in the position of a par ticle is equal to the de Broglie wavel en g t h of the particl e. Which of the following is the minim u m unce r t a i n t y in the mom e n t u m p of the par ticle? A. p 4π B. 4π p C. h p D. p h (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 270 18 9 . Which of the following provide s evide n c e for the qua n tiz a tio n of nucle a r ene r gy levels? I. Alpha particle s have discr e t e value s of kinetic ene r gi e s II. Gam m a- ray photo n s have discr e t e ene r gi e s III. Atomic line emission spec t r a A. I only B. II only C. I and II only D. I, II and III (Tot al 1 mar k ) 19 0 . A radioac tive subs t a n c e S has a dec ay const a n t λ S , subs t a n c e T has a dec ay cons t a n t λ T . Initially, a sam pl e of S cont ai n s N S nuclei and a sa m pl e of T cont ai n s N T nuclei. The initial activity of both sam pl e s is the sam e . NS The ratio N T is A. 1 B. λS λT C. λT λS D. λSλT (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 271 19 1 . Which of the following desc ri b e s the role of the atmos p h e r e in the gree n h o u s e effect? A. The atm os p h e r e is tran s p a r e n t to all solar radia tio n. B. The atm os p h e r e absor b s infrar e d radia tio n from the grou n d. C. The atm os p h e r e scat t e r s red light more tha n blue light. D. Clouds in the atmos p h e r e preve n t abso r p t io n of infra r e d radia tion. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 19 2 . What is the value of the bina ry num b e r 1100 1 in decim al nota tion? A. 50 B. 38 C. 25 D. 19 (Tot al 1 mar k ) 19 3 . A CCD cam e r a is used to capt u r e the image of a paintin g. The are a of the paintin g is 2.0 m 2 and the are a of the imag e is 50 mm 2 . Which of the following is the linear mag nific a tion of the imag e ? A. 2.5 × 10 –5 B. 5.0 × 10 –3 C. 2.0 × 10 2 D. 4.0 × 10 4 (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 272 19 4 . An analog u e signal is sam pl e d at time inte rval s t . Each sam pl e is conve r t e d to a digital num b e r having n bits. What is the total num b e r of bits produ c e d in a time T ? A. nT t B. nt T C. ntT D. n Tt (Tot al 1 mar k ) 19 5 . Data analysis ques tion. The spee d v of waves on the surfa c e of dee p wate r dep e n d s only on the wavele n g t h λ of the waves. The dat a gath e r e d from a par tic ul a r region of the Atlantic Ocea n are plott e d below. The unce r t a i n t y in the speed v is ±0. 3 0 m s –1 and the unc e r t a i n t y in λ is too small to be show n on the diagr a m . IB Questionbank Physics 273 (a) Draw a best- fit line for the data. (1) (b) Stat e, with refer e n c e to the line you have dra w n in (a), (i) why v is not directly propo r tio n a l to λ. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) the value of v for λ = 39 m. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (c) It is sugg e s t e d that the rela tion s hi p betw e e n v and λ is of the form v = a λ whe r e a is a const a n t . To test the validity of this hypot h e s i s, values of v 2 agains t λ are plott e d below. IB Questionbank Physics 274 (i) Use your answ e r to (b)(ii) to show tha t the absolut e unc e r t a i n t y in v 2 for a wavele n g t h of 39 m is ±5 m 2 s –2 . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (ii) The absolut e uncer t a i n t y in v 2 for a wavele n g t h of 2.5 m is ±1 m 2 s –2 . Using this value and the value in (c)(i), const r u c t error bar s for v 2 at the dat a points for λ = 2.5 m and 39 m. (1) (iii) Stat e why the plott e d dat a in (c)(ii) sugg e s t tha t it is likely tha t v is propo r tio n al to λ. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (iv) Use the grap h above to det e r m i n e the cons t a n t a . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... IB Questionbank Physics 275 .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) IB Questionbank Physics 276 (v) Theory shows that a = k 2 π . Dete r mi n e a value for k . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (Tot al 12 mark s ) 19 6 . This ques tion is abou t kine m a t i c s. Lucy stan d s on the edg e of a vertic al cliff and throw s a ston e vertic ally upwa r d s . The stone leaves her han d with a spe e d of 15 m s –1 at the insta n t her hand is 80 m above the surfac e of the sea. Air resist a n c e is negligibl e and the accele r a ti o n of free fall is 10 m s –2 . (a) Calcula t e the maxim u m heigh t rea c h e d by the ston e as me a s u r e d from the point wher e it is throw n. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 277 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 278 (b) Deter m i n e the time for the stone to rea c h the surfa c e of the sea afte r leaving Lucy’s hand. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tota l 5 mark s ) 19 7 . This ques tion is abou t inter n al ene r gy and the r m a l ene r gy (hea t). (a) Disting ui s h betw e e n inter n a l ene r gy and the r m a l ene r gy. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (b) A piece of iron is place d in a kiln until it rea c h e s the tem p e r a t u r e θ of the kiln. The iron is then quickly tra n sf e r r e d to wat e r held in a ther m ally insulat e d cont ai n e r . The wat e r is stirr e d until it rea c h e s a ste a dy tem p e r a t u r e . The following data are availa bl e. Ther m al capa city of the piece of iron IB Questionbank Physics = 60 J 279 K–1 Ther m al capa city of the wate r 10 3 J K –1 Initial tem p e r a t u r e of the wat e r Final tem p e r a t u r e of the wat e r = 2.0 × = 16 °C = 45 °C The ther m al capa ci ty of the cont ai n e r and insula tion is negligible. IB Questionbank Physics 280 (i) Stat e an expr e s s io n, in ter m s of θ and the above dat a, for the ene r gy tran sf e r of the iron in cooling from the tem p e r a t u r e of the kiln to the final tem p e r a t u r e of the wat e r . ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Calculat e the incre a s e in inte r n a l ene r gy of the wat e r as the iron cools in the wat e r . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (iii) Use your answ e r s to (b)(i) and (b)(ii) to det e r m i n e θ. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tota l 7 mark s ) 19 8 . This ques tion is abou t the unified atomic mass unit and a nucle a r rea c tio n. (a) Define the ter m unified atomic mas s unit . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (b) The mas s of a nucleu s of rut h e rf o r di u m- 254 is 254.1 0 0 1 u. Calcula t e the mas s in GeV c –2 . IB Questionbank Physics 281 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 282 (c) In 1919, Ruthe r fo r d produ c e d the first artificial nucle a r tra n s m u t a t i o n by bomb a r di n g nitrog e n with α-par ticle s. The rea c tion is repr e s e n t e d by the following equ atio n. α+ (i) 14 7N 17 8O + X Identify X. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) The following dat a are availa bl e for the rea c tio n. Rest mass of α Rest mass of 14 7N Rest mass of 17 8O = 3.742 8 GeV c –2 = 13.09 4 2 GeV c –2 + X = 16.83 8 3 GeV c –2 The initial kinetic ene r gy of the α-par ticle is 7.68 MeV. Dete r mi n e the sum of the kinetic ene r gi e s of the oxyge n nucle u s and X. (Assu m e that the nitrog e n nucle u s is station a r y.) ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (Tota l 6 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 283 19 9 . This ques tion is abou t chan g e s of stat e of a gas. (a) A cylinde r fitted with a piston cont ai ns 0.23 mol of heliu m gas. The following data are availa ble for the heliu m with the piston in the position show n. Volume Press u r e Temp e r a t u r e (i) = 5.2 × 10 –3 m 3 = 1.0 × 10 5 Pa = 290 K Use the dat a to calcula t e a value for the univer s a l gas const a n t . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) Stat e the assu m p t io n mad e in the calcul a tio n in (a)(i). ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (b) The gas is now comp r e s s e d isothe r m a lly by the piston so that the volum e of the gas is red uc e d . Explain why the comp r e s s i o n must be car ri e d out slowly. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 284 ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 285 (c) After the comp r e s s i o n, the gas is now allowe d to expa n d adia b a ti c a lly to its original volum e. Use the first law of the r m o dy n a m i c s to explain whet h e r the final tem p e r a t u r e will be less tha n, equal to or gre a t e r than 290 K. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (4) (Tota l 9 mark s ) 20 0 . This ques tion is abou t the emf induc e d in a coil. (a) Define magn e t i c flux . ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 286 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 287 (b) A coil is rotat e d at const a n t spee d in a region of unifor m ma g n e ti c field. The grap h shows the variatio n with time t of the emf ε induc e d in the coil for one cycle of rota tio n. (i) On the grap h label, with the lette r T, a time at which the flux linkag e in the coil is a maxim u m . (1) (ii) Use the grap h to dete r m i n e the rat e of cha n g e of flux at t = 4.0 ms. Explain your answ e r . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (iii) Calculat e the root me a n squ a r e value of the induc e d emf. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... IB Questionbank Physics 288 .................. (1) (Tota l 6 mark s ) 20 1 . This ques tion is abou t elect ri c cha r g e and resis t a n c e . (a) A plastic rod XY is held at end X. The end Y is rubb e d with a piec e of cloth and, as a res ult, the end Y beco m e s elect ric ally cha r g e d . The proce d u r e is now rep e a t e d using a coppe r rod and it is found tha t the copp e r rod rem ai n s elect ric ally neut r a l. Explain thes e obse rv a tio n s in ter m s of the prop e r ti e s of cond u c t o r s and insulat o r s . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (5) IB Questionbank Physics 289 (b) Two plastic rods each have a positive char g e + q situa t e d at one end. The rods are arr a n g e d as show n. Assum e that the char g e at the end of eac h rod beha v e s as a point char g e . Draw, in the shad e d are a on the diagr a m (i) the elect ric field patt e r n due to the two cha r g e s . (2) (ii) a line to repr e s e n t an equipot e n ti a l surfa c e. Label the line with the lett e r V. (1) (c) A resis to r of resist a n c e 1.5 Ω is mad e from copp e r wire of radi us 0 .18 mm. The resistivity of coppe r is 1.7 × 10 –8 Ω m. Dete r m i n e the lengt h of copp e r wire used to make the resisto r . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 290 (2) IB Questionbank Physics 291 (d) The man uf a c t u r e r of the resisto r in (c) gua r a n t e e s tha t the resist a n c e is within 10 % of 1.5 Ω , provide d tha t the powe r dissipa tio n in the resisto r does not exce e d 1.0 W. (i) Sugg e s t why the resist a n c e of the resis to r might be gre a t e r tha n 1.65 Ω if the powe r dissipa tion in the resisto r is gre a t e r tha n 1.0 W. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) Show that, for a powe r dissipa tio n of 1.0 W, the curr e n t in a resis to r of resist a n c e 1.5 Ω is 0.82 A. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 292 (iii) The 1.5 Ω resisto r is conn e c t e d in seri es with a varia bl e resis to r and batt e r y of emf 6.0 V and inte r n a l resist a n c e 1.8 Ω. Estim a t e the resist a n c e R of the variabl e resisto r that will limit the curr e n t to 0.82 A. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (Tot al 16 mark s ) 20 2 . This ques tion is abou t orbit al motion. (a) A satellite, of mass m , is in orbit about Eart h at a dista n c e r from the cent r e of Eart h. Deduc e that the kinetic ene r gy E K of the sat ellite is equal to half the magni t u d e of the pote n ti al ene r gy E P of the satellite. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 293 ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 294 (b) The grap h shows the variatio n with dist a n c e r of the Eart h’s gravit atio n al poten ti al V . Values of V for r < R , whe r e R is the radius of Eart h, are not show n. The satellite in (a) has a mas s of 8.2 × 10 2 kg and it is in orbit at a dista n c e of 1.0 × 10 7 m from the cent r e of Eart h. Using data from the grap h and your ans w e r to (a), calcula t e for the satellite (i) its total ene r gy. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) its orbit al spee d. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 295 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 296 (iii) the ener gy it mus t gain to move to an orbit a dista n c e 2.0 × 10 7 m from the cent r e of the Eart h. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tota l 9 mark s ) 20 3 . This ques tion is abou t power prod u c tio n and global war mi n g. (a) In any cyclical proc es s design e d to continu o u s ly conve r t the r m a l ener gy to work, some ene r gy is always deg r a d e d . Explain what is mea n t by degr a d e d ener gy. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) A nuclea r powe r station uses ura ni u m- 235 (U- 235) as fuel. Outline the (i) proce s s e s and ener gy chan g e s that occur thro u g h which the r m a l ene r gy is produ c e d . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 297 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (4) (ii) role of the heat exch a n g e r of the rea c t o r and the tur bi n e in the gen e r a t io n of elect ric al ene r gy. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (c) Identify on e proce s s in the powe r station whe r e ene r gy is degr a d e d . ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (d) The maxim u m powe r outp u t of the Drax coal- fired powe r station in the UK is 4.0 GW. Dete r mi n e the minim u m mas s of pur e U-235 that would be requir e d by a nuclea r powe r sta tion to provide the sam e maxim u m annu al ener gy outpu t as the Drax powe r station. IB Questionbank Physics 298 Ener gy density of U-235 = 82 TJ kg –1 1 year = 3.2 × 10 7 s ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 299 (e) It has bee n sugg e s t e d that the prod u c tio n of gre e n h o u s e gas e s by coal- fired powe r station s has incre a s e d global war mi n g . One piec e of eviden c e to suppo r t this sugg e s ti o n is the incre a s e in sea- level due to an incr e a s e in tem p e r a t u r e of the ocea n s . Over the past 100 yea rs it is sugg e s t e d that sea- levels have rise n by 6.4 × 10 –2 m due to volum e expan si o n. Using the following dat a, det e r m i n e the aver a g e rise in tem p e r a t u r e in the top levels of the ocea n s in the last 100 years. Mean dept h of ocea n s that is affect e d by global war mi n g 4.0 × 10 2 m Coefficien t of volum e expa n sio n of sea wat e r 5.1 × 10 –5 K–1 = = ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tot al 15 mark s ) 20 4 . This ques tion is abou t char g e- couple d device (CCD). (a) Stat e two advan t a g e s of storing infor m a ti o n in a digit al form rat h e r than an analog u e form. 1. ............................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... 2. ............................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 300 ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 301 (b) A CCD is effectively a silicon chip that is divide d into small are a s called pixels. Each pixel is provide d with elect r o d e s . Outline how light incide n t on a pixel prod u c e s a chan g e in pote n t i al differ e n c e acros s the pixel. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (c) Light of frequ e n cy 7.2 × 10 14 Hz and inte n si ty 1.6 mW m –2 is incide n t on a pixel for a time of 18 ms. The are a of the pixel is 2.0 × 10 –10 m 2 and its capacit a n c e is 12 pF. The res ultin g cha n g e in pote n ti al differ e n c e acros s the pixel is 10 μV. (i) Deduc e that the num b e r of photo n s incide n t on the pixel is 1.2 × 10 4 . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) Dete r mi n e the quan t u m efficiency of the pixel. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 302 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (Tot al 10 mark s ) 20 5 . This ques tion is abou t power and efficie ncy. A bus is travelling at a const a n t spe e d of 6.2 m s –1 along a section of road that is incline d at an angle of 6.0° to the horizont al. (a) (i) The bus is rep r e s e n t e d by the black dot show n below. Draw a labelled sketc h to rep r e s e n t the force s acting on the bus. ● (4) (ii) Stat e the value of the rat e of cha n g e of mom e n t u m of the bus. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 303 (b) The total outp u t powe r of the engin e of the bus is 70 kW and the efficiency of the engin e is 35 %. Calcula t e the input powe r to the engin e. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 304 (c) The mas s of the bus is 8.5 × 10 3 kg. Dete r mi n e the rat e of incr e a s e of gravit atio n al poten ti al ene r gy of the bus. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (d) Using your ans w e r to (c) and the dat a in (b), estim a t e the magni t u d e of the resistive forces acting on the bus. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tot al 13 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 305 20 6 . This ques tion is abou t photo el e c t r i c effect and de Broglie wavele n g t h . The diagr a m is a rep r e s e n t a t i o n of appa r a t u s use d to study the photo el e c t r i c effect. Light from the monoc h r o m a t i c sour c e is incide n t on a catho d e plac e d in an evacu a t e d tube. A variable voltag e supply is conn e c t e d betw e e n anod e and catho d e and the photo el e c t r i c cur r e n t is regis t e r e d by the micro a m m e t e r . The sketc h gra p h shows how the photoel e c t ri c cur r e n t I varies with the pote n ti al differe n c e V betw e e n anod e and catho d e for two sour c e s of light, A and B, of differ e n t frequ e n ci e s and intensi ti es. IB Questionbank Physics 306 (a) Explain with refer e n c e to the Einst ei n model, which gra p h, A or B, corr es p o n d s to the light with the gre a t e r frequ e n c y. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (4) (b) The frequ e n c y of the light that prod u c e s gra p h A is 8.8 × 10 14 Hz. The magni t u d e of V A is 1.6 V. (i) Stat e the value of the maxim u m ene r gy, in eV, of the elec t r o n s emitt e d from the catho d e . ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Dete r mi n e the work function, in eV, of the surfa c e of the catho d e . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... IB Questionbank Physics 307 .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 308 (c) The frequ e n c y of the incide n t light is incr e a s e d but the inte n sity rem ai n s const a n t . Explain why this incr e a s e in frequ e n c y res ult s in a cha n g e to the maxim u m photo el e c t r i c cur r e n t (satu r a ti o n cur r e n t ) . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (d) The elect r o n s emitt e d from the photo- catho d e have an associa t e d de Broglie wavele n g t h . Descri b e what is mean t by the de Broglie wavele n g t h . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tot al 12 mark s ) 20 7 . This ques tion is abou t simple har m o ni c motion (SHM), wave motion and polarization. (a) By refer e n c e to simple har m o ni c motion, stat e wha t is mea n t by amplit u d e. ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 309 ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 310 (b) A liquid is cont ain e d in a U-tube. Dia g r a m 1 Dia gr a m 2 The pres s u r e on the liquid in one side of the tube is incr e a s e d so tha t the liquid is displac e d as show n in diag r a m 2. Whe n the pres s u r e is sudd e nly relea s e d the liquid oscillat e s . The dam pi n g of the oscillation s is small. (i) Describ e what is mea n t by da m pi n g. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) The displac e m e n t of the liquid surfa c e from its equilibri u m position is x . The accele r a ti o n a of the liquid in the tube is given by the expr e s si o n a = 2g x l wher e g is the accele r a t io n of free fall and l is the total lengt h of the liquid colum n. Explain, with refer e n c e to the motion of the liquid, the significan c e of the minus sign. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 311 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (iii) The total lengt h of the liquid colum n in the tube is 0.32 m. Dete r mi n e the period of oscillation. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (c) A wave is travelling along a strin g. The string can be modelle d as a single line of particles and each particl e execu t e s simple har m o ni c motion. The period of oscillation of the particle s is 0.80 s. The grap h shows the displa c e m e n t y of par t of the string at time t = 0. The dist an c e along the string is d. IB Questionbank Physics 312 (i) On the grap h, draw an arro w to show the dire c tion of motion of par ticl e P at the point mark e d on the string. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 313 (ii) Dete r mi n e the mag nit u d e of the velocity of particle P. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (4) (iii) Show that the spee d of the wave is 5.0 m s –1 . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (iv) On the grap h above, label with the lette r X the position of par ticl e P at t = 0.40 s. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 314 (d) The string in (c) is fixed at both ends and is mad e to vibra t e in a vertical plane in its first har m o ni c. (i) Describ e how the stan di n g wave in the string gives rise to the first har m o ni c. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (ii) Outline how a travelling wave in a string can be use d to desc rib e the nat u r e of polarize d light. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) IB Questionbank Physics 315 (e) James is weari n g polarize d sungl a s s e s and views the sunlight reflect e d from the smoot h surf ac e of a lake. The angle θ is the angle betw e e n the surfa c e of the lake and Jame s’s line of sight. Calcula t e the value of θ at which the reflec t e d sunlight from the surfac e is minimize d. The refra ctive index of the wate r is 1.3. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tot al 25 mark s ) 20 8 . This ques tion is abou t the prope r ti e s of a sta r. (a) Descri b e what is mean t by a (i) cons t ella tio n. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 316 (ii) stellar clust e r . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 317 (b) Some dat a for the variabl e sta r Betelg e u s e are given below. Avera g e absolut e ma gni t u d e Avera g e appa r e n t mag nit u d e Avera g e appa r e n t brigh t n e s s Radius = 790 solar radii = –5.1 = + 0.60 = 1.6 × 10 –7 W m –2 The luminosity of the Sun is 3.8 × 10 26 W and it has a surfa c e tem p e r a t u r e of 5700 K. (i) Show that the dista n c e from Eart h to Betelge u s e is about 4.0 × 10 18 m. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (ii) Dete r mi n e , in ter m s of the luminosity of the Sun, the luminosity of Betelg e u s e . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (iii) Calculat e the surfac e tem p e r a t u r e of Betelg e u s e . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... IB Questionbank Physics 318 .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (c) On the Hertzs p r u n g–R u s s e ll diagr a m above, (i) label the position of Betelg e u s e with the lette r B. (1) (ii) sketc h Betelge u s e’s likely evolution a r y path. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 319 (d) Some star s, such as Betelg e u s e , are in combi n a tio n with a comp a nio n sta r formin g a spect r o s c o pi c bina ry syste m . Descri b e and explain the char a c t e r i s ti c s of a spect r o s c o pi c bina ry syste m . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tot al 15 mark s ) 20 9 . This ques tion is abou t the density of the unive r s e . (a) Explain, with refer e n c e to the possible fate of the unive r s e , the significan c e of the critical density of matt e r in the univer s e . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 320 (b) Sugg e s t on e reas o n why it is difficult to estim a t e the density of mat t e r in the univer s e. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 5 mark s ) 21 0 . This ques tion is abou t the evolution of sta r s. (a) Stat e what is mea n t by the (i) Chan d r a s e k h a r limit. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Oppe n h ei m e r –Volkoff limit. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 321 (b) Sugg e s t how your ans w e r s in (a) can be use d to pre dic t the fate of a main sequ e n c e star. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tota l 5 mark s ) 21 1 . This ques tion is abou t the Hubbl e cons t a n t . (a) Outline the mea s u r e m e n t s that mus t be take n in orde r to dete r m i n e a value for the Hubbl e const a n t . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 322 (b) One esti m a t e of the Hubbl e const a n t is 60 km s –1 Mpc –1 . Cygnus A is a radio galaxy at a dist an c e of 6.0 × 10 8 ly from Eart h. Calcula t e , in km s –1 , the rece s sio n al spee d of Cygnus A rela tive to the Eart h. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 5 mark s ) 21 2 . This ques tion is abou t modula tio n. (a) Outline what is mean t by the modula tio n of a wave. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) The frequ e n c y spect r u m of the signal from a radio tra n s m i t t e r is show n below. IB Questionbank Physics 323 (i) Stat e the nam e of this form of radio tra n s m i s sio n. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Stat e the frequ e n c y of the car rie r wave. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (iii) Dete r mi n e the band wi d t h of this signal. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (Tota l 5 mark s ) 21 3 . This ques tion is abou t a mobile phon e netwo r k. Describ e the role of the cellula r exch a n g e durin g the making of a call from a mobile phon e. ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... (Tota l 4 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 324 IB Questionbank Physics 325 21 4 . This ques tion is abou t the tran s m i s s io n of signals. The signal from a micro p h o n e is amplified and the n tra ns m i t t e d to a dista n t receive r. The variation with time t of the amplified signal befor e tran s m i s si o n is show n below. (a) The amplified signal is tran s m i t t e d using a coaxial cable as illust r a t e d . On the axes below, sketc h the wavefor m of the signal at point X afte r tran s m i s sio n along the coaxial cable. (3) IB Questionbank Physics 326 (b) A secon d tran s m i s sio n syste m , as show n below, uses a cable cont ai nin g many sepa r a t e fibre s (multi- core optic cable). (i) Sugg e s t why a multi- core optic cable is requi r e d rath e r tha n a single- core optic fibre. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Stat e what circuit s should be includ e d in the tra n s m i s sio n syste m so that a single- core optic fibre may be use d. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 327 (c) The receive d signal of the secon d tra n s m i s s io n syste m is show n below. Calcula t e the (i) minim u m num b e r of outp u t bits of the ADC. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) sam plin g frequ e n c y of the ADC. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (d) Stat e on e adva n t a g e and on e disa dva n t a g e of the coaxial cable tran s m i s sio n as comp a r e d with the fibre optic cable. Advant a g e : .............................................................................................. .................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... Disadv a n t a g e : ......................................................................................... ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 328 ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tot al 11 mark s ) 21 5 . This ques tion is abou t signal powe r and atte n u a t i o n. An optic fibre in a telep h o n e syste m has lengt h 48 km. The noise powe r in the optic fibre is 2.5 × 10 –18 W. (a) The signal- to- noise ratio is not to fall below 25 dB. Show that the minim u m signal power in the fibre is 7.9 × 10 –16 W. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) The att e n u a t i o n per unit lengt h of the signal in the fibre is 2.7 dB km – 1 . Use the data in (a) to dete r m i n e the powe r of the input signal to the fibre so that the signal- to- noise ratio does not fall below 25 dB. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 4 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 329 21 6 . This ques tion is abou t an oper a tio n a l amplifier (op- amp) circuit. The diagr a m shows an incom pl e t e circ uit. The oper a ti o n al amplifier is ideal. (a) On the incom pl e t e diag r a m above, desig n a circ uit for a non- inver tin g amplifier. (2) (b) Calcula t e the (i) gain of the amplifier circuit. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) input poten ti al V IN at which the amplifie r satu r a t e s . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 330 (2) (Tota l 6 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 331 21 7 . This ques tion is abou t prope r ti e s of elect r o m a g n e t i c waves. (a) Stat e two prop e r t i e s that are com m o n to all elect r o m a g n e t i c waves. 1. ............................................................................................................. ..................... 2. ............................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) A single lens is used to form a mag nifie d real imag e of an objec t. Explain, with refer e n c e to the dispe r sio n of light, why the imag e has colour e d edg e s. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (c) Outline why a clear sky is blue in colour. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 7 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 332 21 8 . This ques tion is abou t a conve r gi n g lens. (a) Define angular magnificatio n . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) A thin conver gi n g lens of focal lengt h 4.5 cm is to be use d as a magnifying glass. The obse rv e r places the lens close to her eye. The leas t dista n c e of distinct vision is 24 cm. (i) Show that the dista n c e of the object from the lens is 3.8 cm. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Dete r mi n e the ang ul a r ma g nific a tio n prod u c e d by the lens. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 333 ......................................................................................................... .................. (4) IB Questionbank Physics 334 (c) Sugg e s t two reas o n s why, for high mag nifica tion s , a combin a tio n of lens e s is used rath e r than a single lens. 1. ............................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... 2. ............................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 9 mark s ) 21 9 . This ques tion is abou t interf e r e n c e of light. Two coher e n t nar r o w bea m s of light pass throu g h two identic al evac u a t e d tubes, as show n below. The two coher e n t nar r o w beam s are brou g h t to a focus at point P on a scre e n . (a) Stat e what is mea n t by cohe r e n c e . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (b) Stat e, with refer e n c e to the wavele n g t h , the condition tha t must be satisfied for a brigh t fringe to be form e d on the scre e n at point P. IB Questionbank Physics 335 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 336 (c) Air is allowe d to ent e r gra d u a lly into one of the evac u a t e d tube s . The bright n e s s of the light at point P is see n to decr e a s e and the n incr e a s e again repe a t e d ly. (i) Stat e the effect on the wavele n g t h of the light in the evac u a t e d tube as the air is introd u c e d . ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Sugg e s t why ther e is a variatio n in the bright n e s s of the light at point P. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (Tota l 4 mark s ) 22 0 . This ques tion is abou t X-ray diffrac tion. An X-ray tube fitted with a coppe r targ e t emits radia tion with a char a c t e r i s ti c wavele n g t h of 1.54 × 10 –10 m. (a) Explain why the char a c t e r i s t ic wavele n g t h is dep e n d e n t on the tar g e t mat e ri al. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 337 (b) The X-ray bea m is inciden t on a sodiu m chloride cryst al. The minim u m angle θ at which the X-rays of wavele n g t h 1.54 × 10 –10 m reinforc e const r u c t iv ely when scat t e r e d from a plane of atom s in the cryst al is 15.9°, as show n below. (i) Calculat e the dista n c e d betw e e n neigh b o u r i n g plan e s of atom s . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (ii) Dete r mi n e any othe r values of θ at which maxim u m inten sity occu r s for the X-ray bea m scatt e r e d from the cryst al. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 338 (c) Stat e why it is pref er a bl e to mea s u r e mor e than one angle θ in orde r to det e r m i n e the spacin g of the plan e s of atom s. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tot al 10 mark s ) 22 1 . This ques tion is abou t relativity. Carri e is in a spac es hi p that is travelling towa r d s a sta r in a str ai g h t- line at cons t a n t velocity as obse rv e d by Pete r . Pete r is at rest relative to the sta r. (a) Car ri e meas u r e s her spac e s hi p to have a lengt h of 100 m. Pete r mea s u r e s Carrie’s spac es hi p to have a lengt h of 91 m. (i) Explain why Carrie mea s u r e s the prop e r lengt h of the spa c e s hi p. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Show that Carri e travels at a spe e d of appr oxi m a t e l y 0.4 c relative to Pete r . ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 339 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (b) Accordi n g to Carri e, it take s the sta r ten year s to rea c h her. Using your ans w e r to (a)(ii), calcula t e the dist a n c e to the sta r as mea s u r e d by Peter . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (c) Accordi n g to Pete r, as Carrie pas s e s the sta r she send s a radio signal. Deter m i n e the time, as mea s u r e d by Carri e, for the mes s a g e to reac h Pete r . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 340 (d) Car ri e and Louise, two obse rv e r s in a spa c e s hi p, view a light sour c e place d close to Car rie. When the spac e s hi p is travelling at a const a n t velocity, they both mea s u r e the frequ e n c y of the light sour c e and obtain identic al values. The mag ni t u d e of the velocity of the spac e s hi p incre a s e s . Stat e and explain any chan g e s to the freq u e n c y of the light sourc e , as mea s u r e d by Louis e, that occur during the accel e r a t io n. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (4) (Tot al 12 mark s ) 22 2 . This ques tion is abou t relativistic mec h a ni c s . (a) Calcula t e the pote n ti al differe n c e thro u g h which a proto n, sta r ti n g from rest, mus t be accel e r a t e d for its mas s–e n e r g y to be equ al to thr e e times its rest mas s- ene r gy. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 341 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 342 (b) Calcula t e the mom e n t u m of the proto n afte r accel e r a ti o n. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tota l 6 mark s ) 22 3 . This ques tion is abou t the Michels o n–Mo rl ey expe ri m e n t . (a) (i) Outline the pur po s e of the expe ri m e n t . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Stat e and explain why Michelso n and Morley rota t e d the app a r a t u s throu g h 90°. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... IB Questionbank Physics 343 .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 344 (b) Stat e and explain the signific a n c e of the res ul t of the expe ri m e n t . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tota l 6 mark s ) 22 4 . This ques tion is abou t spac e ti m e . (a) Descri b e what is mean t by spa c e ti m e . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) Stat e the shap e of the pat h in spac e ti m e of a body (i) moving at cons t a n t velocity. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 345 (ii) orbitin g the Eart h. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 346 (c) Explain how spac eti m e is use d to desc ri b e the gravit a tio n a l attr a c ti o n betw e e n Eart h and a satellite orbitin g the Eart h. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 6 mark s ) 22 5 . This ques tion is abou t heari n g. (a) Stat e what is mea n t by the (i) inten si ty I of a sound wave. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) thre s h ol d inten sity I 0 of hea ri n g. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 347 (b) A pneu m a t i c drill prod u c e s noise of inten sity level 98 dB at the ear of a worke r. (i) Calculat e the intensi ty of the noise at the ear. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (ii) The intensity level at which discomfo r t is felt is 108 dB. Seve r al pneu m a t i c drills, each one produ ci n g an inte n si ty level of noise of 98 dB at the ear, are being used at the sam e time. Dete r m i n e the num b e r of pne u m a t i c drills that must be in use befor e the work e r , who has no hea ri n g prot e c tio n, expe ri e n c e s disco mfor t. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (Tota l 9 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 348 22 6 . This ques tion is abou t ultr as o u n d . The diagr a m shows part of a cross- section thro u g h the leg of a patie n t who is unde r g oi n g an ultr as o u n d scan. Data for the spee d c of ultr a s o u n d in differ e n t media are show n below, toget h e r with values for the acous tic impe d a n c e Z . (a) c / m s –1 Z / kg m –2 s –1 air 3.3 × 10 2 4.3 × 10 2 gel 1.5 × 10 3 1.5 × 10 6 muscl e 1.5 × 10 3 1.4 × 10 6 bone 4.1 × 10 3 7.8 × 10 6 Use the data from the table to calcula t e a value for the density of bone. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) The fraction F of the inten si ty of an ultr a s o u n d wave reflect e d at the boun d a r y betw e e n two media having acous tic impe d a n c e s Z 1 and Z 2 is given by the following equ a tio n. IB Questionbank Physics 349 (Z 1 Z 2 ) 2 2 F = ( Z 1 Z 2 ) IB Questionbank Physics 350 Deter m i n e the fraction F for the boun d a r y betw e e n (i) air and muscle. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) gel and muscl e. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (c) Use your answ e r s in (b) to explain the nee d for a gel on the patie n t’s skin. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 8 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 351 22 7 . Outline the princi ples of the prod u c tio n of an imag e using comp u t e d tomog r a p h y (CT). ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... (Tota l 5 mark s ) 22 8 . This ques tion is abou t radiation expos u r e . (a) A radiation worke r is accide n t a lly expos e d to a sourc e of radia tio n. Stat e why it is easier to mea s u r e the expos u r e rath e r tha n the absor b e d dose for the worke r . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 352 (2) IB Questionbank Physics 353 (b) Expos u r e to γ-radiation may be mea s u r e d using a small met al can. The can cont ai n s 3.6 × 10 –3 g of dry air at atmos p h e r i c pres s u r e . A met al wire, insulat e d from the can, is situa t e d along the axis of the can, as show n below. A pot en ti al differ e n c e is applied betw e e n the can and the cent r a l wire. The can is expos e d to γ-radia tio n for a time of 90 s. During this time, the sensitive am m e t e r recor d s a cur r e n t of 4.8 × 10 –7 A. (i) Dete r mi n e the expos u r e prod u c e d by the γ-radia tio n. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (ii) The ener gy req ui r e d to produ c e one ion- pair in air is 34 eV. Dete r mi n e the rat e, in watts, of deposition of ene r gy in the air in the can. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 354 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (Tota l 8 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 355 22 9 . This ques tion is abou t qua r k s. The quar k cont e n t of a π + meso n includ e s an up qua r k. The Feyn m a n diagr a m repr e s e n t s the decay of a π + meso n. (a) Identify the par ticles labelle d A and B. A: ............................................................................................................. .................... B: ............................................................................................................. .................... (2) (b) Stat e, with refer e n c e to their prop e r t i e s , two differ e n c e s betw e e n a photon and a W boson. 1. ............................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... 2. ............................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (c) The appr oxi m a t e rang e of the weak inte r a c ti o n is 10 –18 m. Dete r mi n e , in kg, the likely mass of the W boson. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 356 ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 6 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 357 23 0 . This ques tion is abou t a synch r o t r o n . (a) Stat e and explain how the particle s in a sync h r o t r o n bea m are accel e r a t e d . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (4) (b) In a synch r o t r o n , bea m s of proton s and antipr o t o n s attain ene r gi e s of 1400 GeV. The radius of the synch r o t r o n is 4.9 km. (i) The mag n e t i c field stre n g t h in the synch r o t r o n is 0.95 T. Dete r mi n e , statin g any assu m p t i o n s you make, the mas s of a proton in the bea m. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 358 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (4) IB Questionbank Physics 359 (ii) Outline why, even at the very high ene r gi e s of this par ticle bea m , the collisions are unlikely to lead to the cre a tion of a single unbou n d quar k. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (c) Outline two ben efits of inter n a ti o n a l coope r a ti o n in the const r u c t i o n and use of high- ener gy particle accele r a t o r s . 1. ............................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... 2. ............................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tot al 13 mark s ) 23 1 . This ques tion is abou t stra n g e n e s s . (a) Outline two prop e r t i e s of str a n g e n e s s . 1. ............................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 360 2. ............................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 361 (b) The following particle inte r a c ti o n is propos e d . p + π – → K– + π + In this inter a c ti o n, char g e is cons e r v e d . Stat e, in ter m s of baryo n and stra n g e n e s s cons e rv a t i o n, whet h e r the inter a c ti o n is possible. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 4 mark s ) 23 2 . This ques tion is abou t deep inelas tic scat t e r i n g. (a) Outline what is mean t by dee p inelas ti c scatt e r i n g. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (b) Sugg e s t , with refer e n c e to asym p t o ti c free do m , why dee p inelas tic scat t e r i n g experi m e n t s indica t e tha t qua r k s beh av e as free particl e s within a nucleo n. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 362 (2) (Tota l 3 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 363 23 3 . This ques tion is abou t conditions in the early unive r s e . At one mom e n t in the early unive r s e the aver a g e particle ene r gy was 500 keV. Nucleosy n t h e s i s is thou g h t to have bee n the domin a n t mec h a ni s m for par ticl e inter a c ti o n at this time. (a) Show that the tem p e r a t u r e of the unive r s e at which nucleosy n t h e s i s occur r e d is 4 × 10 9 K. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) Nucleo syn t h e s i s was only domin a n t for a shor t time in the early univer s e . Explain why the time was shor t and why nucleosy n t h e s i s did not re- occur. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 4 mark s ) 23 4 . The best esti m a t e for the time it take s light to cross the nucle u s of the hydro g e n atom is IB Questionbank Physics 364 A. 10 –23 s. B. 10 –20 s. C. 10 –15 s. D. 10 –7 s. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 365 23 5 . The lengt h of each side of a suga r cube is mea s u r e d as 10 mm with an unce r t ai n t y of ±2 mm. Which of the following is the absolut e unce r t a i n t y in the volum e of the suga r cube? A. ±6 mm 3 B. ±8 mm 3 C. ±4 0 0 mm 3 D. ±6 0 0 mm 3 (Tot al 1 mar k ) 23 6 . The time taken for a stone drop p e d from res t to fall vertic ally thro u g h 16 m is 2.0 s. Based on thes e meas u r e m e n t s , wha t is the bes t estim a t e for the accele r a ti o n of free fall? A. 4.0 m s –2 B. 8.0 m s –2 C. 9.8 m s –2 D. 10 m s –2 (Tot al 1 mar k ) 23 7 . A woode n block is sliding down an incline d plane at const a n t spe e d. The mag ni t u d e of the friction al force betw e e n the block and the plan e is equ al to A. zero. B. the mag nit u d e of the weigh t of the block. C. the mag nit u d e of the compo n e n t of weight of the block par allel to the plan e. D. the mag nit u d e of the compo n e n t of the nor m al rea c tio n par allel to the plan e. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 366 23 8 . Which of the following is a corr e c t stat e m e n t of New to n’s secon d law of motion? A. A force acting on a body is propo r tio n a l to the mas s of the body. B. The rate of chan g e of mom e n t u m of a body is equ al to the net exte r n a l force acting on the body. C. The mom e n t u m of a body is propo r tio n a l to the net exte r n a l force acting on the body. D. A force acting on a body is propo r tio n a l to the accele r a ti o n of the body. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 23 9 . A ball of weigh t W is travelling horizon t ally towa r d s a vertic al wall. It strikes the wall and rebo u n d s horizon t ally. The cha n g e in the mag nit u d e of the mom e n t u m of the ball is ∆p. Which of the following is the mag nit u d e of the impuls e that the ball impa r t s to the wall? A. W + ∆p B. W – ∆p C. W D. ∆p (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 367 24 0 . Two object s unde r g o an inelas tic collision. Which of the following is corr e c t in resp e c t of both the cons e r v a ti o n of mom e n t u m and the cons e r v a ti o n of total ener gy of the syste m ? Mo m e n t u m Tot al en e r g y A. cons e r v e d not cons e rv e d B. cons e r v e d cons e r v e d C. not cons e rv e d not cons e rv e d D. not cons e rv e d cons e r v e d (Tot al 1 mar k ) 24 1 . A particle P is moving anti- clockwis e with const a n t spe e d in a horizont a l circle. Which diagr a m corr e c tly shows the direc tio n of the velocity v and accele r a ti o n a of the par ticle P in the position show n? (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 368 24 2 . Two object s are in ther m al cont a c t with eac h othe r . Which of the following will det er m i n e the directio n of the tra n sf e r of the r m a l ene r gy betw e e n the bodies? A. The mas s of each body B. The area of cont a ct betw e e n the bodies C. The specific heat cap acity of eac h body D. The tem p e r a t u r e of each body (Tot al 1 mar k ) 24 3 . The mole is define d as A. 1 1 2 the mas s of an atom of the isotop e car bo n- 12. B. the amou n t of a subst a n c e that cont ai n s as many ele m e n t a r y entitie s as the num b e r of atom s in 12 g of the isotop e carbo n- 12. C. the mas s of one atom of the isotop e car bo n- 12. D. the amou n t of a subst a n c e that cont ai n s as many nuclei as the num b e r of nuclei in 12 g of the isotop e carbo n- 12. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 369 24 4 . A gas is cont ai n e d in a cylinde r by a piston. The gas is comp r e s s e d rapidly by moving the piston in the direc tio n show n. The best explan a ti o n for the resul tin g incr e a s e in tem p e r a t u r e of the gas is that the molec ul e s of the gas gain kinetic ene r gy A. from the moving piston. B. by colliding more frequ e n tly with each othe r. C. by being pus h e d close r toge t h e r . D. by colliding more frequ e n tly with the walls of the cylinde r . (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 370 24 5 . The gra p h shows how the velocity v of an objec t und e r g oi n g simple har m o ni c motion varies with time t for one compl e t e period of oscillation. Which of the following sketc h gra p h s bes t shows how the total ene r gy E of the object varies with t ? (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 371 24 6 . A force that varies sinus oid ally is applied to a syste m that is lightly dam p e d . Which of the following mus t be true of the force for reson a n c e to occu r? A. It mus t always be in anti- pha s e with the oscillations of the syst e m . B. Its directio n must always be in the direc tio n of motion of the oscillations of the syste m . C. Its frequ e n c y mus t be equ al to the freq u e n c y of oscillation of the syste m . D. Its amplit u d e mus t be equ al to the amplit u d e of oscillation of the syste m . (Tot al 1 mar k ) 24 7 . Which of the following is a value of wavele n g t h tha t is found in the visible region of the elect r o m a g n e t i c spec t r u m ? A. 4 × 10 –5 m B. 4 × 10 –7 m C. 4 × 10 –9 m D. 4 × 10 –11 m (Tot al 1 mar k ) 24 8 . Two waves meet at a point in spac e. Which of the following prope r ti e s always add toget h e r ? A. Displac e m e n t B. Amplitud e C. Spee d D. Freq u e n c y (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 372 24 9 . A point char g e of magni t u d e 2.0 μC is move d betw e e n two points X and Y. Point X is at a poten ti al of +6. 0 V and point Y is at a pote n ti al of +9. 0 V. The gain in poten ti al ene r gy of the point cha r g e is A. 0.20 μJ. B. 1.5 μJ. C. 6.0 μJ. D. 30 μJ. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 25 0 . A resisto r of resis t a n c e 12 Ω is conne c t e d in serie s with a cell of negligibl e inter n al resist a n c e . The powe r dissipa t e d in the resisto r is P. The resist o r is repl ac e d with a resis to r of resist a n c e 3.0 Ω. What is the powe r dissip a t e d in this resisto r ? A. 0.25 P B. P C. 2.0 P D. 4.0 P (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 373 25 1 . The elect r o m o t ive force (emf) of a cell is define d as A. the powe r supplie d by the cell per unit curr e n t from the cell. B. the force that the cell provide s to drive elect r o n s roun d a circuit. C. the ene r gy supplied by the cell per unit cur r e n t from the cell. D. the poten ti al differ e n c e acros s the ter mi n a l s of the cell. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 25 2 . The weight of an object of mas s 1 kg at the surfa c e of Mars is about 4 N. The radius of Mars is about half the radius of Eart h. Which of the following is the best estim a t e of the ratio below? m a s so f M a r s m a s sof E a r t h A. 0.1 B. 0.2 C. 5 D. 10 (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 374 25 3 . Three positive point char g e s of equ al mag ni t u d e are held at the corn e r s X, Y and Z of a right- angled trian gl e . The point P is at the midpoin t of XY. Which of the arrow s shows the dire c tion of the elec t ri c field at point P? (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 375 25 4 . An elect r o n travelling in the direc tion show n by the arro w X, ent e r s a region of unifor m mag n e ti c field. It leave s the region of field in the direction show n by the arrow Y. The direction of the mag n e t i c field is A. in the directio n of X. B. into the plane of the pap e r . C. in the opposit e direc tio n to X. D. out of the plane of the pap e r . (Tot al 1 mar k ) 25 5 . Emission and abso r p ti o n spect r a provide evide nc e for A. the nuclea r model of the atom. B. nat u r al radioac tivity. C. the existe n c e of isotop e s. D. the existe n c e of atomic ene r gy levels. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 376 25 6 . Which of the following is true in resp e c t of both the Coulom b inte r a c ti o n and the stron g inter a c ti o n betw e e n nucleon s in an atom? Coul o m b int er a c t i o n exi s t s bet w e e n Str o n g int e r a c t i o n exi s t s bet w e e n A. proto n s only neut r o n s only B. both proto n s and neut r o n s neut r o n s only C. proto n s only both proto n s and neut r o n s D. both proto n s and neut r o n s both proto n s and neut r o n s (Tot al 1 mar k ) 25 7 . Which of the following cor r e c tly identifies the thr e e particle s emitt e d in the 45 45 decay of the nucle u s 2 0 Ca into a nucle u s of 2 1S c ? A. α, β–, γ B. β –, γ, v C. α, γ, v D. α, β–, v (Tot al 1 mar k ) 25 8 . The nuclea r reactio n 2 1H 31 H 4 1 2 H e 0 n is an exam pl e of A. nuclea r fission. B. radioac tive decay. C. nuclea r fusion. D. artificial tran s m u t a t i o n . (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 377 25 9 . Degr a d e d ene r gy is ener gy that is A. stor e d in the Ear t h’s atmo s p h e r e . B. availabl e from non- rene w a bl e ene r gy sour c e s . C. conve r t e d into work in a cyclical proc e s s. D. no longer available for the perfor m a n c e of useful work. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 26 0 . Which of the following cor r e c tly desc ri b e s both the role of the mode r a t o r and of the cont r ol rods in a nucle a r reac t o r ? Mod er a t o r Con tr o l rod s A. slows down the neut r o n s maint ai n a const a n t rat e of fission B. cools down the react o r extr a c t the r m a l ene r gy C. cools down the react o r maint ai n a const a n t rat e of fission D. slows down the neut r o n s extr a c t the r m a l ene r gy (Tot al 1 mar k ) 26 1 . Which of the following cor r e c tly shows the ene r gy chan g e in a photovolt aic cell and in a solar heati n g pan el? Phot o v o l t a i c cell Sol ar he a t i n g pan e l A. solar → elect ric al solar → the r m a l B. elect ric al → ther m al solar → elect ric al C. solar → elect ric al elect ric al → the r m a l D. elect ric al → ther m al solar → the r m a l (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 378 26 2 . The albedo for the ocea n s is lowe r tha n that for glacie r s. This is bec a u s e , comp a r e d to ice, sea wat e r A. has a grea t e r density. B. has a grea t e r specific heat capa ci ty. C. has a grea t e r coefficien t of volum e expa n sio n. D. absor b s a grea t e r amou n t of radia tive powe r. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 26 3 . Which of the following is most likely to red uc e the enh a n c e d gre e n h o u s e effect? A. Replace the use of gas- fired powe r station s with oil-fired powe r stations B. Replace coal- fired powe r station s with nucle a r powe r stations C. Incr e a s e the use of all non- rene w a b l e ene r gy sourc e s D. Decr e a s e the efficiency of powe r produ c tio n (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 379 26 4 . This ques tion is abou t elect ri ca l resist a n c e . The gra p h shows the variation with tem p e r a t u r e T of the resist a n c e R of an elect ric al com po n e n t . (a) A stud e n t hypot h e siz e s that the resist a n c e is inver s ely propo r tio n a l to the tem p e r a t u r e . Use dat a from the gra p h to show whet h e r the hypot h e s i s is suppo r t e d . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 380 ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (b) A secon d stud e n t sugg e s t s that the relations hi p is of the form b lg R = a + T whe r e a and b are const a n t s . The stud e n t plots the grap h below. Erro r bar s have bee n includ e d for the sake of clarity. IB Questionbank Physics 381 (i) Explain how the grap h dra w n could be use d as evide nc e to suppo r t the stud e n t’s sugg e s tio n. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) Use the grap h to dete r m i n e the const a n t s a and b . b : ..................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. a: ..................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (4) (iii) Using your ans w e r s to (b)(ii), dete r m i n e a value for the resis t a n c e of the compo n e n t at a tem p e r a t u r e of 260 K. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 382 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tot al 11 mark s ) 26 5 . This ques tion is abou t forces. An athlet e trains by dra g gi n g a heavy load acros s a roug h horizont al surfac e. The athl et e exer t s a force of ma gni t u d e F on the load at an angle of 25° to the horizont al. (a) Once the load is moving at a stea dy spee d, the aver a g e horizon t a l friction al force acting on the load is 470 N. Calcula t e the aver a g e value of F that will ena bl e the load to move at const a n t spee d. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 383 (b) The load is moved a horizon t a l dista n c e of 2.5 km in 1.2 hour s. Calcula t e (i) the work done on the load by the force F. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 384 (ii) the minim u m aver a g e powe r requi r e d to move the load. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (c) The athlet e pulls the load uphill at the sam e spe e d as in par t (a). Explain, in ter m s of ene r gy cha n g e s , why the minim u m aver a g e powe r req ui r e d is grea t e r than in (b)(ii). ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 8 mark s ) 26 6 . This ques tion is abou t solar hea ti n g pan el s. (a) Stat e the ener gy chan g e tha t take s plac e in a solar pan el. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 385 (b) A village consist s of 120 hous e s . It is propos e d tha t solar pan els be used to provide hot wate r to the hous e s . The following data are availa ble. aver a g e powe r need e d per hous e to hea t wate r aver a g e surfac e solar inten sity efficiency of ene r gy conve r sio n of a solar pan el = 3.0 kW = 650 W m –2 = 18 % Calcula t e the minim u m surfa c e are a of the solar pan els requi r e d to provide the total powe r for wat e r hea tin g. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (c) Sugg e s t two disadv a n t a g e s of using sola r powe r to provide ene r gy for heatin g wat e r. 1: ............................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... 2: ............................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 6 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 386 26 7 . This ques tion is abou t solar radi a tion. (a) Stat e the Stefan–Boltzm a n n law for a black body. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) The following data relat e s to the Eart h and the Sun. Eart h- Sun dist a n c e radius of Eart h radius of Sun surfac e tem p e r a t u r e of Sun (i) = = = = 1.5 × 6.4 × 7.0 × 5800 10 11 m 10 6 m 10 8 m K Use data from the table to show tha t the powe r radi a t e d by the Sun is abou t 4 × 10 26 W. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Calculat e the solar powe r incide n t per unit are a at a dista n c e from the Sun equ al to the Eart h’s dista n c e from the Sun. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... IB Questionbank Physics 387 .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 388 (iii) The aver a g e powe r absor b e d per unit are a at the Eart h’s surfa c e is 240 W m –2 . Stat e two reas o n s why the value calcula t e d in (b)(ii) differs from this value. 1: ..................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. 2: ..................................................................................................................... .. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (iv) Show that the value for powe r absor b e d per unit are a of 240 W m –2 is consist e n t with an aver a g e equilibri u m tem p e r a t u r e for the Eart h of abou t 255 K. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (c) Explain, by refer e n c e to the gre e n h o u s e effect, why the aver a g e tem p e r a t u r e of the surfac e of the Eart h is gre a t e r tha n 255 K. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 389 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 390 (d) Sugg e s t why the burnin g of fossil fuels may lead to an incr e a s e in the tem p e r a t u r e of the surfac e of the Eart h. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tot al 15 mark s ) 26 8 . This ques tion is abou t kicking a football. A ball is susp e n d e d from a ceiling by a string of lengt h 7.5 m. The ball is kicked horizon t ally and rises to a maxim u m height of 6.0 m. (a) Assumin g that the air resist a n c e is negligible, show that the initial spee d of the ball is 11 m s –1 . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 391 ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 392 (b) The mas s of the ball is 0.55 kg and the impa c t time of the kicke r’s foot with the ball is 150 ms. Estim a t e the aver a g e force exer t e d on the ball by the kick. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (c) (i) Explain why the tension in the string incr e a s e s imm e di a t ely after the ball is kicke d. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (ii) Calculat e the tension in the string imm e di a t e ly afte r the ball is kicked. Assum e that the string is vertic al. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) IB Questionbank Physics 393 (Tot al 10 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 394 26 9 . This ques tion is abou t wat e r wave motion. A small sphe r e , mount e d at the end of a vertic al rod, dips below the surfa c e of shallow wat e r in a tray. The sphe r e is drive n vertic ally up and down by a motor att ac h e d to the rod. The oscillation s of the sphe r e produ c e travelling waves on the surfa c e of the wate r . (a) The diagr a m shows how the displa c e m e n t of the wat e r surfa c e at a particul a r insta n t in time varies with dista n c e from the sphe r e . The period of oscillation of the sphe r e is 0.027 s. Use the diagr a m to calcul a t e , for the wave, (i) the amplitu d e. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 395 (ii) the wavele n g t h . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (iii) the frequ e n cy. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (iv) the spee d. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (b) The wave moves from region A into a region B of shallowe r wate r . The waves move mor e slowly in region B. The diag r a m (not to scale) shows som e of the wavefr o n t s in region A. IB Questionbank Physics 396 IB Questionbank Physics 397 (i) With refer e n c e to a wave, disting uis h betw e e n a ray and a wavefro n t . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) The angle betw e e n the wavefr on t s and the inte rf a c e in region A is 60°. The refrac tive index An B is 1.4. Dete r mi n e the angle betw e e n the wavefro n t s and the inte rfa c e in region B. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (iii) On the diagr a m above, cons t r u c t thr e e lines to show the position of thre e wavefro n t s in region B. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 398 (c) Anothe r sphe r e is dippe d into the wate r . The sphe r e s oscillat e in phas e. The diagr a m shows some lines in region A along which the distu r b a n c e of the wat e r surfa c e is a minim u m . (i) Outline how the regions of minim u m distu r b a n c e occur on the surfac e. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) IB Questionbank Physics 399 (ii) The frequ e n cy of oscillation of the sphe r e s is incr e a s e d . Stat e and explain how this will affect the position s of minim u m distu r b a n c e . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tot al 15 mark s ) 27 0 . This ques tion is abou t nuclea r proc e s s e s . (a) A nucleu s of radiu m- 91 ( a nucle u s of radon (Rn). (i) 226 9 1 Ra ) unde r g o e s alpha particle dec ay to form Identify the proto n num b e r and nucle on num b e r of the nucle u s of Rn. Proto n num b e r : .................................................................................. ............... Nucleo n num b e r : .................................................................................. ............ (2) (ii) The half- life of radiu m- 91 is 1600 yea rs. Dete r mi n e the lengt h of time taken for 87.5 % of the radiu m to disint e g r a t e . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 400 ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 401 (b) Imm e di a t ely after the dec ay of a station a r y radiu m nucle u s , the alpha particl e and the rado n nucle u s move off in opposit e dire c tion s and at differ e n t spee d s . Outline the reas o n s for thes e obse rv a tio n s . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (c) Outline why a bet a particl e has a longe r rang e in air tha n an alpha particl e of the sam e ene r gy. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tot al 10 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 402 IB Questionbank Physics 403 27 1 . This ques tion is abou t an elect ric al hea t e r . An elect ric al heat e r consist s of two hea ti n g elem e n t s E 1 and E 2 . The elem e n t s are conn e c t e d in par allel. Each elem e n t has a switc h and is conne c t e d to a supply of emf 240 V. The supply has negligibl e inter n al resis t a n c e . Elem e n t E 1 is mad e from wire that has a cros s- section a l are a of 6.8 × 10 –8 m 2 . The resistivity of the wire at the oper a ti n g tem p e r a t u r e of the elem e n t is 1.1 × 10 –6 Ωm. (a) (i) The total lengt h of wire is 4.5 m. Show tha t the resis t a n c e of E 1 is 73 Ω. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Calculat e the powe r outp u t of E 1 with only this elem e n t conne c t e d to the supply. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 404 (iii) Elem e n t E 2 is mad e of wire of the sam e cross- section and mat e ri al as E 1 . The lengt h of wire use d to make E 2 is 1.5 m. Dete r mi n e the total powe r outpu t whe n both E 1 and E 2 are conne c t e d to the supply. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (iv) With refer e n c e to the powe r outp u t, explain why it would be inapp r o p r i a t e to conn e c t the hea ti n g ele m e n t s in serie s. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (b) Each elem e n t in the elect ri c a l heat e r is woun d as a coil as show n. IB Questionbank Physics 405 Each tur n of the coil may be conside r e d to act as a cur r e n t- car ryin g long str ai g h t wire. IB Questionbank Physics 406 (i) On the diagr a m , draw the mag n e t i c field arou n d a curr e n tcarryi n g long str ai g h t wire. The arro w shows the dire c tion of the curr e n t . (3) (ii) Stat e and explain whet h e r the turn s of wire will attr a c t or rep el one anot h e r . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (Tot al 15 mark s ) 27 2 . This ques tion is abou t heati n g a liquid. (a) Sugg e s t why, in ter m s of the molec ul a r model, the ene r gy associa t e d with melting is less than that associ a t e d with boiling. ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 407 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 408 (b) Milk in a cup is heat e d to boiling point by passin g stea m throu g h it. Whilst cooling subs e q u e n t l y, some milk evapo r a t e s . (i) Disting ui s h betw e e n evapo r a t io n and boiling. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) The cup cont ai n s 0.30 kg of milk at an initial tem p e r a t u r e of 18 °C. Estim a t e the minim u m mas s of ste a m at 100 °C tha t is requi r e d to heat the milk to 80 °C. Specific latent heat of vaporiz a tio n of wate r kg –1 Specific heat capacity of wate r K–1 Specific heat capacity of milk K–1 = 2.3 × 10 6 J = 4200 J kg –1 = 3800 J kg –1 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... IB Questionbank Physics 409 .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (4) IB Questionbank Physics 410 (iii) Stat e two reas o n s , othe r than evapo r a ti o n, why the ans w e r to (b) (ii) is likely to be differ e n t from the act u al mas s of cond e n s e d stea m . 1: ..................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. 2: ..................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tot al 10 mark s ) 27 3 . This ques tion is abou t the eye and sight. (a) Stat e, by refer e n c e to hum a n vision, wha t is me a n t by accom m o d a t i o n. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) Explain how accom m o d a t i o n is achieve d in the hum a n eye. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 411 (c) The light outpu t from two par tic ul a r lamps is desc ri b e d as “war mwhite” and as “cold- white”. Both lamps emit the full spec t r u m of colour s. Stat e how the visual impr e s s io n of tem p e r a t u r e differ e n c e may be achieve d. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 7 mark s ) 27 4 . This ques tion is abou t the Dopple r effect. At one point in an arte ry, blood cells flow along the axis of the arte ry with spee d v , as show n. A par allel bea m of ultra s o u n d of freq u e n c y 4.5 MHz is incide n t on the art e r y at an angle of 40°. The spee d of ultra s o u n d in the body tissu e s is c = 1.5 × 10 3 m s –1 . The ultra s o u n d dete c t e d after reflection from the blood cells is found to be Doppler- shifted in frequ e n cy by 740 Hz. The expr es sio n for the Dopple r shift ∆f of the ultra s o u n d of freq u e n c y f may be ass u m e d to be IB Questionbank Physics 412 (2 fv c osθ ) c ∆f = . IB Questionbank Physics 413 (a) For this stat e d expr e s s io n, explain the inclusion of (i) the factor of 2. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) the factor cos θ. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (b) Deter m i n e a value for the spe e d of the blood cells in the art e r y. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 5 mark s ) 27 5 . This ques tion is abou t polarizatio n. (a) Stat e what is mea n t by polariz e d light. ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 414 ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 415 (b) Descri b e and explain how polariz a tio n may be use d in stre s s analysis. You may draw a diagr a m if you wish. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (6) (Tota l 8 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 416 27 6 . This ques tion is abou t the wave nat u r e of matt e r . (a) Descri b e the de Broglie hypot h e si s . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) Outline an experi m e n t to verify the de Broglie hypot h e s i s. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 417 (c) Show that the de Broglie wavel e n g t h of elect r o n s accel e r a t e d from rest thro u g h a pote n ti al differe n c e of 150 V is 1.0 ×1 0 –10 m. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tota l 8 mark s ) 27 7 . This ques tion is abou t alpha ( α) par ticle scat t e r i n g . An experi m e n t is car ri e d out in which alph a (α) par ticle s of initial kinetic ene r gy 5.0 MeV are fired at a piece of gold foil. The proton num b e r of gold is 79. Dete r mi n e the dista n c e of close s t appr o a c h of an alpha (α) particle to a gold nucleu s . ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... (Tota l 4 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 418 IB Questionbank Physics 419 27 8 . This ques tion is abou t β+ (posit ro n) dec ay. (a) In a β + decay, a positro n is em itted along with a neut ri n o, and a γ-ray photon. Althoug h the ener gy spect r u m for γ-ray s involved is discr e t e , the ener gy spect r u m for the positr o n s is continu o u s . (i) Stat e the differ e n c e betw e e n a disc r e t e ene r gy spec t r u m and a contin uo u s ener gy spec t r u m . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Explain how the exist e n c e of the neut ri n o accou n t s for the contin uo u s nat u r e of the positro n ene r gy spec t r u m . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (b) Sodiu m- 22 is a radioisot o p e use d in nucle a r medicin e that unde r g o e s β + decay. The half- life of sodiu m- 22 is 2.6 yea rs. A sam pl e of sodiu m- 22 has an initial activity of 6.2 × 10 9 Bq. (i) Define decay cons ta n t . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Calculat e the decay const a n t of sodiu m- 22. IB Questionbank Physics 420 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (iii) Calculat e the activity of the sam pl e of sodiu m- 22 afte r 8.0 year s. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (Tota l 8 mark s ) 27 9 . This ques tion is abou t storin g infor m a t io n. Infor m a ti o n may be stor e d eithe r in analog u e form or in digital form. (a) Disting ui s h betw e e n analog u e inform a t io n and digital infor m a t io n. Analogu e: ................................................................................................ .................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... Digital: .................................................................................................... .................... IB Questionbank Physics 421 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) Stat e on e met ho d by which inform a t io n may be stor e d in (i) analog u e form. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) digital form. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 422 (c) Stat e and explain two rea s o n s why, for many pur po s e s , digital stor a g e of infor m a ti o n is replacin g analog u e stor a g e . 1: ............................................................................................................. .................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... 2: ............................................................................................................. .................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (4) (d) Sugg e s t two possible implica tion s for society of the ever- incr e a si n g capa bility of data stor a g e . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tot al 10 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 423 28 0 . This ques tion is abou t an amplifier circuit. The diagr a m below show s an amplifie r circuit incor p o r a t i n g an ideal oper a tio n al amplifier (op- amp). The oper a ti o n al amplifier uses a +9 V / 0 / –9 V supply. (a) Calcula t e the gain of the amplifier circuit. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 424 (b) Deter m i n e the outp u t pote n ti al V out for value s of input pote n ti al V in equal to (i) –0.9 V. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) +2. 0 V. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (Tota l 5 mark s ) 28 1 . This ques tion is abou t a mobile phon e netwo r k. Describ e the role of bas e stations and a cellula r excha n g e when a mobile phon e is switch e d on and befor e a call is ma d e. ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... IB Questionbank Physics 425 ......................................................................................................................... ....................... (Tota l 5 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 426 28 2 . This ques tion is abou t relativistic kine m a t i c s . (a) Define inertial fram e of refer e n c e . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) Ann and Sue are twins. Sue rem ai n s on Eart h. Ann travels to the sta r Sirius in a spac es hi p moving at a spe e d of 0.80 c, as mea s u r e d by Sue. The dist an c e betw e e n Eart h and Sirius is 8.8 ly, as mea s u r e d by Sue. (i) Calculat e the time elaps e d , as mea s u r e d by Sue, betw e e n Ann leaving Ear t h and rea c hi n g Sirius. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Stat e and explain whet h e r Ann or Sue mea s u r e s the prope r time betw e e n Ann leaving Eart h and arriving at Sirius. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (iii) Calculat e the time take n for the spa c e s hi p to reac h Sirius, as meas u r e d by Ann. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 427 (2) IB Questionbank Physics 428 (iv) As Ann appr o a c h e s Sirius, she sends a radio mess a g e back to Sue. The dista n c e betw e e n Sirius and Eart h, as mea s u r e d by Ann, is 5.28 ly. Deter m i n e the time, as mea s u r e d by Ann, that it takes for the signal to reac h Sue. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (Tot al 10 mark s ) 28 3 . This ques tion is abou t funda m e n t a l inte r a c ti o n s . (a) Stat e an excha n g e par ticle for (i) the weak inter a c ti o n. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) the elect r o m a g n e t i c inter a c tio n. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (b) Comm e n t , with refer e n c e to the mass of the excha n g e particle s , on the rang e of the weak and elect r o m a g n e t i c inte r a c ti o n s . IB Questionbank Physics 429 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (c) Descri b e the proce s s repr e s e n t e d by the Feyn m a n diagr a m below. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (d) Stat e what is mea n t by a virtual par ticle. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (e) Explain how the Heise n b e r g unce r t a i n t y princi ple for ene r gy and time applies to the inter a c t io n in (c). IB Questionbank Physics 430 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 431 (f) The unce r t ai n t y in the time for the elect r o m a g n e t i c inte r a c tio n betw e e n two elect r o n s is 1.6 × 10 –16 s. Dete r mi n e the unc e r t a i n t y in the ene r gy of the virtu al photon. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tot al 10 mark s ) 28 4 . Which of the following quan ti tie s can be dete r m i n e d from a spe e d- time grap h of a particle travelling in a straig h t line? A. Only the mag nit u d e of the accel e r a ti o n at a given insta n t B. Both the velocity and the acc el e r a t io n at a given insta n t C. Only the dista n c e travelled in a given time D. Both the dista n c e travelle d in a given time and the ma gni t u d e of the accel e r a t i o n at a given inst a n t (Tot al 1 mar k ) 28 5 . Which of the following is a corr e c t definition of work? A. Produ c t of force and dista n c e B. Produ c t of force and dista n c e move d in the dire c tion of the force C. Produ c t of powe r and time D. Produ c t of force and displa c e m e n t (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 432 28 6 . The diagr a m shows two par allel met al plat e s X and Y. Plate X is at Eart h pot en ti al (0 V) and the pote n ti al of plat e Y is V 0 . Which of the following is corr ec t in resp e c t of the mag nit u d e and the direction of the elect ric field betw e e n the plat e s ? Ma g n i t u d e Dire c t i o n A. const a n t X→Y B. incr e a si n g Y→ X C. const a n t Y→ X D. incr e a si n g X→Y (Tot al 1 mar k ) 28 7 . Gravit atio n al poten ti al at a point is define d as the work done A. per unit mas s in moving a small mass from infinity to the point. B. in moving a unit mas s from infinity to the point. C. in moving a small mas s from infinity to the point. D. per unit mas s in moving a unit mas s from infinity to the point. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 433 28 8 . The esca p e spee d from the surfa c e of a plan e t dep e n d s on A. both the radius and the mass of the plane t. B. only the radi us of the plane t . C. only the mas s of the plane t. D. only the gravit a tion al field stre n g t h at the surfa c e of the plan e t. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 28 9 . Wate r at a tem p e r a t u r e of 0 °C is kept in a the r m a lly insula t e d cont ai n e r . A lump of ice, also at 0 °C, is plac e d in the wate r and comple t ely subm e r g e d . Which of the following is true in resp e c t of both the net amou n t of ice that will melt and the chan g e in tem p e r a t u r e of the wat e r ? Net am o u n t of ice tha t m el t s Cha n g e in te m p e r a t u r e of wat e r A. all will melt no cha n g e B. som e will melt decr e a s e C. none will melt no cha n g e D. all will melt decr e a s e (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 434 29 0 . The beh aviou r of a mona t o mi c gas such as heliu m will appr oxi m a t e to that of an ideal gas when it is kept at A. a tem p e r a t u r e close to absolut e zero. B. low pres s u r e . C. very high pres s u r e . D. very high tem p e r a t u r e . (Tot al 1 mar k ) 29 1 . The diagr a m shows the pres s u r e p and volum e V relation s hi p for one cycle of oper a tio n of an engin e. Which of the labelled par t s of the cycle identify isoba ric cha n g e s and adiab a ti c chan g e s of stat e? Isob a ri c Adiab a t i c A. IV only I and II only B. I and III only II and IV only C. II and III only IV only D. I and III only II only (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 435 29 2 . The funda m e n t a l (first har m o nic) frequ e n c y of the note emitt e d by an organ pipe closed at one end is f. What is the funda m e n t a l frequ e n c y of the note emitt e d by an orga n pipe of the sa m e lengt h tha t is open at both ends? A. f 4 B. f 2 C. 2f D. 4f (Tot al 1 mar k ) 29 3 . Which of the following wave phe no m e n a is associ a t e d with blood flow meas u r e m e n t s ? A. Polarization B. Diffractio n C. Refrac tion D. Doppl er effect (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 436 29 4 . A bea m of coher e n t light is incide n t on a single slit of width b . After passin g throu g h the slit, the light is incide n t on a scre e n at a dista n c e D from the slit. Which of the following chan g e s , carri e d out sepa r a t e ly, in res p e c t of b and D will result in an incr e a s e in width of the first diffra ctio n maxim u m form e d on the scre e n ? b D A. decr e a s e incr e a s e B. incr e a s e incr e a s e C. decr e a s e decr e a s e D. incr e a s e decr e a s e (Tot al 1 mar k ) 29 5 . The imag e s of two sourc e s are just resolve d. Which of the following is a corr e c t stat e m e n t of the Rayleigh crite rion for this situa tion ? A. The cent r al maxim u m of the diffrac tion patt e r n of one sour c e must coincide with the cent r al maxim u m of the diffrac tio n patt e r n of the other sourc e. B. Light from the sour c e s must pass throu g h a circul a r ape r t u r e . C. Light from the sour c e s must be cohe r e n t . D. The first minim u m of the diffra c tion patt e r n of one sourc e must coincide with the cent r al maxim u m of the diffrac tio n patt e r n of the other sourc e. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 437 29 6 . An optically active subs t a n c e is a subs t a n c e tha t A. has a refr ac tive index that depe n d s on the plane of pola riz a tio n of inciden t light. B. compl et ely absor b s incide n t unpola riz e d light. C. rotat e s the plane of polariz a tion of incide n t polariz e d light. D. polarize s unpola riz e d light. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 29 7 . A copp e r shee t is sus p e n d e d in a region of unifor m magn e t i c field by an insulati n g wire conne c t e d to a horizon t al suppo r t . The she e t is pulle d to one side so that it is outsid e the region of the field, and the n rele a s e d . The unifor m mag n e ti c field is dire c t e d into the plan e of the pape r. Which of the following is true for both the dire c tion of the induc e d cur r e n t in the sheet and the chan g e in amplit u d e of the oscillation s of the she e t with time? Dire c t i o n of indu c e d curr e n t Chan g e in am p l i t u d e A. stays the sam e no cha n g e B. chan g e s decr e a s e s C. stays the sam e decr e a s e s D. chan g e s no cha n g e (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 438 29 8 . An alter n a ti n g curr e n t supply of negligible inter n al resist a n c e is conne c t e d to two resis to r s that are in par all el. The resist a n c e of each resisto r is R and the peak volta g e of the ac supply is V 0 . Which of the following is the aver a g e powe r dissip a t e d in the circ uit? A. 2V0 R B. V0 R 2 2 V0 C. 2 2R 2 D. V0 2R (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 439 29 9 . Which of the following is true in resp e c t of both the Coulom b inte r a c ti o n and the stron g inter a c ti o n betw e e n nucleon s in an atom? Coul o m b int er a c t i o n exi s t s bet w e e n Str o n g int e r a c t i o n exi s t s bet w e e n A. proto n s only neut r o n s only B. both proto n s and neut r o n s neut r o n s only C. proto n s only both proto n s and neut r o n s D. both proto n s and neut r o n s both proto n s and neut r o n s (Tot al 1 mar k ) 30 0 . Light of freq u e n c y f is inciden t on a met al surf ac e . The work function of the met al is φ. Which o f the following is the maxim u m kinetic ene r gy of the elect r o n s emitt e d from the surfa c e ? A. hf – B. h ( f ) e C. – hf D. h ( f ) e (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 440 30 1 . An elect r o n is accel er a t e d from rest thro u g h a pote n ti al differ e n c e V . Which of the following is the de Broglie wavele n g t h of the elect r o n afte r accele r a ti o n? h A. 2m e V e 2m e h B. V2 h C. 2m e V 2 e 2 D. V2 2m e h (Tot al 1 mar k ) 30 2 . Which of the following is an assu m p t i o n of the Schr ö di n g e r model of the hydro g e n atom? A. The orbit al pat h of the elect r o n fits a sta n di n g wave. B. The position of the elect r o n is undefin e d but its mom e n t u m is well define d. C. The mom e n t u m of the elect r o n is und efine d but its position is well define d. D. The elect r o n is desc ri b e d by wavefun c tio n s . (Tot al 1 mar k ) 30 3 . A Bainbri d g e mass spect r o m e t e r may be use d to mea s u r e the mas s of A. an atom. B. an ion. C. an isotop e. D. a molecul e. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 441 30 4 . A nucle u s of the isotop e potas si u m- 40 dec ays to a nucle u s of the isotop e argo n- 40. The reaction equ a tio n for this dec ay may be writt e n as 40 19K 40 Z Ar X ν Which of the following cor r e c tly identifies the proto n num b e r of argo n- 40 and the particle X? Z X A. 18 β– B. 18 β+ C. 19 β+ D. 19 β– (Tot al 1 mar k ) 30 5 . For the five- bit binary num b e r 1101 0, which of the following corr e c tly identifies both the most- significa n t bit (MSB) and the equivale n t decim al num b e r ? MS B Dec i m a l A. 1 52 B. 0 26 C. 1 26 D. 0 52 (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 442 30 6 . The capa cit a n c e of a pixel of a CCD is 3.2 pF. A pulse of light is incide n t on the pixel and as a res ult, 10 4 elect r o n s are eject e d from the pixel. The mag ni t u d e of the chan g e in pote n ti al of the pixel is A. 5.0 × 10 –16 V B. 5.0 × 10 –4 V C. 2.0 × 10 3 V D. 2.0 × 10 15 V (Tot al 1 mar k ) 30 7 . Which of the following ratios is the definition of qua n t u m efficiency of a pixel? A. n u m b eor f p h ot onin s c id e n t n u m b eof r e le c t r o nesm it t e d B. n u m b eof r e le c t r o nesm it t e d n u m b eor f p h ot onin s c id e n t C. in t e n s itoyf in c id e nlig t ht in t e n s itoyf e m it t e lig d ht D. in t e n s itoyf e m it t e lig d ht in t e n s itoyf in c id e nlig t ht (Tot al 1 mar k ) 30 8 . Degr a d e d ene r gy is ener gy that is A. stor e d in the Ear t h’s atmo s p h e r e . B. availabl e from non- rene w a bl e ene r gy sour c e s . C. conve r t e d into work in a cyclical proc e s s. D. no longer available for the perfor m a n c e of useful work. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 443 30 9 . A coal- fired powe r station has a powe r outp u t of P and its efficiency is ε. It bur n s a mas s of coal M every secon d. The best estim a t e of the ene r gy density of the coal used is A. Pε M B. Mε P C. Pε M D. P εM (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 444 31 0 . This ques tion is abou t elect ri ca l resist a n c e . The gra p h shows the variation with tem p e r a t u r e T of the resist a n c e R of an elect ric al com po n e n t . (a) A stud e n t hypot h e siz e s that the resist a n c e is inver s ely propo r tio n a l to the tem p e r a t u r e . Use dat a from the gra p h to show whet h e r the hypot h e s i s is suppo r t e d . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 445 ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (b) A secon d stud e n t sugg e s t s that the relations hi p is of the form b lg R = a + T whe r e a and b are const a n t s . The stud e n t plots the grap h below. Erro r bar s have bee n includ e d for the sake of clarity. IB Questionbank Physics 446 (i) Explain how the grap h dra w n could be use d as evide nc e to suppo r t the stud e n t’s sugg e s tio n. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) Use the grap h to dete r m i n e the const a n t s a and b . b : ..................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. a: ..................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (4) (iii) Using your ans w e r s to (b)(ii), dete r m i n e a value for the resis t a n c e of the compo n e n t at a tem p e r a t u r e of 260 K. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 447 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tot al 11 mark s ) 31 1 . This ques tion is abou t forces. An athlet e trains by dra g gi n g a heavy load acros s a roug h horizont al surfac e. The athl et e exer t s a force of ma gni t u d e F on the load at an angle of 25° to the horizont al. (a) Once the load is moving at a stea dy spee d, the aver a g e horizon t a l friction al force acting on the load is 470 N. Calcula t e the aver a g e value of F that will ena bl e the load to move at const a n t spee d. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 448 (b) The load is moved a horizon t a l dista n c e of 2.5 km in 1.2 hour s. Calcula t e (i) the work done on the load by the force F. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 449 (ii) the minim u m aver a g e powe r requi r e d to move the load. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (c) The athlet e pulls the load uphill at the sam e spe e d as in par t (a). Explain, in ter m s of ene r gy cha n g e s , why the minim u m aver a g e powe r req ui r e d is grea t e r than in (b)(ii). ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 8 mark s ) 31 2 . This ques tion is abou t solar hea ti n g pan el s. (a) A village consist s of 120 hous e s . It is propos e d tha t solar pan els be used to provide hot wate r to the hous e s . The following data are availa ble. aver a g e powe r need e d per hous e to hea t wate r aver a g e surfac e solar inten sity efficiency of ene r gy conve r sio n of a solar pan el = 3.0 kW = 650 W m –2 = 18 % Calcula t e the minim u m surfa c e are a of the solar pan els requi r e d to provide the total powe r for wat e r hea tin g. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 450 ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (b) Sugg e s t two disadv a n t a g e s of using sola r powe r to provide ene r gy for heatin g wat e r. 1: ............................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... 2: ............................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 5 mark s ) 31 3 . This ques tion is abou t a gen e r a t o r . (a) Define electro m o t i v e force . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (b) The grap h shows the variatio n with time of elect r o m o tive force (emf) for a gene r a t o r . IB Questionbank Physics 451 IB Questionbank Physics 452 (i) Calculat e the rms value of the emf of the gen e r a t o r . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) The spee d of rotation of the gene r a t o r is halved with no othe r chan g e s being mad e. On the grap h, sketc h the variatio n of emf with time. (2) (iii) Explain why the grap h you drew in (ii) is differ e n t from the origin al grap h. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tota l 7 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 453 31 4 . This ques tion is abou t an ideal gas. (a) The grap h shows a pres s u r e- volum e (P–V ) rela tion s hi p for a fixed mas s of an ideal gas. The gas und e r g o e s a thr e e- stag e cycle AB, BC and CA. (i) Identify the isocho ric (isovolu m e t r i c) cha n g e of stat e. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Use data from the gra p h to show that the chan g e AB is isothe r m a l . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... IB Questionbank Physics 454 .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) IB Questionbank Physics 455 (iii) Stat e the two chan g e s for which the r m a l ene r gy is tra n sf e r r e d from the gas. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (iv) Calculat e the work done by the gas in the cha n g e BC. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (b) The amou n t of gas in part (a) is 0.74 mol. Calcula t e the maxim u m tem p e r a t u r e of the gas durin g the cycle in part (a). ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 456 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (4) IB Questionbank Physics 457 (c) The fixed mass of gas is heat e d from tem p e r a t u r e T 1 to T 2 at const a n t volum e. Explain why, if this fixed mas s of gas is hea t e d from T 1 to T 2 at const a n t pres s u r e , the amou n t of ene r gy requi r e d is differ e n t . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tot al 14 mark s ) 31 5 . This ques tion is abou t solar radi a tion. (a) Stat e the Stefan–Boltzm a n n law for a black body. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) The following data relat e to the Eart h and the Sun. Eart h- Sun dist a n c e radius of Eart h IB Questionbank Physics = 1.5 × 10 11 m = 6.4 × 10 6 m 458 radius of Sun surfac e tem p e r a t u r e of Sun IB Questionbank Physics = 7.0 × 10 8 m = 5800 K 459 (i) Use data from the table to show tha t the powe r radi a t e d by the Sun is abou t 4 × 10 26 W. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Calculat e the solar powe r incide n t per unit are a at a dista n c e from the Sun equ al to the Eart h’s dista n c e from the Sun. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (iii) The aver a g e powe r absor b e d per unit are a at the Eart h’s surfa c e is 240 W m –2 . Stat e two reas o n s why the value calcula t e d in (b)(ii) differs from this value. 1: ..................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. 2: ..................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (iv) Show that the value for powe r absor b e d per unit are a of 240 W m –2 is consist e n t with an aver a g e equilibri u m tem p e r a t u r e for Eart h of abou t 255 K. IB Questionbank Physics 460 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 461 (c) Explain, by refer e n c e to the gre e n h o u s e effect, why the aver a g e tem p e r a t u r e of the surfac e of the Eart h is gre a t e r tha n 255 K. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (d) Sugg e s t why the burnin g of fossil fuels may lead to an incr e a s e in the tem p e r a t u r e of the surfac e of the Eart h. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tot al 15 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 462 31 6 . This ques tion is abou t char g e- couple d device s (CCDs). (a) List two adva n t a g e s of using CCDs as comp a r e d to using film for imag e capt u r e . 1: ............................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... 2: ............................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) A CCD used to capt u r e X-ray imag e s consis t s of a squa r e 2600 0 × 2600 0 arr a n g e m e n t of pixels. Eac h pixel produ c e s 16 levels of infor m a t io n. Imag e s capt u r e d by the CCD are stor e d on a disk which can stor e a maxim u m of 4.0 × 10 11 bits of dat a. Deter m i n e the num b e r of imag e s that may be stor e d on one disk. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (c) Outline (i) how X-rays inciden t on a pixel in a CCD prod u c e a volta g e signal. IB Questionbank Physics 463 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 464 (ii) how voltag e signal s such as that in (c)(i) are use d to stor e the Xray infor m a ti o n. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (Tot al 10 mark s ) 31 7 . This ques tion is abou t wat e r wave s. A small sphe r e , mount e d at the end of a vertic al rod, dips below the surfa c e of shallow wat e r in a tray. The sphe r e is drive n vertic ally up and down by a motor att ac h e d to the rod. The oscillation s of the sphe r e prod u c e travelling waves on the surfac e of the wat e r. (a) Stat e what is mea n t by a travelling (prog r e s sive ) wave. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 465 (b) The diagr a m shows how the displa c e m e n t of the wat e r surfa c e at a particul a r insta n t in time varies with dista n c e from the sphe r e . The period of oscillation of the sphe r e is 0.027 s. Use the diagr a m to calcul a t e , for the wave, (i) the amplitu d e. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) the wavele n g t h . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (iii) the frequ e n cy. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 466 (iv) the spee d. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (c) The wave moves from region A into a region B of shallowe r wate r . The waves move mor e slowly in region B. The diag r a m (not to scale) shows som e of the wavefr o n t s in region A. (i) On the diagr a m , draw thr e e lines to comple t e the wavefro n t s in region B. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 467 (ii) Theory sugg e s t s that the wave spe e d c is relat e d to the wat e r dept h d by c = gd wher e g is a const a n t . The refr ac tive index for waves travelling from region A to region B is 1.4. Dete r mi n e the following ratio. w a t e dr e p t hin A w a t e dr e p t hin B ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (d) Anothe r sphe r e is dippe d into the wate r . The sphe r e s oscillat e in phas e. The diagr a m shows some lines in region A along which the distu r b a n c e of the wat e r surfa c e is a minim u m . IB Questionbank Physics 468 (i) Outline how the regions of minim u m distu r b a n c e occur on the surfac e. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (ii) The frequ e n cy of oscillation of the sphe r e s is incr e a s e d . Stat e and explain how this will affect the position s of minim u m distu r b a n c e . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... IB Questionbank Physics 469 .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tot al 15 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 470 31 8 . This ques tion is abou t projectile motion. A sphe r e is project e d horizont a lly. The sphe r e is photog r a p h e d at inte rv als of 0.10 s. The imag e s of the sphe r e are show n again s t a grid on the diagr a m . Air resis t a n c e is negligible. IB Questionbank Physics 471 (a) Use dat a from the diagr a m to det e r m i n e the accel e r a ti o n of free fall. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (b) Deter m i n e the spee d of the sphe r e 1.2 s afte r rele a s e . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (5) IB Questionbank Physics 472 (c) On the grid, draw the path of the sphe r e assu mi n g air resis t a n c e is not negligible. (2) (Tot al 10 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 473 31 9 . This ques tion is abou t nuclea r dec ay and ioniza tion. (a) A nucleu s of radiu m- 91 ( a nucle u s of radon (Rn). 226 9 1 Ra ) unde r g o e s alpha particle dec ay to form Identify the proton num b e r and nucleo n num b e r of the nucle u s of Rn. Proton num b e r : ........................................................................................... ................. Nucleo n num b e r : ........................................................................................... .............. (2) (b) Imm e di a t ely after the dec ay of a station a r y radiu m nucle u s , the alpha particl e and the rado n nucle u s move off in opposit e dire c tion s and at differ e n t spee d s . (i) Outline the reas o n s for thes e obse rv a ti o n s . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) IB Questionbank Physics 474 (ii) Show that the ratio in it ia kl in e t ice n e r g oy f a lp h ap a r t ic le in it ia kl in e t ice n e r g of y r a d o na t o m is abou t 56. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (c) The initial kinetic ener gy of the alpha par ticle is 4.9 MeV. As the alpha particl e pas s e s thro u g h air, it loses all its kine tic ene r gy by causin g the ionization of 1.7 × 10 5 air molec ul e s . (i) Stat e what is mean t by ionization. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Estim a t e , in joules, the aver a g e ene r gy nee d e d to ionize an air molecul e. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 475 ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 476 (d) Outline why a bet a particl e has a longe r rang e in air tha n an alpha particl e of the sam e ene r gy. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tot al 14 mark s ) 32 0 . This ques tion is abou t radio waves. A satellite is travelling directly away from a spac e shuttl e with a spe e d of 7.9 km s –1 . The satellite is tran s m i t ti n g radio wave s of frequ e n c y 150.00 0 000 MHz. (a) (i) Calculat e the frequ e n c y to which an astr o n a u t on the shuttl e will need to set a rec eive r in orde r to rec eive the signal from the satellite. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 477 (ii) The satellite now pass e s close to a secon d spac e shuttl e. Describ e the chan g e s tha t will nee d to be mad e to the setti ng of the receive r as the sat ellit e appr o a c h e s and moves away from the secon d shut tl e. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (iii) Sugg e s t why the form ul a use d in the calcul a tion in (a)(i) would not be suita bl e for radia tio n from a dista n t galaxy moving away from the Eart h at 90 % of the spe e d of light. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (b) A space shuttl e orbits at a heigh t of 300 km above the surfa c e of the Eart h. It carri es two pan els sepa r a t e d by a dista n c e of 24 m. The panels reflect light of wavel e n g t h 500 nm towa r d s an obse rv e r on the Eart h’s surfac e. The obse rv e r views the pan els with a tele sc o p e of ape r t u r e dia m e t e r 85 mm. The panels act as point sourc e s of light for the obse r v e r . (i) Describ e what is mea n t by the Rayleigh crite rion. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 478 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 479 (ii) Dete r mi n e whet h e r the imag e s of the pan els form e d by the teles co p e will be resolve d. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (Tot al 11 mark s ) 32 1 . This ques tion is abou t an elect ric al hea t e r . An elect ric al heat e r consist s of two hea ti n g elem e n t s E 1 and E 2 . The elem e n t s are conn e c t e d in par allel. Each elem e n t has a switc h and is conne c t e d to a supply of emf 240 V. The supply has negligibl e inter n al resis t a n c e . Elem e n t E 1 is mad e from wire that has a cros s- section a l are a of 6.8 × 10 –8 m 2 . The resistivity of the wire at the oper a ti n g tem p e r a t u r e of the elem e n t is 1.1 × 10 –6 Ωm. IB Questionbank Physics 480 (a) (i) The total lengt h of wire is 4.5 m. Show tha t the resis t a n c e of E 1 is 73 Ω. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 481 (ii) Calculat e the powe r outp u t of E 1 with only this elem e n t conne c t e d to the supply. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (iii) Elem e n t E 2 is mad e of wire of the sam e cross- section and mat e ri al as E 1 . The lengt h of wire use d to make E 2 is 1.5 m. Dete r mi n e the total powe r outpu t whe n both E 1 and E 2 are conne c t e d to the supply. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (iv) With refer e n c e to the powe r outp u t, explain why it would be inapp r o p r i a t e to conn e c t the hea ti n g ele m e n t s in serie s. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... IB Questionbank Physics 482 .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) IB Questionbank Physics 483 (b) Each elem e n t in the elect ri c a l heat e r is woun d as a coil as show n. Each tur n of the coil may be conside r e d to act as a cur r e n t- car ryin g long str ai g h t wire. (i) On the diagr a m , draw the mag n e t i c field arou n d a curr e n tcarryi n g long str ai g h t wire. The arro w shows the dire c tion of the curr e n t . (3) (ii) Stat e and explain whet h e r the turn s of wire will attr a c t or rep el one anot h e r . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (Tot al 15 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 484 IB Questionbank Physics 485 32 2 . This ques tion is abou t the hydro g e n atom. (a) A par allel beam of visible light is shone throu g h mona t o m i c hydro g e n gas. The radiation em er gi n g from the gas is analys e d by comp a r i n g the inciden t and eme r gi n g inte nsi ti e s at various wavele n g t h s . It is found that at a wavelen g t h of 490 nm the inte nsity of the eme r g e n t bea m is grea tly reduc e d . The diagr a m shows some of the elect r o n ene r gy stat e s of the hydrog e n atom wher e n is the qua n t u m num b e r of the ene r gy level. (i) Calculat e the ene r gy, in eV, of a photon of light of wavele n g t h 490 nm. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 486 (ii) Use your answ e r in (a)(i) and the ene r gy level diag r a m to explain the redu c tio n in inten sity of the eme r g e n t bea m . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (4) (b) Outline how the Schr ö di n g e r model of the hydrog e n atom leads to the idea of discr e t e elect r o n ene r gy stat e s . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 487 ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (4) (Tot al 10 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 488 32 3 . This ques tion is abou t det er m i ni n g some prop e r t i e s of the sta r Wolf 359. (a) The star Wolf 359 has a par allax angle of 0.419 arcs e c o n d s . (i) Describ e how this par allax angl e is mea s u r e d . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (4) (ii) Calculat e the dista n c e in light- year s from Eart h to Wolf 359. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (iii) Stat e why the met h o d of par allax can only be use d for star s at a dist a n c e of less than a few hund r e d par s e c s from Eart h. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 489 ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 490 (b) The ratio a p p a r e nbtr ig h t n e of s s Wo lf3 5 9 a p p a r e nbtr ig h t n e os sf t h eS u n is 3.7 × 10 –15 . Show that the ratio lu m in o s itoyf Wolf3 5 9 lu m in o s itof y t h eS u n is 8.9 × 10 –4 . (1ly = 6.3 × 10 4 AU) ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (4) (c) The surf ac e tem p e r a t u r e of Wolf 359 is 2800 K and its luminosity is 3.5 × 10 23 W. Calcula t e the radius of Wolf 359. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 491 (d) By refer e n c e to the data in (c), sugg e s t why Wolf 359 is neith e r a white dwarf nor a red giant. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tot al 15 mark s ) 32 4 . This ques tion is abou t the density of the unive r s e . (a) Define critical densit y . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (b) Explain how the futur e of the unive r s e may be pre dic t e d by comp a r i n g the estim a t e d density of the unive r s e to the critic al density. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 492 ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 493 (c) Explain why the existe n c e of dark matt e r make s it difficult to me a s u r e the density of the univer s e . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (Tota l 5 mark s ) 32 5 . This ques tion is abou t stellar evolution. (a) Descri b e how a larg e cloud of hydro g e n gas can lead to conditions that initiat e a fusion reac tio n. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (b) Stat e the prop e r t y of a main sequ e n c e sta r that det e r m i n e s for how long hydro g e n in its cor e fuse s into helium. ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (c) Stat e the end prod u c t of nucle a r fusion proc e s s e s in the core of IB Questionbank Physics 494 (i) a red giant. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 495 (ii) the large s t red supe r giant s . ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (Tota l 6 mark s ) 32 6 . This ques tion is abou t galactic motion. (a) The wavele n g t h of the Lyma n- alph a line in the hydrog e n spec t r u m is mea s u r e d in the labor a t o r y to be 122 nm. In the hydro g e n spec t r u m of a galaxy, the Lyman- alph a line is me a s u r e d to be 147 nm. Dete r m i n e the dista n c e of this galaxy from the Eart h. Assum e that the Hubbl e const a n t H 0 is 75km s –1 M pc –1 . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (b) Sugg e s t on e reas o n why the r e is unc e r t a i n t y in the value of the Hubbl e const a n t . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (Tota l 4 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 496 32 7 . This ques tion is abou t modula tio n. (a) A car rie r wave may be amplit u d e modula t e d or frequ e n c y modul a t e d . Stat e (i) what is mean t by modula tio n . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) why car rie r waves are modula t e d . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (b) A sinusoid al car ri e r wave has a frequ e n c y of 500 kHz and an amplit u d e of 8.0 V. The carri e r wave is frequ e n c y modula t e d by a sinusoi d al infor m a t io n signal of frequ e n cy 2.5 kHz and amplit u d e 1.2 V. The frequ e n c y deviation of the carri e r wave is 15 kHz V –1 . Describ e qua n tit a tiv ely the variation with time of the car ri e r wave. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 497 (4) (Tota l 6 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 498 32 8 . This ques tion is abou t optic fibre tra n s m i s sio n. The variation with time t of the input powe r to an optic fibre is show n in Diagr a m 1. The variation with time t of the outp u t powe r from the optic fibre is show n in Diagr a m 2. The scales are the sam e on both diag r a m s . (a) Stat e and explain the feat u r e of the gra p h s tha t shows tha t the r e is (i) att e n u a t i o n of the signal. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) signal noise. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 499 (b) The dur a tio n (time width) of the signal incre a s e s as it travels along the optic fibre. (i) Stat e two reas o n s for this incr e a s e d time dur a tio n. 1:...................................................................................................... .................. 2:...................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) Sugg e s t why this incre a s e in the width of the pulse sets a limit on the frequ e n cy of pulse s that can be tran s m i t t e d along an unint e r r u p t e d lengt h of optic fibre. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (Tota l 7 mark s ) 32 9 . This ques tion is abou t the use of sat ellite s for com m u ni c a ti o n. (a) (i) Stat e what is me a n t by a geost a t io n a r y sat ellite. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) Explain the advan t a g e s of the use of geos t a tio n a r y satellite s for com m u ni c a ti o n. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 500 ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 501 (b) Explain the adva n t a g e s of the use of pola r- orbitin g satellite s for com m u ni c a t io n. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tota l 7 mark s ) 33 0 . This ques tion is abou t a mobile phon e netwo r k. A pas s e n g e r in a car is using a mobile phon e. Stat e and explain the role of the base stations and the cellula r excha n g e as the car moves from one cell to anot h e r . ......................................................................................................................... ........................ ......................................................................................................................... ........................ ......................................................................................................................... ........................ ......................................................................................................................... ........................ ......................................................................................................................... ........................ ......................................................................................................................... ........................ ......................................................................................................................... ........................ ......................................................................................................................... ........................ ......................................................................................................................... IB Questionbank Physics 502 ........................ ......................................................................................................................... ........................ (Tota l 5 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 503 33 1 . This ques tion is abou t an amplifier circuit. The diagr a m below show s an amplifie r circuit incor p o r a t i n g an ideal oper a tio n al amplifier (op- amp). The oper a ti o n al amplifier uses a +9 V / 0 / –9 V supply. (a) Calcula t e the gain of the amplifier circuit. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 504 (b) Deter m i n e the outp u t pote n ti al V out for value s of input pote n ti al V in equal to (i) –0.9 V. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) +2. 0 V. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (Tota l 5 mark s ) 33 2 . This ques tion is abou t a compo u n d microsc o p e , sphe ri c al abe r r a t i o n and chro m a t i c aber r a t i o n. (a) An object O is place d in front of the objective lens of a compo u n d micros c o p e as shown below. The focal point s of the objective lens are at F. The micros c o p e is in nor m al adjus t m e n t . Withou t dra wi n g a ray diag r a m , label the appr oxi m a t e positions , on the princip al axis, of (i) the image prod u c e d by the objec tive lens (label this position X). (1) (ii) the focal points of the eye lens (label thes e points E). (1) IB Questionbank Physics 505 (iii) the final imag e (label this image Y). (1) IB Questionbank Physics 506 (b) An object is viewed throu g h a convex lens that has bee n corr e c t e d for sphe ric al aber r a t i o n. For a partic ul a r object dista n c e , the image of the objec t is as show n below. Anothe r convex lens of the sam e focal lengt h, but not corr e c t e d for sphe ric al aber r a t i o n, is now used to view the object. The object dista n c e is unch a n g e d . In the spac e below, draw the imag e as it would be see n throu g h this secon d lens. The imag e as seen thro u g h the cor r e c t e d lens is show n as a broke n line. (2) (c) Explain how chro m a t i c abe r r a t i o n arise s whe n an objec t is viewe d throu g h a single lens. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 7 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 507 33 3 . This ques tion is abou t the scatt e r i n g of light. (a) Stat e an appr oxi m a t e wavele n g t h for (i) red light. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) blue light. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (b) With refer e n c e to your answ e r s in (a), explain why the settin g Sun appe a r s reddis h in colour. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tota l 5 mark s ) 33 4 . This ques tion is abou t two- sour c e inte rfe r e n c e . A doubl e slit is arr a n g e d so that its plan e is nor m al to a bea m of lase r light, as show n below. IB Questionbank Physics 508 The wavelen g t h of the light is 640 nm. The slit sepa r a t i o n in the doubl e slit arr a n g e m e n t is 0.85 mm. Cohe r e n t light eme r g e s from the slits and an interf e r e n c e patt e r n is observ e d on a scre e n. The scre e n is par allel to the plane of the double slits. The dist a n c e betw e e n the slits and the scre e n is 2.4 m. IB Questionbank Physics 509 (a) (i) Stat e what is me a n t by cohe r e n t light. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Explain how an interfe r e n c e patt e r n is form e d on the scre e n. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (b) Calcula t e the sepa r a t io n of the fringe s in the inte rfe r e n c e patt e r n on the scre e n. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (c) The interf e r e n c e patt e r n in (b) consis t s of a serie s of alter n a t e light and dark fringe s. The inte n sity of the light from one slit is now red uc e d . Sugg e s t the effect on the app e a r a n c e of the fringe s. IB Questionbank Physics 510 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 8 mark s ) 33 5 . This ques tion is abou t X-rays. (a) In an X-ray tube having a tungs t e n tar g e t , elect r o n s are accele r a t e d from rest throu g h a pote n ti al differ e n c e of 45 kV. Calcula t e the ran g e of wavele n g t h s tha t will be obse rv e d in the X-ray spect r u m produ c e d by this bom b a r d m e n t . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (b) Explain the origins of the feat u r e s of a cha r a c t e r i s ti c X-ray spec t r u m . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 511 ..................... (3) (Tota l 6 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 512 33 6 . This ques tion is abou t thin film inte rf e r e n c e . (a) The diagr a m below shows a ray of monoc h r o m a t i c light incide n t on a thin film in air. On the diag r a m , draw the pat hs of rays tha t would give rise to interfe r e n c e as seen by an eye in the region nea r E. (2) (b) White light is incide n t on a soap bubbl e. Explain why the soap film appe a r s colour e d. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 4 mark s ) 33 7 . This ques tion is abou t relativistic kine m a t i c s . (a) Define inertial fram e of refer e n c e . ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 513 ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 514 (b) Ann and Sue are twins. Sue rem ai n s on Eart h. Ann travels to the sta r Sirius in a spac es hi p moving at a spe e d of 0.80c, as mea s u r e d by Sue. The dist an c e betw e e n Eart h and Sirius is 8.8 ly, as mea s u r e d by Sue. (i) Calculat e the time elaps e d , as mea s u r e d by Sue, betw e e n Ann leaving Ear t h and rea c hi n g Sirius. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Stat e and explain whet h e r Ann or Sue mea s u r e s the prope r time betw e e n Ann leaving Eart h and arriving at Sirius. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (iii) Calculat e the time take n for the spa c e s hi p to reac h Sirius, as meas u r e d by Ann. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (iv) As Ann appr o a c h e s Sirius, she sends a radio mess a g e back to Sue. The dista n c e betw e e n Sirius and Eart h, as mea s u r e d by Ann, is 5.28 ly. Deter m i n e the time, as mea s u r e d by Ann, that it takes for the signal to reac h Sue. ......................................................................................................... IB Questionbank Physics 515 .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (c) As soon as Ann arrives at Sirius, she imme di a t e ly turn s arou n d and ret u r n s to Eart h at a spee d of 0.80c, as mea s u r e d by Sue. The ret u r n journ ey gives rise to the twin par a d ox. (i) Stat e what is mean t by the twin par a d ox. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Outline how the twin par a d ox is resolve d. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tot al 13 mark s ) 33 8 . This ques tion is abou t relativistic mass and ene r gy. (a) Define rest mas s. IB Questionbank Physics 516 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (b) Explain why par ticle s canno t be accel e r a t e d to the spe e d c. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 517 (c) Two proto n s are travelling towa r d s one anot h e r along the sam e str aig h t line. The spee d of eac h proton is 0.70c as me a s u r e d by a labor a t o r y observ e r . Calcul a t e the rela tive velocity of app ro a c h , as mea s u r e d in the fram e of refe r e n c e of one of the proto n s . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (d) Deter m i n e the pote n ti al differ e n c e throu g h which a proton mus t be accel e r a t e d in orde r to rea c h a spe e d of 0.70c. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tota l 9 mark s ) 33 9 . This ques tion is abou t black holes. (a) Define the Sch w a r z s c hil d radius . ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 518 ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 519 (b) Calcula t e the Schw a r z s c hil d radius for an objec t of mas s 2.0 × 10 31 kg. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (c) A star s hi p is station a r y just outsid e the event horizon of a black hole. A space station is also station a r y and is locat e d far away from the black hole and any othe r mas sive objec t. (i) The star s hi p tran s m i t s a radio signal to the spac e station. Explain why the signal receive d at the spac e station is shifte d to a lower frequ e n c y than the tra n s m i t t e d frequ e n c y. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 520 (ii) The star s hi p rem ai n s sta tion a r y just outsid e the event horizon for one hour as meas u r e d by an obse rv e r in the star s hi p. The time elaps e d , as meas u r e d by an obse rv e r in the spac e station, is ten hour s. Deter m i n e , in ter m s of the Schw a r z s c hil d radius R s of the black hole, the dist an c e of the sta r s hi p from the event horizon of the black hole. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (Tota l 8 mark s ) 34 0 . This ques tion is abou t heari n g. A stud e n t listen s to music using a pers o n a l ear p h o n e . The powe r of the soun d produ c e d by the ear p h o n e is 0.19 μW. The powe r i s evenly distrib u t e d over the tymp a ni c me m b r a n e of are a 54 mm 2 . (a) Calcula t e, for the surfac e of the tymp a ni c me m b r a n e , (i) the sound inten sity. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 521 (ii) the sound inten sity level (IL ). ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (b) Comm e n t , with resp e c t to the effect on the hea ri n g of the stud e n t , on the intensi ty level calcul at e d in (a)(ii). ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 6 mark s ) 34 1 . This ques tion is abou t ultr as o u n d . (a) Define acous tic impe d a n c e . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 522 (b) The table gives values of the acous tic impe d a n c e for air and soft tissue. acous tic impe d a n c e / kg m –2 s –1 air 430 soft tissue 1.63 × 10 6 The inten sity reflectio n coefficie n t for two medi a of impe d a n c e s Z 1 and Z 2 is Z1 Z 2 Z Z 2 IR = 1 (i) 2 Dete r mi n e the intensi ty reflectio n coefficie nt betw e e n air and soft tissue. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) Explain why air betw e e n an ultra s o u n d prob e and the skin (soft tissu e) of a pers o n preve n t s ultr a s o u n d diag no sis taking plac e. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) IB Questionbank Physics 523 (iii) Stat e and explain how the proble m you have explain e d in (b)(ii) is overco m e . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tota l 8 mark s ) 34 2 . This ques tion is abou t nuclea r ma gn e t i c reson a n c e (NMR). Outline the basic principles of nucle a r mag n e t i c reso n a n c e (NMR) imagin g. ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... IB Questionbank Physics 524 ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... (Tota l 6 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 525 34 3 . This ques tion is abou t radiation. (a) Stat e, in the cont ext of radia tio n mea s u r e m e n t , wha t is me a n t by (i) expos u r e . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) abso r b e d dose. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (iii) equivale n t dose. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (b) The ene r gy requir e d to prod u c e one ion pair in air is 34 eV. The expos u r e in a workpla c e is found to be 2.5 × 10 –3 C kg –1 . Deter m i n e the ener gy given to 1.0 g of air as a res ult of this expos u r e . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 526 ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (4) IB Questionbank Physics 527 (c) The expos u r e to X-ray radia tio n during a comp u t e d tomog r a p h y (CT) scan impos e s a finite risk for the patie n t. (i) Sugg e s t the nat u r e of this risk. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Explain why such a risk is thou g h t to be acce p t a bl e by both the patien t and the medic al profes sion. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tot al 10 mark s ) 34 4 . This ques tion is abou t funda m e n t a l inte r a c ti o n s . (a) Stat e an excha n g e par ticle for (i) the weak inter a c ti o n. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) the elect r o m a g n e t i c inter a c tio n. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 528 (b) Comm e n t , with refer e n c e to the mass of the excha n g e particle s , on the rang e of the weak and elect r o m a g n e t i c inte r a c ti o n s . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (c) Descri b e the proce s s repr e s e n t e d by the Feyn m a n diagr a m below. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (d) Stat e what is mea n t by a virtual par ticle. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 529 (e) Explain how the Heise n b e r g unce r t a i n t y princi ple for ene r gy and time applies to the inter a c t io n in (c). ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (f) The unce r t ai n t y in the time for the elect r o m a g n e t i c inte r a c tio n betw e e n two elect r o n s is 1.6 × 10 –16 s. Dete r mi n e the unc e r t a i n t y in the ene r gy of the virtu al photon. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tot al 10 mark s ) 34 5 . This ques tion is abou t particle dete c tio n. (a) Outline how particle s prod u c e visible trac ks in a bubble cha m b e r . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 530 ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 531 (b) Stat e two reas o n s why wire cha m b e r s are now use d rat h e r tha n bubbl e cha m b e r s . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (c) Below is a sketc h of the track s in a bubble cha m b e r of an elect r o n and a positr o n, prod u c e d by the anni hila tion of a photon. Ther e is a mag n e t i c field dire c t e d nor m al to the plane of the pape r. Explain why the tracks of the particle s are spirals. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 532 ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tota l 8 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 533 34 6 . This ques tion is abou t meso n s and baryon s. (a) Stat e the qua r k cont e n t of meson s and baryon s . Meson s: ................................................................................................... .................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... Baryons: .................................................................................................. .................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) Explain why both meso n s and baryon s can be desc ri b e d as colourle s s . Meson s: ................................................................................................... .................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... Baryons: .................................................................................................. .................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (c) A neg a tive pion, π –, collide s with a station a r y proton, produ ci n g a neut r o n and an unknow n par ticle, X. π– + p → n + X (i) Stat e the char g e on par ticle X. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 534 (ii) Deduc e whet h e r particle X is a meson or a baryo n. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tota l 7 mark s ) 34 7 . This ques tion is abou t pair prod u c tio n. (a) Estim a t e the tem p e r a t u r e below which spont a n e o u s pair prod u c tio n of elect r o n s and positr o n s cannot occur. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (b) It is sugg e s t e d that, in the early unive r s e , ther e was slightly mor e mat t e r than anti- matt e r . Using your ans w e r to (a), stat e why the r e is cur r e n tly only sta bl e mat t e r in the univer s e . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 535 ..................... (2) (Tota l 5 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 536 34 8 . The cur r e n t in a resisto r is mea s u r e d as 2.00 A ± 0.02 A. Which of the following corr e c tly identifies the absolut e unc e r t a i n t y and the perc e n t a g e unce r t ai n t y in the curr e n t ? Abso l u t e unc e r t a i n t y Per c e n t a g e un c e r t a i n t y A. ± 0.02 A ±1 % B. ± 0.01 A ± 0.5 % C. ± 0.02 A ± 0.01 % D. ± 0.01 A ± 0.005 % (Tot al 1 mar k ) 34 9 . Which of the following lists only two vector qua n ti ti e s ? A. mas s, ener gy, work B. mom e n t u m , work, spee d C. weight, force, accele r a ti o n D. mom e n t u m , ener gy, displa c e m e n t (Tot al 1 mar k ) 35 0 . Sam a n t h a walks along a horizont a l path in the direc tio n shown. The curve d par t of the pat h is a semi- circle. The mag ni t u d e of her displ ac e m e n t from point P to point Q is app r oxi m a t ely A. 2 m. B. 4 m. C. 6 m. D. 8 m. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 537 35 1 . Which of the following may be dete r m i n e d from a spe e d- time gra p h ? A. Displac e m e n t B. Dista nc e C. Power D. Forc e (Tot al 1 mar k ) 35 2 . Step h e n pus h e s two boxes P and Q, tha t stay in cont a c t, along a roug h table, with a force F of 30 N. Box P has a mas s of 2.0 kg and box Q has a mas s of 4.0 kg. Both boxes move with cons t a n t spee d. The res ult a n t force on box Q is A. 0 N. B. 5.0 N. C. 15 N. D. 30 N. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 538 35 3 . A ball moves along the inside of a horizont a l semi- circ ula r ring as show n. The diagr a m is a view from above. Which arrow repr e s e n t s the dire c tion of the aver a g e force on the ball? (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 539 35 4 . A ball is throw n vertically upwa r d s and come s down again. Air resist a n c e is negligible. Which of the following gra p h s shows how the gravit a tion a l poten ti al ene r gy E P varies with time t ? (Tot al 1 mar k ) 35 5 . A pum p extr ac t s wate r from a well of dept h h at a const a n t rat e of R kg s –1 . What is the powe r requir e d to raise the wat e r ? A. R gh B. Rgh C. Rg h D. hg R (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 540 35 6 . A box that is at rest with resp e c t to horizon t a l grou n d cont ain s a fixed quan ti ty of an ideal gas. The inte r n a l ene r gy of the gas is U and its tem p e r a t u r e is T . The box is now ma d e to move at cons t a n t spe e d with res p e c t to the grou n d . Which of the following gives the cha n g e , if any, in the inter n al ene r gy and the tem p e r a t u r e of the gas afte r the box has bee n moving for some time? Int er n a l en e r g y Te m p e r a t u r e A. no chan g e no cha n g e B. no chan g e incr e a s e C. incr e a s e no cha n g e D. incr e a s e incr e a s e (Tot al 1 mar k ) 35 7 . Object P has a mas s m P and specific hea t capa city c P . Object Q has a mas s m Q and specific heat capacity c Q . The tem p e r a t u r e of eac h objec t incr e a s e s by the sam e amou n t . Which of the following gives the ratio t h e r m aeln e r g y tnr safe r r e tdoo b je c P t t h e r m aeln e r g y tnr safe r r e tdoo b je c Q t ? mP cQ A. mQ c P B. mP cP mQ c Q mQ c Q C. mP cP mQ c P D. mP cQ (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 541 35 8 . For two object s to be in ther m a l equilibri u m they mus t A. be in cont a c t with each othe r. B. radiat e equ al amou n t s of powe r. C. have the sam e ther m a l capa city. D. be at the sam e tem p e r a t u r e . (Tot al 1 mar k ) 35 9 . The shock abso r b e r s of a car, in good working condition, ens u r e that the vertical oscillations of the car are A. und a m p e d . B. lightly dam p e d . C. moder a t e ly dam p e d . D. critically dam p e d . (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 542 36 0 . The gra p h s show how the accele r a ti o n a of four differe n t par ticle s varies with their displace m e n t x. Which of the par ticles is executi n g simple har m o ni c motion? (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 543 36 1 . The diagr a m below is a snap s h o t of wave fronts of circul a r wave s emitt e d by a point sour c e S at the surfac e of wate r . The sour c e vibra t e s at a frequ e n c y f = 10.0 Hz. The spee d of the wave front is A. 0.15 cm s –1 . B. 1.5 cm s –1 . C. 15 cm s –1 . D. 30 cm s –1 . (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 544 36 2 . Two coher e n t point sour c e s S 1 and S 2 emit sphe ri c a l waves. Which of the following bes t desc ri b e s the inte n si ty of the wave s at P and Q? P Q A. maxim u m minim u m B. minim u m maxim u m C. maxim u m maxim u m D. minim u m minim u m (Tot al 1 mar k ) 36 3 . An alph a particle is accel e r a t e d thro u g h a pote n ti al differ e n c e of 10 kV. Its gain in kinetic ene r gy is A. 10 eV. B. 20 eV. C. 10 keV. D. 20 keV. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 545 36 4 . A copp e r wire, of elect ric resis t a n c e R , has a lengt h L and a cross- section S are a S . Anothe r copp e r wire has a lengt h 2 L and a cross- section are a of 2 . Which of the following is the resist a n c e of this wire? A. R 4 B. R 2 C. 2R D. 4R (Tot al 1 mar k ) 36 5 . The circuit shows a light- depe n d e n t resisto r (LDR) in serie s with a resisto r and a cell. The emf of the cell is ε. The inte r n a l resist a n c e of the cell is negligible. When light shines on the LDR, the pote n ti al differ e n c e acros s the resis to r will A. stay the sam e. B. decr e a s e . C. incr e a s e but always be less tha n ε. D. incr e a s e and exce e d ε. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 546 36 6 . The radius of a char g e d sphe ri c a l condu c t o r is R. Which of the following grap h s best show s how the mag nit u d e of the elect ric al field str e n g t h E varies with dista n c e r from the cent r e of the sphe r e ? (Tot al 1 mar k ) 36 7 . Which of the following gives the acc ele r a t io n of an elect r o n of elect ric char g e e and mas s m in a unifor m elect ric field of stre n g t h E ? A. E B. Ee C. Ee m D. m Ee (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 547 36 8 . A particle, of mas s m and char g e q , moves with velocity v perp e n d i c ul a r ly to a mag n e ti c field. The mag nit u d e of the mag n e ti c forc e acting on the par ticl e at a par tic ul a r point is F. Which of the following gives the mag ni t u d e of the mag n e ti c field str e n g t h at that point? A. F q B. F m C. F ν D. F qν (Tot al 1 mar k ) 36 9 . Which of the following decay sequ e n c e s would result in the daug h t e r nucle u s having the sam e proto n num b e r as the par e n t nucle u s ? A. Alpha followed by gam m a B. Beta (β – ) followe d by gam m a C. Alpha followed by bet a (β –) followe d by beta (β –) D. Beta (β –) followed by gam m a followe d by gam m a (Tot al 1 mar k ) 12 37 0 . The differe n c e betw e e n the mas s of a 6 C nucle u s and the sum of the mas s e s of the individu al nucleo n s is 0.1 u. Which of the following is app r oxi m a t ely the bindin g ener gy of the nucle u s ? A. 90 MeV B. 90 MeV c –2 C. 8 MeV D. 8 MeV c –2 (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 548 37 1 . The proc es s by which a heavy nucle u s splits into two light e r nuclei is known as A. fission. B. fusion. C. radioac tive decay. D. artificial (induc e d) tran s m u t a t i o n . (Tot al 1 mar k ) 37 2 . Which of the following cor r e c tly shows a rene w a bl e and a non- ren e w a bl e sour c e of ener gy? Ren e w a b l e No n- ren e w a b l e A. oil geot h e r m a l B. wind biofuels C. ocea n waves nucle a r D. nat u r al gas coal (Tot al 1 mar k ) 37 3 . Critical mas s refer s to the amou n t of fissile mat e ri a l that A. will allow fission to be sust ai n e d . B. is equivale n t to 235 g of ura ni u m . C. will produ c e a growin g chain rea c tion. D. is the minim u m mass nece s s a r y for fission to take plac e. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 549 37 4 . The annu al variation s of solar powe r incide n t per unit are a at a partic ul a r point on the Eart h’s surfac e is mainly due to the cha n g e in the A. dista n c e betw e e n the Ear t h and the Sun. B. angle at which the solar rays hit the surfa c e of the Eart h. C. aver a g e albedo of the Eart h. D. aver a g e cloud cover of the Eart h. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 550 37 5 . The wate r in a res er voir behind a da m drops from an initial height H 0 above a turbin e to prod u c e hydro el e c t r i city. At time t = T , h = 0. The gra p h shows the variation with time t of the height h of the wat e r above the tur bi n e. Which of the following is a mea s u r e of the maxim u m theor e t i c a l elect ric powe r availabl e? A. H 0 and the slope of the gra p h B. T and the slope of the grap h C. T and the are a unde r the gra p h D. H 0 and the are a und e r the gra p h (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 551 37 6 . Each squa r e met r e of the Sun’s surfac e emits S joules per secon d. The radi us of the Sun is r, and the Sun is at a mea n dista n c e R from the Eart h. Which of the following gives the solar powe r incide n t per unit are a of the top layer of the Eart h’s atmo s p h e r e ? A. r S R B. r S R C. R S r D. R S r 2 2 (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 552 37 7 . The diagr a m shows a simple clima t e model for Ear t h. The tem p e r a t u r e of the grou n d is T g and is ass u m e d to radia t e as a black body. The tem p e r a t u r e of the atmos p h e r e is T a and has an emis sivity ε. In the model, the intensi ty radia t e d from the groun d equ als the inte nsity Tg radi at e d from the atm os p h e r e towa r d s the grou n d. What is the ratio Ta ? A. ε4 B. ε C. ε4 D. 1 1 (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 553 37 8 . Data analysis ques tion. Gillian carrie d out an experi m e n t to inves tig a t e the crat e r s form e d whe n steel balls are dropp e d into sand. To try and find the relation s hi p betw e e n the diam e t e r of the crat e r and the ene r gy of impac t of ste el balls of the sam e diam e t e r , she dropp e d a ste el ball from differ e n t heigh t s h into sand and mea s u r e d the res ultin g diam e t e r d of the crat e r . The data are show n plott e d below. (a) The unce r t ai n t y in the mea s u r e m e n t of d is ±0. 4 0 cm; the unce r t a i n t y in h is too small to be show n. Draw erro r bars for the data point (0.2, 0.047) and the dat a point (2.0, 0.10). (2) (b) Draw a best- fit line for the data points. (2) (c) The origin al hypot h e si s, ma d e by Gillian, was that the diam e t e r of the crat e r is directly propo r tio n a l to the ene r gy of impa c t of the ste el balls. Explain why the data does not suppo r t this hypot h e si s. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 554 ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 555 (d) Since Gillian’s data did not suppo r t her hypot h e s i s, she res e a r c h e d to find alter n a t iv e hypot h e s e s . She found that the r e are two theo ri e s used to predict a relation s hi p betw e e n d and h . In orde r to find which theor y is bes t suppo r t e d by the dat a, she proc e s s e d the data in two sepa r a t e ways. The proce s s e d dat a are shown below. (i) Draw a line of best- fit on each gra p h. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 556 (ii) Stat e and explain which theo ry is best suppo r t e d by the stud e n t’s data. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tot al 11 mark s ) 37 9 . This ques tion is abou t circula r motion and global war mi n g. (a) A car is travelling at const a n t spe e d of 18 m s –1 arou n d a horizon t a l bend in the road. The mas s of the car is 1.5 × 10 3 kg and the bend forms part of a circle of radius 2.0 × 10 3 m. (i) Stat e why the car is accele r a ti n g . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Dete r mi n e the friction al forc e betw e e n the tyres of the car and the surfac e of the roa d that prod u c e s the acc el e r a t io n. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 557 (2) IB Questionbank Physics 558 (b) It is sugg e s t e d that the use of fossil fuels to powe r car s has led to an enha n c e m e n t of the gree n h o u s e effect. (i) Stat e the reas o n for this sugg e s t io n. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Outline on e mech a ni s m by which the enha n c e d gre e n h o u s e effect may lead to an incr e a s e in global war mi n g . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (Tota l 7 mark s ) 38 0 . This ques tion is abou t chan g e of pha s e of a liquid and late nt heat of vaporiza tion. (a) Stat e the differ e n c e betw e e n evapo r a t i o n and boiling with refe r e n c e to (i) tem p e r a t u r e . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 559 (ii) surfac e area of a liquid. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (b) A liquid in a calori m e t e r is hea t e d at its boiling point for a mea s u r e d period of time. The following data are availa ble. Power rating of heat e r Time for which liquid is hea t e d at boiling point 10 2 s Mass of liquid boiled away 10 –2 kg = 15 W = 4.5 × = 1.8 × Use the data to det e r m i n e the specific late nt hea t of vaporiz a tio n of the liquid. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (c) Stat e and explain on e rea s o n why the calcula tio n in (b) will give a value of the specific laten t hea t of vaporiz a tion of the liquid tha t is grea t e r than the true value. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 560 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 7 mark s ) 38 1 . This ques tion is abou t fossil fuels and the gre e n h o u s e effect. (a) Stat e two reas o n s why most of the world’s ene r gy cons u m p t i o n is provide d by fossil fuels. 1. ............................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... 2. ............................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 561 (b) A powe r station has an outpu t powe r of 500 MW and an over all efficiency of 27 %. It uses nat u r al gas as a fuel tha t has an ene r gy density of 56 MJ kg –1 . (i) Define ener g y densit y . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Dete r mi n e the rat e of cons u m p t i o n of nat u r a l gas in the powe r station. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (c) Outline why the enha n c e d gre e n h o u s e effect may res ult in an incr e a s e in the tem p e r a t u r e of the Ear t h’s surfa c e . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 562 (d) (i) The solar inte nsity at the position of the Eart h is 1380 –2 W m . The aver a g e albe do of Eart h is 0.300. Sta t e why an aver a g e value of albe d o is quot e d. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 563 (ii) Show that the aver a g e reflec t e d inte n sity from the Eart h is about 100 W m –2 . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (4) (e) One of the expect e d res ult s of global war mi n g is an incre a s e d sea level. The incre a s e in volum e ΔV for a tem p e r a t u r e incr e a s e ΔT is given by ΔV = γV ΔT. Show, using the following dat a, that the res ultin g rise in sea level is about 0.5 m. Temp e r a t u r e incr e a s e = 2.0 °C Surfa c e are a of ocea n s on Eart h 8 3.6 × 10 km = 2 Avera g e ocea n dept h = 3.0 km γ = 8.8 × 10 –5 K–1 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tot al 16 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 564 38 2 . This ques tion is abou t radioa ctive dec ay and bindin g ene r gy. (a) Descri b e what is mean t by radioa c tive decay. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) A nucleu s of thallium- 206 (Tl-206) unde r g o e s radioa c tive dec ay to a nucleu s of lead- 206 (Pb- 206). In the reac tio n equa tio n below, identify the proton num b e r Z of lead and the par ticle x . 206 8 2T β x 206 Z P b Z : ............................................................................................................. .................... x : ............................................................................................................. .................... (2) (c) The mas s of a Tl-206 nucle u s is 191 870 MeV c –2 . Dete r mi n e the binding ener gy per nucleo n of Tl-206. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 565 (4) IB Questionbank Physics 566 (d) Stat e why the bindin g ene r gy of Pb- 206 is gre a t e r tha n tha t of Tl-206. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (Tota l 9 mark s ) 38 3 . This ques tion is abou t oscillation s and waves. (a) A rect a n g u l a r piece of wood of lengt h l floats in wate r with its axis vertical as show n in diagr a m 1. The lengt h of wood below the surfa c e is d . The wood is pus h e d vertically down w a r d s a dista n c e A such that a lengt h of wood is still above the wate r surfac e as show n in diag r a m 2. The wood is the n relea s e d and oscillat e s vertic ally. At the insta n t show n in diag r a m 3, the wood is moving down w a r d s and the lengt h of wood bene a t h the surfac e is d + x . (i) On diag r a m 3, draw an arrow to show the direc tion of the accele r a ti o n of the wood. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 567 (ii) The accel e r a t io n a of the wood (in m s –2 ) is relat e d to x (in m) by the following equ atio n. a = 14 x l Explain why this equ a tio n show s that the wood is exec u ti n g simpl e har m o ni c motion. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (iii) The period of oscillation of the wood is 1.4 s. Show tha t the lengt h l of the wood is 0.70 m. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) IB Questionbank Physics 568 (b) The wood in (a), as show n in diagr a m 2, is rele a s e d at time t = 0. On the axes below, sketc h a gra p h to show how the velocity v of the wood varies with time over one period of oscillation. (1) (c) The dist an c e A that the wood is initially pus h e d down is 0.12 m. (i) Calculat e the magni t u d e of the maxim u m accele r a ti o n of the wood. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) On your sketc h gra p h in (b) label with the lette r P one point wher e the mag nit u d e of the accel e r a ti o n is a maxim u m . (1) IB Questionbank Physics 569 (d) The oscillations of the wood gen e r a t e waves in the wat e r of wavelen g t h 0.45 m. The grap h shows how the displa c e m e n t D, of the wate r surfa c e at a particul a r dista n c e from the wood varies with time t . Using the grap h, calcula t e the (i) spee d of the waves. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) ratio of the displac e m e n t at t = 1.75 s to the displa c e m e n t at t = 0.35 s. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 570 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 571 (iii) ratio of the ener gy of the wave at t = 1.75 s to the ene r gy at t = 0.35 s ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (Tot al 15 mark s ) 38 4 . This ques tion is abou t elect ri ca l resist a n c e and elect ric circ uit s. (a) Define resista n c e and stat e Ohm’s law. Resist a n c e: .............................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... Ohm’s law: ................................................................................................. ................. ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) A resis to r mad e from a met al oxide has a resist a n c e of 1.5 Ω. The resisto r is in the form of a cylinde r of lengt h 2.2 × 10 –2 m and radius 1.2 × 10 –3 m. Calcula t e the resistivity of the met al oxide. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (c) The man uf a c t u r e r of the resisto r in (b) gua r a n t e e s its resis t a n c e to be IB Questionbank Physics 572 within ±1 0 % of 1.5 Ω provide d the powe r dissip a tio n in the resis to r does not excee d 1.0 W. Calcula t e th e maxim u m curr e n t in the resis to r for the power dissipa tion to be equal to 1.0 W. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 573 (d) The resi stan c e of each of the resis to r s in the circ uit below is mea s u r e d to be 1.5 Ω with an accu r a c y of ±1 0 %. The cell has an emf of 2.0 V and negligible inte r n a l resist a n c e . (i) Define emf . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Dete r mi n e the minim u m and the maxim u m powe r that could be dissipa t e d in this circuit. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (Tot al 10 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 574 IB Questionbank Physics 575 38 5 . This ques tion is abou t mom e n t u m , ene r gy and powe r. (a) In his Principia Math e m a t i c a Newt o n expr e s s e d his third law of motion as “to every action the r e is always oppos e d an equ al rea c tion”. Stat e what New to n mean t by this law. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (b) A book is relea s e d from rest and falls towa r d s the surfa c e of Eart h. Discus s how the cons e rv a t io n of mom e n t u m applies to the Eart h- book syste m . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 576 (c) A larg e swingin g ball is use d to drive a horizon t al iron spike into a vertical wall. The cent r e of the ball falls thro u g h a vertic al height of 1.6 m befor e striking the spike in the position show n. The mas s of the ball is 3.5 kg and the mas s of the spike is 0.80 kg. Imm e di a t ely after striking the spike, the ball and spike move toge t h e r . Show that the (i) spee d of the ball on striking the spike is 5.6 m s –1 . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) ene r gy dissip at e d as a res ult of the collision is abou t 10 J. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 577 ......................................................................................................... .................. (4) IB Questionbank Physics 578 (d) As a result of the ball striking the spike, the spike is drive n a dista n c e 7.3 × 10 –2 m into the wall. Calcula t e , ass u m i n g it to be const a n t , the friction force F betw e e n the spike and wall. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (e) The machin e that is used to rais e the ball has a useful powe r outp u t of 18 W. Calculat e how long it take s for the mac hi n e to raise the ball throu g h a height of 1.6 m. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tot al 15 mark s ) 38 6 . This ques tion is abou t elect ri c and gravit a tio n a l fields (a) Stat e, in ter m s of elect r o n s , the differ e n c e betw e e n a cond u c t o r and an insulat o r . ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 579 ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 580 (b) Sugg e s t why ther e mus t be an elect ric field inside a cur r e n t- carryin g cond u c t o r . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (c) The mag ni t u d e of the elec t ric field str e n g t h inside a condu c t o r is 55 N C –1 . Calculat e the force on a free elect r o n in the cond uc t o r . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (d) The elect ric force betw e e n two point cha r g e s is a funda m e n t a l forc e as is the gravit ation al forc e betw e e n two point mas s e s . Sta t e on e similarity betw e e n thes e two force s and on e differ e n c e (othe r than the fact that one applies to cha r g e and the othe r to mas s). Similari ty: ............................................................................................... .................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... Differ e n c e: .............................................................................................. .................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (e) The force on a mas s of 1.0 kg falling freely nea r the surfa c e of Jupite r IB Questionbank Physics 581 is 25 N. The radius of Jupite r is 7.0 × 10 7 m. (i) Stat e the value of the ma gni t u d e of the gravit a tion a l field str e n g t h at the surfac e of Jupite r. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 582 (ii) Calculat e that the mas s of Jupite r is about 1.8 × 10 27 kg. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tot al 10 mark s ) 38 7 . This ques tion is abou t vision and the eye. (a) Stat e on e function of (i) cone cells. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) rod cells. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (b) Descri b e the distri b u tio n of cone and rod cells on the retin a. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 583 ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 584 (c) An object is to be viewed in very dim light. With refe r e n c e to your ans w e r to (b) explain why the objec t is most clea rly see n whe n looke d at sidew ay s rat h e r than direc tly. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 6 mark s ) 38 8 . This ques tion is abou t stan di n g wave s. A string that is fixed at both ends is mad e to vibra t e in the funda m e n t a l (first har m o nic) mode. The fixed ends of the string are at x = 0 and x = L . Each point on the string oscillat e s in simple har m o ni c motion. The displac e m e n t y of the string at a point x at time t is given by the equ a tio n y = A cos(50 0 π t ) πx wher e A = 12sin 2 . In thes e form ul a e x is in met r e s and t is in secon d s . Using this equ a tio n, (a) explain why the amplitu d e of the sta n di n g wave is not cons t a n t . ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 585 ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 586 (b) calculat e the frequ e n c y of the stan di n g wave. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (c) show that L = 2.0 m. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (Tota l 4 mark s ) 38 9 . This ques tion is abou t diffrac tio n and resolution. (a) Light from a monoc h r o m a t i c point sour c e S 1 is incide n t on a nar r o w rect a n g ul a r slit. IB Questionbank Physics 587 After pas sin g thro u g h the slit, the light is incide n t on a scre e n som e dista n c e away from the slit. The gra p h shows how the inte nsi ty distrib u tio n on the scre e n varies with the angle θ show n in the diagr a m . (i) The width of the slit is 4.0 × 10 –4 m. Use dat a from the gra p h to calcula t e the wavel en g t h of the light. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 588 (ii) An identical sour c e S 2 is plac e d close to S 1 as show n. The imag e s of the two sourc e s on the scre e n are just resolve d accor di n g to the Rayleigh crit e rio n. On the gra p h above, dra w the inten sity distri b u tio n of the secon d sour c e . (1) (b) The Very Larg e Array (VLA) is use d to analys e radio signals from dista n t galaxies. The combi n e d diam e t e r of the VLA is 36 km. A region of linea r size L inside the radio galaxy M87 emits radio wave s with a frequ e n c y of 43 GHz. The galaxy is a dista n c e 4.7 × 10 23 m from Ear t h. The VLA can just resolve the radio emittin g region. Estim a t e the value of L . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tota l 6 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 589 39 0 . This ques tion is abou t polarizatio n. (a) A bea m of unpola riz e d light of inte nsity I 0 is incide n t on a polariz e r . The polarizatio n axis of the pola riz e r is initially vertic al as show n. The polarizer is then rota t e d by 180° in the direc tio n show n. On the axes below, sketc h a grap h to show the varia tio n with the rotatio n angle θ, of the tran s mi t t e d light inte n sity I, as θ varies from 0° to 180°. Label your sketc h- gra p h with the lette r U. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 590 (b) The bea m in (a) is now repla c e d with a polariz e d bea m of light of the sam e inten si ty. The plane of polarizatio n of the light is initially par allel to the polariza tio n axis of the pola riz e r. The polarizer is then rota t e d by 180° in the direc tio n show n. On the sam e axes in (a), sketc h a gra p h to show the variatio n with the rotation angle θ, of the tra n s mi t t e d light inte n sity I, as θ varies from 0° to 180°. Label your sketc h- gra p h with the lette r P. (2) (Tota l 4 mark s ) 39 1 . This ques tion is abou t the photo el e c t r i c effect. (a) In the photo el ec t r i c effect, elect r o n s are emitt e d from a met al surfa c e almost imm edi at ely after light is incide n t on the surfa c e, i.e. withou t any time delay. Explain this obse r v a tio n with refe r e n c e to Einst ei n’s theor y of the photoel e c t r i c effect. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 591 (b) The grap h shows the variatio n with incide n t light freq u e n c y f of the maxim u m kinetic ene r gy E K of the emitt e d elect r o n s . Use the grap h to (i) estim a t e the work function of the met al surfa c e . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) calcula t e the maxim u m spe e d of the emitt e d elect r o n s for incide n t light of frequ e n c y 5.0 × 10 15 Hz. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (Tota l 6 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 592 IB Questionbank Physics 593 39 2 . This ques tion is abou t qua n t u m aspe c t s of the elect r o n . (a) The ene r gy of elect r o n s in atom s is said to be qua n tiz e d. Stat e wha t is mea n t by qua n tize d ener gy. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (b) An elect r o n that is confine d to move in a region of lengt h L can only have ener gi e s given by the equ a tio n h2n2 2 E n = 8πm L whe r e n is a positive integ e r . For L = 1.0 × 10 –10 m, use the equa tio n above to (i) calcula t e that the smalle s t differ e n c e betw e e n the allowe d ene r gi e s of the elect r o n is 5.8 × 10 –18 J. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) det e r m i n e the wavele n g t h of the photon whos e ene r gy is 5.8 × 10 –18 J. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 594 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) IB Questionbank Physics 595 (c) Part of the emission spect r u m of hydro g e n is show n in the diag r a m . Sugg e s t whet h e r this spec t r u m can be explain e d by the model in (b). ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 8 mark s ) 39 3 . This ques tion is abou t radioa ctive dec ay. (a) The decay const a n t for a par tic ul a r isotop e is λ = 0.048 s –1 . A sam pl e of the isotop e initially cont ai n s 2.0 × 10 12 nuclei of this isotop e. (i) Define decay cons ta n t . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Estim a t e the num b e r of nuclei that will dec ay in the first secon d. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 596 (b) The grap h shows the variatio n with time t of the activity A of a sam pl e cont ai nin g radioac tive mat e ri al that consis t s of two differe n t isotop e s . Each isotop e decays into a stabl e daug h t e r isotop e . (i) Use the grap h to explain how it may be dedu c e d that the sa m pl e cont ai n s mor e than one isotop e . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 597 (ii) One of the isotop e s in the sam pl e has a half- life tha t is shor t e r than 0.20 s. Use the gra p h to estim a t e the half- life of the othe r isotop e. Explain your workin g. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tota l 6 mark s ) 39 4 . This ques tion is abou t char g e- couple d device s (CCDs). (a) Light from an object that is incide n t on the pixels of a CCD gives rise to pote n ti al differ e n c e s acros s the pixels. Outline how the s e pote n ti al differ e n c e s are used to prod u c e an imag e of the object. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) The CCD of a partic ul a r digital cam e r a has 5.0 × 10 6 pixels and a collectin g are a of 22 mm 2 . Light of inte n si ty 1.4 W m –2 is incide n t on the collectin g are a of the CCD for a time of 85 ms. The aver a g e ene r gy of the photon s of the incide n t light is 3.6 × 10 –19 J. The quan t u m efficiency of the CCD is 75 %. (i) Stat e what is mean t by qua n t u m efficiency. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 598 (ii) Show that the num b e r of photon s incide n t on on e pixel of the CCD in the time interv al of 85 ms is appr oxi m a t e ly 1.5 × 10 6 . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (iii) The capa cit a n c e of a pixel of the CCD is 12 pF. Show tha t the poten ti al differ e n c e est a blis h e d acros s the pixel is appr oxi m a t e ly 15 mV. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (iv) The voltag e in (b)(iii) is digitize d into a four bit bina ry num b e r . Dete r mi n e the bina ry equivale n t of this volta g e . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (c) CCDs dete c ti n g X-rays are now use d in medic al diagno si s. Stat e the adva n t a g e to the patien t of an X-ray CCD det e c t o r with high qua n t u m efficiency. IB Questionbank Physics 599 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (Tot al 10 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 600 39 5 . This ques tion is abou t the mobile phone syste m . In the mobile phon e syste m , a partic ul a r geog r a p h i c are a is divide d into a num b e r of cells with a base station in eac h cell, eac h conn e c t e d to a cellula r exch a n g e . Describ e the function of the bas e sta tion s and the cellula r excha n g e . Base stations : ................................................................................................... ...................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... Cellula r exch a n g e : ................................................................................................ ................. ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... (Tota l 4 mark s ) 39 6 . This ques tion is abou t the oper a tio n al amplifie r. (a) On the axes below draw a sketc h gra p h to show the variatio n with input voltag e V in of the outpu t volta g e V out of a non- inverti n g oper a ti o n al amplifier. IB Questionbank Physics 601 (2) IB Questionbank Physics 602 (b) A tem p e r a t u r e war nin g devic e make s use of a buzze r tha t sound s whe n the poten ti al differe n c e acros s it is 24 V. The circ uit in the war ni n g device is show n. It is requi r e d that the buzze r should sound whe n the tem p e r a t u r e of the ther m i s t o r rises above 50 °C. (i) Stat e the voltag e at point Q. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) At a tem p e r a t u r e of 50 °C the resist a n c e of the the r m i s t o r is R . Explain why the buzze r will sound whe n the tem p e r a t u r e rise s above 50 °C. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (Tota l 6 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 603 39 7 . This ques tion is abou t relativistic kine m a t i c s . (a) Stat e what is mea n t by prope r lengt h and prop e r time inte rv al. Prope r lengt h: ............................................................................................. ................. ................................................................................................................. ..................... Prope r time interv al: ........................................................................................... ........ ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) A space s hi p moves with spe e d v = 0.600 c relative to a spa c e sta tion. Two laser s , A and B, on the spac e station are 5.00 m apa r t as mea s u r e d by the space station obse rv e r s . The ga m m a factor for a spee d of v = 0.600 c is γ =1. 2 5. (i) A radio signal is sent to the spac e s hi p from the spac e sta tion. The tran s mi s s io n lasts for 6.00 s accor di n g to spa c e station clocks. Calculat e the dur atio n of the tra n s m i s sio n accor di n g to the spac e s hi p obse rv e r s . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... IB Questionbank Physics 604 .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 605 (ii) Calculat e the dista n c e betw e e n the laser s A and B accor di n g to the space s hi p obse rv e r s . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (c) The laser s in (b) are fired si m u l t a n e o u s l y accor di n g to the spa c e stat i o n obse rv e r s . Light from each laser make s a ma rk on the spac e s hi p. The spac e s hi p obse rv e r s mea s u r e the dista n c e betw e e n the two ma rk s to be 6.25 m. Accordi n g to the space s hi p obse rv e r s (i) stat e which laser was fired first. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) det e r m i n e the differ e n c e in time betw e e n the firings of the two laser s. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tota l 9 mark s ) 39 8 . This ques tion is abou t qua r k s. The table below gives the elect ric cha r g e of the thr e e light e s t qua r k s in ter m s of e , the char g e of the proton. IB Questionbank Physics 606 Quark flavo u r Elec t r i c ch ar g e / e IB Questionbank Physics up u 2 3 down d 1 3 str a n g e s 1 3 607 (a) Using the dat a in the table, dete r m i n e the (i) quar k conte n t of a meson with cha r g e +1 and str a n g e n e s s 0 and that of a baryon with cha r g e –1 and str a n g e n e s s –3. Meso n: ............................................................................................ .................. Baryon: ............................................................................................ ................. (2) (ii) possible spin values of the meson in (a)(i). ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (b) Stat e the Pauli exclusion principle. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (c) 3 Explain how the baryon with qua r k cont e n t uuu and spin 2 does not violate the Pauli exclusion principle. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (d) In the Feyn m a n diagr a m show n a blue down qua r k emits a gluon and prod u c e s a red qua r k. IB Questionbank Physics 608 IB Questionbank Physics 609 Deduc e the (i) quar k flavour (type) of the prod u c e d qua r k. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) colour quan t u m num b e r s of the emitt e d gluon. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (e) The positive kaon K + (qua r k cont e n t u s ) dec ays into an anti- muon and a neut ri no accor di n g to the rea c tion below. K+ → µ + + ν Explain how it may be dedu c e d that this dec ay is a weak inter a c ti o n proce s s . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 610 (f) The diagr a m shows thre e of the inter a c ti o n vertic e s for the wea k inter a c ti o n. Using the app r o p r i a t e vert ex, dra w a Feyn m a n diag r a m for the dec ay K + → µ + + ν labelling all particl e s involve d. (3) (Tot al 11 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 611 39 9 . This ques tion is abou t the luminosity, size and dista n c e of star s. The Her tzs p r u n g–R u s s ell (HR) diag r a m shows the varia tion with spec t r a l class of the absolut e mag ni t u d e of sta r s . The star Capella and the Sun are in the sa m e spec t r a l class (G). Using the HR diag r a m , (a) (i) the Sun. sugg e s t why Capella has a gre a t e r surfa c e are a than ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 612 (ii) estim a t e the luminosity of Capella in ter m s of that of the Sun. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (iii) calcula t e the radius of Capella in ter m s of that of the Sun. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (b) The spect r o s c o pi c par allax meth o d can be use d to me a s u r e the dista n c e of star Vega. (i) Using the HR diagr a m , sta t e the absolut e mag nit u d e of Vega. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) The app a r e n t mag nit u d e of Vega is 0.0. Dete r mi n e (in pars e c ) the dist a n c e of Vega from Eart h. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... IB Questionbank Physics 613 .................. (3) IB Questionbank Physics 614 (iii) Light from Vega is abso r b e d by a dust cloud betw e e n Vega and Eart h. Sugg e s t the effect, if any, this will have on dete r m i ni n g the dista n c e of Vega from Eart h. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (c) Vega is a very massive sta r. Sta t e why Vega does not und e r g o gravit atio n al collaps e. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (Tot al 12 mark s ) 40 0 . This ques tion is abou t cosmic microw a v e backg r o u n d radia tio n (CMB) and the density of the univer s e. The gra p h shows the relative inte nsity of the CMB as a function of wavele n g t h . IB Questionbank Physics 615 (a) Explain how this grap h is consist e n t with the Big Bang model of the univer s e . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (b) The density of the univer s e will det e r m i n e its ultim a t e fate. Outline the proble m s associa t e d with dete r m i ni n g the density of the unive r s e . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 5 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 616 40 1 . A cart of mas s M is on a horizont a l frictionle s s table. The cart is conn ec t e d to an object of weigh t W via a pulley. Which of the following is the accel er a ti o n of the cart? A. W M g W W B. W M g C. Mg W D. 0 (Tot al 1 mar k ) 40 2 . An ideal gas has pres s u r e p 0 and volum e V 0 . The num b e r of molec ul e s of the gas is doubl ed withou t chan gi n g the tem p e r a t u r e . What is the new value of pres s u r e times volum e ? A. p 0V 0 4 B. p 0V 0 2 C. p 0V0 D. 2 p 0V0 (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 617 40 3 . The diagr a m shows the pres s u r e–vol u m e (PV ) rela tion s hi p for a gas. Which of the following area(s) is/ar e equal to the work done by the gas as it expa n d s ? A. are a I B. are a II C. are a I + are a II D. are a I – are a II (Tot al 1 mar k ) 40 4 . The shock abso r b e r s of a car, in good working condition, ens u r e that the vertical oscillations of the car are A. und a m p e d . B. lightly dam p e d . C. moder a t e ly dam p e d . D. critically dam p e d . (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 618 40 5 . An orga n pipe of lengt h L is ope n at one end and close d at the othe r . Which of the following gives the wavele n g t h of the secon d har m o nic sta n di n g wave in the pipe? A. L 2 B. L C. 4L D. 4L 3 (Tot al 1 mar k ) 40 6 . A man stan di n g by the shor e obs e rv e s sea wave s appr o a c h i n g at a frequ e n c y of 0.20 Hz. A man on a boat obse r v e s tha t wave s are app r o a c hi n g the boat at a frequ e n c y of 0.50 Hz. The spe e d of the wave s is 2.0 m s –1 . Which of the following gives a possible value for the spe e d of the boat and its directio n? Sp e e d / m s –1 Dire c t i o n A. 3.0 away from the shor e B. 3.0 towa r d s the shor e C. 1.2 away from the shor e D. 1.2 towa r d s the shor e (Tot al 1 mar k ) 40 7 . In a monoch r o m a t i c liquid cryst al display (LCD), suc h as thos e use d in calcula t o r s , the pur po s e of the liquid cryst al is to A. chan g e colour from white to black whe n a seg m e n t is to be displaye d. B. lubrica t e the small gap betw e e n the plat e s to preve n t over h e a ti n g . C. rotat e the plan e of polariz a tio n of the light pas si ng throu g h it. D. act as a cond u c ti n g pat h w a y betw e e n the segm e n t elect r o d e s . (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 619 40 8 . A par allel bea m of light with a wavele n g t h 600 nm pass e s throu g h a single nar r o w slit and forms a diffraction patt e r n on a scre e n. The angle at which the first diffractio n minim u m is form e d is 2.0 × 10 –3 rad. What would be the angle of the first diffrac tion minim u m for light of wavele n g t h 400 nm? A. 3.0 × 10 –3 rad B. 2.0 × 10 –3 rad C. 1.3 × 10 –3 rad D. 1.2 × 10 –3 rad (Tot al 1 mar k ) 40 9 . The gra p h shows how the cur r e n t I in a resis to r varies with the volta g e V applied acros s it. Which of the following gives the resist a n c e of the resis to r, whe n I = I 1 ? A. V1 I1 B. The slope of the curve at the point (V 1 , I 1 ) C. I1 V1 D. The inver s e of the slope of the curve at the point ( V 1 , I 1 ) (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 620 41 0 . Two 10 Ω resis to r s are conn e c t e d as show n. What is the resist a n c e acros s PQ? A. 0 Ω B. 5 Ω C. 10 Ω D. 20 Ω (Tot al 1 mar k ) 41 1 . A unifor m mag n e t i c field is per p e n di c ul a r to the plane of a loop of condu c ti n g wire. The field is direct e d out of the plan e of pape r. The ma g nit u d e of the mag n e ti c field is decr e a s i n g at a cons t a n t rat e. Which of the following gives the corr e c t stat e and corr e c t dire c tio n of the cur r e n t in the wire? Curre n t Dire c t i o n A. varying clockwis e B. const a n t clockwis e C. varying count e rclockwis e D. const a n t count e rclockwis e (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 621 41 2 . The gra p h shows th e variation of the induc e d emf ε of a gene r a t o r as a function of time. IB Questionbank Physics 622 The frequ e n cy of rotation of the gene r a t o r is halve d. Which of the following grap h s corr e c tly shows the variation of the new induc e d emf ε as a function of time? (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 623 41 3 . Which of the following is true about gravit a tion a l field lines? A. They are always tang e n t i al to equipo t e n ti a l surfa c e s . B. They are always perp e n di c ul a r to equipo t e n t i al surfa c e s . C. They can be both tang e n ti al or per p e n d i c ul a r to equipot e n t i al surfac e s . D. They can have any angle to the equipot e n t i al surfa c e s . (Tot al 1 mar k ) 41 4 . Which of the following is true about the gravit a tion a l pote n ti al V due to a point mass at a dista n c e r from the point mas s? A. B. 1 r and always positive 1 r and always neg ative V V C. V D. V 1 r 2 and always positive 1 r 2 and always positive (Tot al 1 mar k ) 41 5 . An astro n a u t in orbit arou n d Eart h is said to be “weightl e s s ”. This is due to the fact that the A. gravit atio n al force on the astr o n a u t is zero. B. ast ro n a u t and the spac e c r a f t expe ri e n c e the sa m e accel e r a t io n. C. ast ro n a u t and the spac e c r a f t expe ri e n c e the sa m e gravit a tio n a l force. D. gravit atio n al field at the position of the spa c e c r a f t is zero. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 624 41 6 . Which of the following decay sequ e n c e s would result in the daug h t e r nucle u s having the sam e proto n num b e r as the par e n t nucle u s ? A. Alpha followed by gam m a B. Beta (β –) followed by gam m a C. Alpha followed by bet a (β –) followe d by beta (β –) D. Beta (β –) followed by gam m a followe d by gam m a (Tot al 1 mar k ) 41 7 . A radioac tive sour c e emits alpha par ticle s that the n travel throu g h air. With refer e n c e to the rang e of the alpha par ticle s consid e r the following thre e qua n ti ti es . I. The char g e of the alph a par ticl e II. The kinetic ener gy of the alpha par ticle III. The density of the air Which of the above dete r m i n e s the rang e of the alpha par ticle s? A. I only B. II only C. I and II only D. I, II and III (Tot al 1 mar k ) 41 8 . Photoel e ct r o n emission only occur s if the light incide n t on a met al surfa c e is A. coher e n t . B. above a cert ai n minim u m inte nsi ty. C. below a cert ai n minim u m frequ e n c y. D. below a cert ai n minim u m wavel e n g t h . (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 625 41 9 . Elect r o n s are accel e r a ti n g from rest thro u g h a pot e n ti al differ e n c e of V . The de Broglie wavelen g t h λ of the elect r o n s is propo r tio n a l to which of the following? A. V B. 1 V C. V 1 D. V (Tot al 1 mar k ) 42 0 . The diagr a m shows som e of the ene r gy levels of a hypot h e t ic al atom. The atom is excite d to the ene r gy level n = 4. Which of the following tran si tion s will prod u c e a photo n of the longe s t and the short e s t wavele n g t h ? Lon g e s t wav el e n g t h Sh or t e s t wave l e n g t h A. 4 →3 4 →1 B. 4 →1 4 →3 C. 2 →1 4 →3 D. 4 →3 2 →1 (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 626 42 1 . In the Schr ö di n g e r model of the hydro g e n atom, it is ass u m e d tha t elect r o n s A. are mas sl es s par ticles. B. are waves. C. oscillat e. D. can be descri b e d by wave functions . (Tot al 1 mar k ) 42 2 . The ener gy of α-par ticles in α-dec ay and the ene r gy of γ-rays in γ-dec ay are discr e t e . This provide s evide n c e for the existe n c e of A. nuclea r ener gy levels. B. neut ri n o s. C. atomic ene r gy levels. D. isotop e s . (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 627 42 3 . The gra p h below shows the num b e r of nuclei N of a radioa c tive isotop e as a function of time t . The slope of the curve at any given time is A. indep e n d e n t of the decay const a n t . B. propo r tio n al to the half- life of the isotop e. C. propo r tio n al to the num b e r of radioa c tive nuclei re m ai ni n g at that time. D. propo r tio n al to the num b e r of radioa c tive nuclei dec ay e d. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 628 42 4 . Worldwi d e, the use of gas powe r e d tur bi n e s is beco mi n g more com m o n than the use of oil powe r e d turbi n e s . A stud e n t mak e s the following thr e e stat e m e n t s about gas powe r e d turbin e s as comp a r e d to oil powe r e d turbin e s . I. They are mor e efficient. II. They prod u c e mor e the r m a l ene r gy per unit of mass. III. They prod u c e less CO 2 per unit of outp u t ene r gy. Which stat e m e n t ( s ) could be a possible reas o n for favourin g gas powe r e d turbin e s ? A. I only B. II only C. I and II only D. I, II and III (Tot al 1 mar k ) 42 5 . To ret riev e infor m a ti o n stor e d on a CD, light of wavele n g t h 800 nm is use d. To ret riev e infor m a ti o n stor e d on a DVD, light of wavele n g t h 400 nm is used. p it h e ig hof t t h eCD Which of the following gives the ratio p it h e ig hot f t h eDVD ? A. 8 B. 2 C. 1 D. 0.5 (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 629 426. N photo n s are incide n t on a pixel of a CCD. Each photon caus e s one elect r o n of char g e e to be emitt e d . The capa ci t a n c e of the pixel is C. What is the res ultin g poten ti al differ e n c e acros s the pixel? A. NeC B. C Ne C. Ne C D. Ce N (Tot al 1 mar k ) 42 7 . The linear mag nificatio n of a digital cam e r a is M . The lengt h of one side of a pixel is l. A pictur e of two points of an object sepa r a t e d by a dista n c e D is take n. MD l is The imag e s of the points will be resolve d on the CCD if the ratio A. smaller than 1. B. equal to 1. C. equal to 2 or mor e. D. at least 10 or more. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 630 42 8 . Data analysis ques tion. Gillian carrie d out an experi m e n t to inves tig a t e the crat e r s form e d whe n steel balls are dropp e d into sand. To try and find the relation s hi p betw e e n the diam e t e r of the crat e r and the ene r gy of impac t of ste el balls of the sam e diam e t e r , she dropp e d a ste el ball from differ e n t heigh t s h into sand and mea s u r e d the res ultin g diam e t e r d of the crat e r . The data are show n plott e d below. (a) The unce r t ai n t y in the mea s u r e m e n t of d is ±0. 4 0 cm; the unce r t a i n t y in h is too small to be show n. Draw erro r bars for the data point (0.2, 0.047) and the dat a point (2.0, 0.10). (2) (b) Draw a best- fit line for the data points. (2) (c) The origin al hypot h e si s, ma d e by Gillian, was that the diam e t e r of the crat e r is directly propo r tio n a l to the ene r gy of impa c t of the ste el balls. Explain why the data does not suppo r t this hypot h e si s. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 631 ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 632 (d) Since Gillian’s data did not suppo r t her hypot h e s i s, she res e a r c h e d to find alter n a t iv e hypot h e s e s . She found that the r e are two theo ri e s used to predict a relation s hi p betw e e n d and h . 1 3 Theory 1 predict s that d = cons t (h) and theory 2 pre dic t s that d = 1 4 const (h) . In orde r to test which theo ry her dat a suppo r t s , she plott e d a gra p h of lg( d ) again s t lg( h ). The plot produ c e d a straig h t line tha t could be dra w n throu g h all the erro r bar s. IB Questionbank Physics 633 The grap h includ es the lines of maxim u m and minim u m gra di e n t s bas e d on the first erro r bar for the first non- zero dat a point and the last error bar. The last error bar is too small to be show n. Sta t e and explain if the original data suppo r t theory 1 or theor y 2. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (4) (Tot al 11 mark s ) 42 9 . This ques tion is abou t radioa ctive dec ay and bindin g ene r gy. (a) Descri b e what is mean t by radioa c tive decay. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) A nucleu s of potas si u m- 40 (K-40) unde r g o e s radioa c tive dec ay to a IB Questionbank Physics 634 nucleu s of argon- 40 (Ar- 40). In the reac tio n equa tio n below, identify the proton num b e r Z of argon and the particle x . 40 19K 4Z0 Ar β x Z : ............................................................................................................. .................... x : ............................................................................................................. .................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 635 (c) The mas s of a K-40 nucleu s is 37 216 MeV c –2 . Dete r m i n e the bindin g ener gy per nucleon of K-40. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (4) (d) Stat e why the bindin g ene r gy of Ar-40 is gre a t e r tha n that of K-40. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (Tota l 9 mark s ) 43 0 . This ques tion is abou t chan g e of pha s e of a liquid and late nt heat of vaporiza tion. (a) Stat e the differ e n c e betw e e n evapo r a t i o n and boiling with refe r e n c e to (i) tem p e r a t u r e . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 636 ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 637 (ii) surfac e area of a liquid. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (b) A liquid in a calori m e t e r is hea t e d at its boiling point for a mea s u r e d period of time. The following data are availa ble. Power rating of heat e r Time for which liquid is hea t e d at boiling point 10 2 s Mass of liquid boiled away 10 –2 kg = 15 W = 4.5 × = 1.8 × Use the data to det e r m i n e the specific late nt hea t of vaporiz a tio n of the liquid. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (c) Stat e and explain on e rea s o n why the calcula tio n in (b) will give a value of the specific laten t hea t of vaporiz a tion of the liquid tha t is grea t e r than the true value. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 638 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 7 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 639 43 1 . This ques tion is abou t induc e d emf and tra nsfo r m e r s . (a) One of the coils of a par tic ul a r tra n sfor m e r is conn e c t e d in serie s with a switch and a batt e r y. The coil has low resis t a n c e . On closing the switch it is obs erv e d that the curr e n t take s a cert ai n amou n t of time to reac h its final const a n t value. Explain this obs e rv a ti o n with refe r e n c e to Far a d ay’s law and Lenz’s law. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (b) In a particul a r powe r station the volta g e gen e r a t e d is step p e d up by a tran sfo r m e r . The root mea n squa r e volta g e is incr e a s e d by a factor of 2 × 10 3 . The outpu t power of the tran sfor m e r is tra n s m i t t e d to a town by cable s. (i) Outline what is mea n t by the root me a n squa r e value of a timevarying voltag e. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) Stat e the best estim a t e for the factor by which the powe r loss in the cables is redu c e d as a res ult of step pi n g up the volta g e. IB Questionbank Physics 640 ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (Tota l 6 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 641 43 2 . This ques tion is abou t stan di n g wave s. (a) Stat e two prop e r t i e s of a sta n di n g (station a r y) wave. 1. ............................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... 2. ............................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) The diagr a m shows an orga n pipe that is open at one end. The lengt h of the pipe is l. The frequ e n c y of the funda m e n t a l (first har m o ni c) note emitt e d by the pipe is 16 Hz. (i) On the diagr a m , label with the lette r P the position along the pipe whe r e the amplitu d e of oscillation of the air molec ul e s is the large s t . (1) (ii) The spee d of sound in the air in the pipe is 330 m s –1 . Calcula t e the lengt h l. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 642 ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) IB Questionbank Physics 643 (c) Use your answ e r to (b)(ii) to sugg e s t why it is bett e r to use orga n pipes that are closed at one end for produ ci n g low frequ e n c y note s rat h e r than pipes that are open at both ends. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 8 mark s ) 43 3 . This ques tion is abou t polarized light. (a) Disting ui s h betw e e n polariz e d and unpol a riz e d light. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 644 (b) A bea m of plan e polarized light of inte n sity I 0 is incide n t on an analys e r . The directio n of the bea m is at right angle s to the plan e of the analys e r . The angle betw e e n the tra n s m i s sio n axis of the analys e r and the plan e of polarizatio n of the light is θ. In the position show n the tra ns m i s sio n axis of the analys e r is par allel to the plane of polariz a tion of the light (θ = 0). On the axes, sketc h a grap h to show how the inte nsity I of the tran s m i t t e d light varies with θ as the analys e r is rotat e d throu g h 180°. (2) (Tota l 4 mark s ) 43 4 . This ques tion is abou t elect ri c fields and elect ri c a l resist a n c e . (a) Stat e, in ter m s of elect r o n s , the differ e n c e betw e e n a cond u c t o r and an insulat o r . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 645 (b) Sugg e s t why ther e mus t be an elect ric field inside a cur r e n t- carryin g cond u c t o r . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (c) The mag ni t u d e of the elec t ric field str e n g t h inside a condu c t o r is 55 N C –1 . Calculat e the force on a free elect r o n in the cond uc t o r . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (d) Define resista n c e . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (e) A resis to r mad e from a met al oxide has a resis t a n c e of 1.5 Ω. The resisto r is in the form of a cylinde r of lengt h 2.2 × 10 –2 m and radius 1.2 × 10 –3 m. Calcula t e the resistivity of the met al oxide. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 646 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 647 (f) The man uf a c t u r e r of the resisto r in (e) gua r a n t e e s its resist a n c e to be within ±1 0 % of 1.5 Ω provide d the powe r dissip a tio n in the resis to r does not excee d 1.0 W. Calcula t e th e maxim u m curr e n t in the resis to r for the power dissipa tion to be equal to 1.0 W. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (g) Thre e of the resisto r s in (f) are conn e c t e d in the circuit below. The cell has an emf of 2.0 V and negligible inte r n a l resist a n c e . (i) Define emf . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 648 (ii) Dete r mi n e the minim u m and the maxim u m powe r that could be dissipa t e d in this circuit. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (Tot al 14 mark s ) 43 5 . This ques tion is abou t radioa ctive dec ay. (a) The alpha particle s prod u c e d in alpha dec ay have discr e t e ene r gi e s . Sugg e s t how this obs erv a ti o n provide s evide n c e for the existe n c e of nuclea r ener gy levels. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) A nucleu s of the isotop e fluorin e- 18 decays into a nucle u s of oxyge n18 by the emission of a positro n and neut ri n o. Outline how the natu r e of the β-decay ener gy spect r u m o f fluorine- 18 sugg e s t s the exist e n c e of the neut ri n o involved in the decay. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 649 ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 650 (c) A freshly prep a r e d sam pl e of fluorine- 18 has an activity of 1.12 MBq. Its activity four hour s late r is 0.246 MBq. (i) Show that the decay const a n t for fluorin e- 18 is 0.379 hr –1 . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (ii) Calculat e the half- life of fluorine- 18. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (d) The ene r gy of a beta par ticle in the dec ay of the sa m pl e in (c) is 8.4 × 10 –15 J. Show that the de Broglie wavele n g t h of this particle is 5.3 × 10 –12 m. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tot al 11 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 651 43 6 . This ques tion is abou t oscillation s and waves. (a) A rect a n g u l a r piece of wood of lengt h l floats in wate r with its axis vertical as show n in diagr a m 1. The lengt h of wood below the surfa c e is d . The wood is pus h e d vertically down w a r d s a dista n c e A such that a lengt h of wood is still above the wate r surfac e as show n in diag r a m 2. The wood is the n relea s e d and oscillat e s vertic ally. At the insta n t show n in diag r a m 3, the wood is moving down w a r d s and the lengt h of wood bene a t h the surfac e is d + x . (i) On diag r a m 3, draw an arrow to show the direc tion of the accele r a ti o n of the wood. (1) (ii) The accel e r a t io n a of the wood (in m s –2 ) is relat e d to x (in m) by the following equ atio n. a = 14 x l Explain why this equ a tio n show s that the wood is exec u ti n g simpl e har m o ni c motion. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 652 ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (iii) The period of oscillation of the wood is 1.4 s. Show tha t the lengt h l of the wood is 0.70 m. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (b) The wood in (a), as show n in diagr a m 2, is rele a s e d at time t = 0. On the axes below, sketc h a gra p h to show how the velocity v of the wood varies with time over one period of oscillation. (1) (c) The dist an c e A that the wood is initially pus h e d down is 0.12 m. (i) Calculat e the magni t u d e of the maxim u m accele r a ti o n of the wood. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 653 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) On your sketc h grap h in (b) label with the lette r P one point whe r e the magni t u d e of the accele r a t i o n is a maxim u m . (1) (d) The oscillations of the wood gen e r a t e waves in the wat e r of wavelen g t h 0.45 m. The grap h shows how the displa c e m e n t D, of the wate r surfa c e at a particul a r dista n c e from the wood varies with time t . Using the grap h, calcula t e the (i) spee d of the waves. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 654 (ii) ratio of the displac e m e n t at t = 1.75 s to the displa c e m e n t at t = 0.35 s. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 655 (iii) ratio of the ener gy of the wave at t = 1.75 s to the ene r gy at t = 0.35 s ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (Tot al 15 mark s ) 43 7 . This ques tion is abou t gase s and the r m o d y n a m i c proc e s s e s . (a) Stat e on e way in which a real gas differs from an ideal gas. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 656 (b) The diagr a m shows how the pre s s u r e p varies with volum e V of an ideal gas that und e r g o e s a cyclic cha n g e of stat e. AB and CD are adiab a t ic cha n g e s of stat e. The pres s u r e at point B is 1.8 × 10 5 Pa and the chan g e in volum e of the gas betw e e n B and C is 4.8 ×1 0 –4 m 3 . IB Questionbank Physics 657 (i) Stat e what is mean t by an adia b a ti c cha n g e of stat e. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 658 (ii) The chan g e in volum e of the gas betw e e n B and C take s 0.020 s. Dete r mi n e the powe r develop e d durin g this cha n g e of stat e. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 659 (iii) Stat e durin g which par t of the cycle the r m a l ene r gy is tran sf e r r e d from the gas to the sur ro u n di n g s . ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 660 (c) The ene r gy tran sf e r r e d is degr a d e d . Explain wha t is me a n t by deg r a d e d ener gy. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 661 (d) Discus s how your answ e r to (c) relat e s to the secon d law of ther m o d y n a m i c s . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tot al 10 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 662 43 8 . This ques tion is abou t fossil fuels and the gre e n h o u s e effect. (a) Stat e two reas o n s why most of the world’s ene r gy cons u m p t i o n is provide d by fossil fuels. 1. ............................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... 2. ............................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 663 (b) A powe r station has an outpu t powe r of 500 MW and an over all efficiency of 27 %. It uses nat u r al gas as a fuel tha t has an ene r gy density of 56 MJ kg –1 . (i) Define ener g y densit y . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 664 (ii) Dete r mi n e the rat e of cons u m p t i o n of nat u r a l gas in the powe r station. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) IB Questionbank Physics 665 (c) Outline why the enha n c e d gre e n h o u s e effect may res ult in an incr e a s e in the tem p e r a t u r e of the Ear t h’s surfa c e . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 666 (d) (i) The solar inte nsity at the position of the Eart h is 1380 –2 W m . The aver a g e albe do of Eart h is 0.300. Sta t e why an aver a g e value of albe d o is quot e d. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 667 (ii) Show that the aver a g e reflec t e d inte n sity from the Eart h is about 100 W m –2 . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (4) IB Questionbank Physics 668 (e) One of the expect e d res ult s of global war mi n g is an incre a s e d sea level. The incre a s e in volum e ΔV for a tem p e r a t u r e incr e a s e ΔT is given by ΔV = γV ΔT. Show, using the following dat a, that the res ultin g rise in sea level is about 0.5 m. Temp e r a t u r e incr e a s e = 2.0 °C Surfa c e are a of ocea n s on Eart h 8 3.6 × 10 km = 2 Avera g e ocea n dept h = 3.0 km γ = 8.8 × 10 –5 K–1 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tot al 16 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 669 43 9 . This ques tion is abou t elect ri c pote n ti al. (a) Define electric pote n tial at a point in an elect ric field. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 670 (b) The elect ric field inside a cha r g e d condu c ti n g sphe r e is zero. Stat e and explain why the value of the pote n ti al inside the sphe r e is const a n t . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 671 (c) In 1914 Niels Bohr propos e d a simple model of the hydrog e n atom in which the elect r o n is assu m e d to be in an orbit of radius r about the proto n. Both the elect r o n and the proton are reg a r d e d to be point char g e s . (i) It can be shown that the kinetic ene r gy E K of the elect r o n is given by the equ a tio n k e2 E K = 2r wher e k is the Coulom b const a n t and e is the elect r o n cha r g e . Deduc e an equa tio n for the total ene r gy E of the elect r o n . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 672 (ii) In the Bohr model, the mag nit u d e of the minim u m ene r gy of the elect r o n is 2.2 × 10 –18 J. Estim a t e the radius of the orbit, in which the elect r o n has minim u m ene r gy. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tota l 9 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 673 44 0 . This ques tion is abou t mom e n t u m , ene r gy and powe r. (a) In his Principia Math e m a t i c a Newt o n expr e s s e d his third law of motion as “to every action the r e is always oppos e d an equ al rea c tion”. Stat e what New to n mean t by this law. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 674 (b) A book is relea s e d from rest and falls towa r d s the surfa c e of Eart h. Discus s how the cons e rv a t io n of mom e n t u m applies to the Eart h- book syste m . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 675 (c) A larg e swingin g ball is use d to drive a horizon t al iron spike into a vertical wall. The cent r e of the ball falls throu g h a vertic al height of 1.6 m befor e striking the spike in the position show n. IB Questionbank Physics 676 The mas s of the ball is 3.5 kg and the mas s of the spike is 0.80 kg. Imm e di a t ely after striking the spike, the ball and spike move toge t h e r . Show that the (i) spee d of the ball on striking the spike is 5.6 m s –1 . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 677 (ii) ene r gy dissip at e d as a res ult of the collision is abou t 10 J. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (4) IB Questionbank Physics 678 (d) As a result of the ball striking the spike, the spike is drive n a dista n c e 7.3 × 10 –2 m into the wall. Calcula t e , ass u m i n g it to be const a n t , the friction force F betw e e n the spike and wall. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 679 (e) The machin e that is used to rais e the ball has a useful powe r outp u t of 18 W. Calculat e how long it take s for the mac hi n e to raise the ball throu g h a height of 1.6 m. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tot al 15 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 680 44 1 . This ques tion is abou t CCDs and digital dat a stor a g e . (a) An object is to be photo g r a p h e d using a digital cam e r a . (i) Stat e the nam e of the phe no m e n o n in which light caus e s elect r o n s to be emitt e d from a pixel of a CCD. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 681 (ii) Outline how the image of the object on the CCD is form e d. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 682 (b) Photo n s are inciden t on one of the pixels of the CCD at a rat e of 3.6 × 10 6 s –1 . The pixel has capa cit a n c e 34 pF and qua n t u m efficiency of 80 %. Dete r m i n e the poten ti al differ e n c e acros s the pixel after an expos u r e time of 15 ms. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (4) IB Questionbank Physics 683 (c) Outline, with refer e n c e to the ret riev al of stor e d data, why it is bett e r to stor e dat a in digital form rath e r tha n analog u e form. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tot al 10 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 684 44 2 . This ques tion is abou t the relative popul a tion density of sta r s and galaxie s. The num b e r of star s arou n d the Sun, within a dista n c e of 17 ly, is 75. The num b e r of galaxies in the local group, within a dist a n c e of 4.0 × 10 6 ly from the Sun, is 26. (a) Calcula t e the aver a g e popula tion density, per ly 3 , of star s and galaxies. Star s: ....................................................................................................... .................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... Galaxies: .................................................................................................. .................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 685 (b) Use your answ e r to (a) to dete r m i n e the ratio a ve r a gpeo p u la t ion d e n s it oy f s t a r s a ve r a gpeo p u la t ion d e n s it oy f g a la xie s ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (Tota l 3 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 686 44 3 . This ques tion is abou t the luminosity, size and dista n c e of star s. The Her tzs p r u n g–R u s s ell (HR) diag r a m shows the varia tion with spec t r a l class of the absolut e mag ni t u d e of sta r s . IB Questionbank Physics 687 The star Capella and the Sun are in the sa m e spec t r a l class (G). Using the HR diag r a m , (a) (i) the Sun. sugg e s t why Capella has a gre a t e r surfa c e are a than ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 688 (ii) estim a t e the luminosity of Capella in ter m s of that of the Sun. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 689 (iii) calcula t e the radius of Capella in ter m s of that of the Sun. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 690 (b) The spect r o s c o pi c par allax meth o d can be use d to me a s u r e the dista n c e of star Vega. (i) Using the HR diagr a m , sta t e the absolut e mag nit u d e of Vega. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 691 (ii) The app a r e n t mag nit u d e of Vega is 0.0. Dete r mi n e (in pars e c ) the dist a n c e of Vega from Eart h. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) IB Questionbank Physics 692 (iii) Light from Vega is abso r b e d by a dust cloud betw e e n Vega and Eart h. Sugg e s t the effect, if any, this will have on dete r m i ni n g the dista n c e of Vega from Eart h. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tot al 11 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 693 44 4 . This ques tion is abou t cosmic microw a v e backg r o u n d radia tio n (CMB) and the density of the univer s e. The gra p h shows the relative inte nsity of the CMB as a function of wavele n g t h . IB Questionbank Physics 694 (a) Explain how this grap h is consist e n t with the Big Bang model of the univer s e . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 695 (b) The density of the univer s e will det e r m i n e its ultim a t e fate. Outline the proble m s associa t e d with dete r m i ni n g the density of the unive r s e . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 696 (c) Outline how the expan sio n of the univer s e ultim a t e ly mad e it possible for stabl e nuclei and atom s to exist. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (Tota l 6 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 697 44 5 . This ques tion is abou t the mass–lumi no si ty rela tion and also the evolution of star s . The mas s–lu mi n o sity relation for main sequ e n c e sta r s is assu m e d to be L M 3.5 , wher e L is the luminosity and M is the mas s. Star X is 8 × 10 4 time s mor e lumino u s than the Sun and 25 time s mor e mas sive tha n the Sun. (a) Deduc e that star X is a main sequ e n c e sta r. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 698 (b) Outline with refer e n c e to the Oppe n h e i m e r–Volkoff limit, the evolution a r y steps and the fate of sta r X afte r it leave s the main sequ e n c e . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tota l 5 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 699 44 6 . This ques tion is abou t Hubbl e’s law and the expa n sio n of the unive r s e . (a) The spect r u m of the clust e r of galaxies Pega s u s I shows a shift of 5.04 nm in the wavele n g t h of the K-line. The wavel e n g t h of this line from a labor a t o r y sour ce is mea s u r e d as 396.8 nm. Calcul a t e the velocity of rece s s io n of the clust e r . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 700 (b) The grap h shows the reces sio n velocitie s of a num b e r of clust e r s of galaxies as a function of their app roxi m a t e dista n c e s . IB Questionbank Physics 701 (i) Stat e on e met ho d by which the dista n c e s show n on the gra p h could have bee n dete r m i n e d . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 702 (ii) Use the grap h to show that the age of the unive r s e is about 10 17 s. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tota l 5 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 703 44 7 . This ques tion is abou t modula tio n. (a) The diagr a m shows how the volta g e signal of a frequ e n c y modul a t e d (FM) car ri e r wave varies with time. The carri e r wave is modul a t e d by a single frequ e n c y signal. On the above axes sketc h the infor m a ti o n signal. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 704 (b) Stat e and explain on e adva n t a g e of using FM modul a tio n rath e r tha n amplit u d e modul a tio n (AM). ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 3 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 705 44 8 . This ques tion is abou t sam pling. A telep h o n e call is sam pl e d with a sam pling frequ e n c y of 8.0 kHz. Eac h sam pl e is stor e d as a four bit bina ry num b e r . The dur a tio n of eac h bit in the sam pl e is 4.0 µ s. (a) Calcula t e the time interv al betw e e n the end of one sam pl e and the beginni n g of the next. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 706 (b) Outline, with refer e n c e to your ans w e r in (a), what is me a n t by timedivision multiplexing. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 5 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 707 44 9 . This ques tion is abou t the mobile phone syste m . In the mobile phon e syste m , a partic ul a r geog r a p h i c are a is divide d into a num b e r of cells with a base station in eac h cell, eac h conn e c t e d to a cellula r exch a n g e . Describ e the function of the bas e sta tion s and the cellula r excha n g e . Base stations : ................................................................................................... ...................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... Cellula r exch a n g e : ................................................................................................ ................. ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... (Tota l 4 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 708 45 0 . This ques tion is abou t the tran s m i s s io n of signals along an optic fibre. (a) A ray of light ente r s an optic fibre from air. The ray make s an angle θ with the nor m al. The ray und e r g o e s total inte r n a l reflectio n at point P. The refra ctive index of the core is 1.56 and that of the claddin g is 1.38. (i) Calculat e the critical angle of the claddi n g- cor e bound a r y. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) Show that the large s t angle of incide n c e θ in air, at which total inter n al reflection at the claddi n g- core boun d a r y take s plac e, is 46.7°. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 709 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 710 (b) Disting ui s h betw e e n modal dispe r sio n and mat e ri a l dispe r si o n in an optic fibre. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (c) The signal show n is fed into a mono m o d e optic fibre. (i) Stat e what the shad e d are a repr e s e n t s . ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Use the axes above to dra w the sha p e of the signal afte r it has travelled a large dist a n c e in the fibre. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 711 (iii) The input signal powe r in a mono m o d e fibre is 15.0 mW. The att e n u a t i o n per unit lengt h for this fibre is 1.24 dB km –1 . Dete r mi n e the powe r of the outp u t signal afte r the signal has travelled a dista n c e of 3.40 km in the fibre. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (Tot al 12 mark s ) 45 1 . This ques tion is abou t the oper a tio n al amplifie r. (a) On the axes below draw a sketc h gra p h to show the variatio n with input voltag e V in of the outpu t volta g e V out of a non- inverti n g oper a ti o n al amplifier. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 712 (b) A tem p e r a t u r e war nin g devic e make s use of a buzze r tha t sound s whe n the poten ti al differe n c e acros s it is 24 V. The circ uit in the war ni n g device is show n. It is requi r e d that the buzze r should sound whe n the tem p e r a t u r e of the ther m i s t o r rises above 50 °C. (i) Stat e the voltag e at point Q. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) At a tem p e r a t u r e of 50 °C the resist a n c e of the the r m i s t o r is R . Explain why the buzze r will sound whe n the tem p e r a t u r e rise s above 50 °C. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (Tota l 6 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 713 45 2 . This ques tion is abou t laser light. (a) Outline how laser light is prod u c e d . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (b) Stat e two ways in which light emitt e d by a lase r differ s from light emitt e d from an ordin a r y filam e n t lamp. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 5 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 714 45 3 . This ques tion is abou t a compo u n d microsc o p e . The diagr a m (not to scale) is of a compo u n d micros c o p e . The focal lengt h of the objective lens is 20 mm and that of the eyepiec e lens is 60 mm. A small object is plac e d at a dist a n c e of 24 mm from the objective lens. The micros c o p e prod u c e s a final virtu al imag e of the object at a dista n c e of 240 mm from the eyepi ec e lens. (a) (i) Dete r mi n e , by calcula tion, the dista n c e from the objective lens of the imag e form e d by the objective lens. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) Explain why the imag e in (a)(i)is real. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (iii) Dete r mi n e the dista n c e of the image form e d by the objective lens from the eyepiec e lens. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 715 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (b) Deter m i n e the over all mag nifica tion of the micros c o p e . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 7 mark s ) 45 4 . This ques tion is abou t interf e r e n c e . (a) Light from a laser is incide n t on two very nar r o w slits A and B. (diagr a m not to scale) Point C on the scre e n is direc tly opposit e the midpoint of the slits. IB Questionbank Physics 716 (i) On the axes below, sketc h the varia tion with angle θ of the inten si ty of the light on the scre e n. (2) (ii) The sepa r a t i o n of the slits is 0.120 mm and the wavele n g t h of the light is 6.80 × 10 –7 m. The dist a n c e bet w e e n the slits and the scre e n is 1.40 m. Calculat e the sepa r a t i o n of the bright fringe s on the scre e n . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (b) Slit A is cover e d with a tra n s p a r e n t piec e of glass. The effect of the glas s is to incr e a s e the path lengt h of the light from the slit to the scre e n by half a wavelen g t h . It may be assu m e d tha t the amou n t of light absor b e d by the glass is negligible. Stat e and explain the effect(s), if any, of the glass on the (i) inten si ty patt e r n you have dra w n in (a)(i). ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 717 (ii) sepa r a t i o n of the brigh t fringe s calcul a t e d in (a)(ii). ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tota l 8 mark s ) 45 5 . This ques tion is abou t X-rays. In an X-ray tube elect r o n s are accele r a t e d from rest throu g h a pote n ti al differ e n c e and strike a met al tar g e t . (a) On the axes below draw and annot a t e a typical X-ray spec t r u m . (2) (b) Identify the mech a ni s m by which the differ e n t regions of the X-ray spect r u m are produ c e d . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 718 (3) IB Questionbank Physics 719 (c) In a particul a r X-ray tube the elect r o n s are accel e r a t e d from res t throu g h a poten ti al differ e n c e of 24 kV. The minim u m wavele n g t h of the X-rays produ c e d is 4.8 × 10 –11 m. Deter m i n e a value for the Planck cons t a n t . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (d) X-rays of wavele n g t h 2.25 × 10 –10 m are direc t e d towa r d s the surfa c e of a cryst al. A stron g first orde r reflect e d X-ray bea m is obse rv e d whe n the X-rays make an angle of 28.1° with the cryst al surfa c e . Deter m i n e the sepa r a t i o n of the atomic plan e s in the cryst al. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tot al 10 mark s ) 45 6 . This ques tion is abou t fram e s of refe r e n c e and the spe e d of light. (a) Descri b e what is mean t by an inerti al fram e of refe r e n c e . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 720 ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 721 (b) The diagr a m shows two iner ti al fram e s of refe r e n c e . Fra m e S ′ moves with velocity v = 2.0 × 10 8 m s –1 relative to fra m e S along the x -x ′directio n. When the origins of the two fram e s coincid e d, the clocks in both fram e s wer e set to show zero. An event takes place at x = 5.0 × 10 3 m whe n the clocks in fram e S show t = 3.0 × 10 –5 s. (i) By using Galilean tra nsfor m a t i o n equa tio n s , dete r m i n e the position and time of this event in the S ′ fram e of refe r e n c e . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) A laser, at res t in the fram e S ′, emits a ray of light along the neg a tive x ′-direction ( i.e. towa r d s the left). The spe e d of the ray of light is meas u r e d to be c in the fram e S ′. Show, using the relativistic velocity addition form ul a, tha t the spe e d of the ray of light in the fram e S is also me a s u r e d to be c . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... IB Questionbank Physics 722 .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 723 (c) Outline an experi m e n t (othe r tha n the Michelso n–Mo rl ey expe ri m e n t ) which provides eviden c e that the spe e d of light is inde p e n d e n t of the spee d of its sourc e. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 8 mark s ) 45 7 . This ques tion is abou t relativistic kine m a t i c s . (a) Stat e what is mea n t by prope r lengt h and prop e r time inte rv al. Prope r lengt h: ............................................................................................. ................. ................................................................................................................. ..................... Prope r time interv al: ........................................................................................... ......... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) A space s hi p moves with spe e d v = 0.600 c relative to a spa c e sta tion. Two laser s , A and B, on the spac e station are 5.00 m apa r t as mea s u r e d by the space station obse rv e r s . The ga m m a factor for a spee d of v = 0.600 c is γ =1. 2 5. IB Questionbank Physics 724 IB Questionbank Physics 725 (i) A radio signal is sent to the spac e s hi p from the spac e sta tion. The tran s mi s s io n lasts for 6.00 s accor di n g to spa c e station clocks. Calculat e the dur atio n of the tra n s m i s sio n accor di n g to the spac e s hi p obse rv e r s . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) Calculat e the dista n c e betw e e n the laser s A and B accor di n g to the space s hi p obse rv e r s . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (c) The laser s in (b) are fired si m u l t a n e o u s l y accor di n g to the spa c e stat i o n obse rv e r s . Light from each laser make s a ma rk on the spac e s hi p. The spac e s hi p obse rv e r s mea s u r e the dista n c e betw e e n the two ma rk s to be 6.25 m. Accordi n g to the space s hi p obse rv e r s (i) stat e which laser was fired first. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) det e r m i n e the differ e n c e in time betw e e n the firings of the two laser s. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 726 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tota l 9 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 727 45 8 . This ques tion is abou t relativistic mec h a ni c s . The upsilon (Y0 ) is an uns t a bl e particle that dec ays into a tau (τ –) and an antit a u (τ + ) accor di n g to the reac tio n Y0 → τ – + τ + The Y0 is at rest relative to the labor a t o r y whe n it dec a ys. The mom e n t u m of the τ – relative to the labor a t o r y is 4.40 GeV c –1 . The rest mas s of the τ – and of the τ + is 1.78 GeV c –2 . Dete r mi n e the rest mass of the Y0 . ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... ......................................................................................................................... ....................... (Tota l 3 mark s ) 45 9 . This ques tion is abou t gene r a l relativity. (a) Stat e Einst ei n’s principle of equivale n c e . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 728 (b) A rocket is accel er a t i n g in the direc tio n show n far from any mass e s . A monoch r o m a t i c bea m of light is emitt e d from the floor F of the rocke t. The bea m is receive d at the ceiling C of the rocke t. Sugg e s t why the freq u e n cy of the light bea m me a s u r e d at C is less tha n the frequ e n c y mea s u r e d at F. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 729 (c) The diagr a m shows thre e identic al rocke t s A, B and C. Rocket A is accel e r a t i n g in oute r spa c e with accele r a t io n a. Rocket B is at rest on the surf ac e of a plane t. The gravit a tio n al field str en g t h at the surfac e of the plane t is a . Rocket C is falling freely above a plane t. The gravit a tion a l field str en g t h of the plane t in the region of the rocke t is a. Light is emitt e d from a sour c e X on the left wall of eac h rocke t. The receive r Y is directly opposit e X. The initial directio n of the light is par allel to the floor of the rocke t. Draw, for each rocket, the pat h of the light ray emitt e d from X accor di n g to an obse rv e r in eac h rocke t. (3) IB Questionbank Physics 730 (d) Einst ei n’s theo ry of gen e r a l rela tivity pre dic t s that a mas sive body caus e s a curvat u r e (bendin g) of spa c e. (i) Describ e what is mea n t by the curva t u r e of spa c e. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Describ e how Edding t o n’s expe ri m e n t provide s evide n c e for the curvat u r e of space caus e d by the Sun. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (Tot al 10 mark s ) 46 0 . This ques tion is abou t the ear and hea ri n g. (a) Stat e the physical prop e r t y of a sound wave tha t is relat e d to the intensity of the sound. ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 731 ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 732 (b) The grap h shows the variatio n with freq u e n c y of the thr e s h ol d of heari n g for a pers o n with nor m al hea ri n g. Calcula t e the inten sity of sound of freq u e n c y 600 Hz that can just be hear d by this pers o n. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (c) As a result of long- ter m expos u r e to noise a pers o n suffer s from a heari n g loss of 20 dB. (i) On the axes in (b) dra w a sketc h gra p h to show the variation with frequ e n c y of the thr e s h ol d of hea ri n g for this pers o n. (1) (ii) Explain why this loss is likely to lead to difficulties with spee c h recog ni tion. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... IB Questionbank Physics 733 .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tota l 7 mark s ) 46 1 . This ques tion is abou t ultr as o u n d . (a) Define acous tic impe d a n c e . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (b) Ultra s o u n d of intensi ty I 0 is travelling in a mediu m of impe d a n c e Z 1 and is incide n t on a mediu m of impe d a n c e Z 2 . The reflect e d ultra s o u n d has intensity I R given by the following equ a tio n. I R Z1 Z 2 I 0 Z 1 Z 2 2 Explain why when using ultr a s o u n d a gel is plac e d betw e e n the tran s d u c e r and the skin of the patie n t . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (4) (Tota l 5 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 734 46 2 . This ques tion is abou t X-rays. (a) Define half- value thickn e s s . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 735 (b) The half- value thickn e s s in met r e s of air at pres s u r e p and tem p e r a t u r e T is given by the equ a tio n T x 1 1.8 1 05 p 2 X-rays from the Sun reach the oute r layers of the atmo s p h e r e of Eart h. The following data are availa ble. Avera g e pres s u r e of the atmos p h e r e Avera g e tem p e r a t u r e of the atmos p h e r e Effective heigh t of the atmos p h e r e = 2.0 × 10 4 Pa = 240 K = 25 km Using the dat a, calcul at e the (i) half- value thickn e s s for the atmo s p h e r e . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) fraction of the incide n t X-ray inte n si ty that is tra n s m i t t e d to the surfac e of the Eart h. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (c) Comm e n t , using your ans w e r to (b)(ii), on whet h e r the atmo s p h e r e IB Questionbank Physics 736 provides any significan t prot e c t io n from incomi n g X-rays. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (d) X-ray photon s of aver a g e ene r gy 20 keV are incide n t at a height of 10 km above the Eart h’s surfa c e at a rate of 2.8 × 10 8 m –2 s –1 . A pas s e n g e r is in a plan e flying at a height of 10 km above the surfa c e of the Ear t h. The pass e n g e r has a mas s of 60 kg and body surfa c e are a 1.6 m 2 . The quality factor for X-rays is 1. (i) Calculat e the dose equivale n t rec eive d by this pass e n g e r durin g a thr e e hour flight at a height of 10 km. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (4) (ii) Stat e on e reas o n why the dose equivale n t rec eive d will be muc h less than your ans w e r in (d)(i). ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (Tot al 12 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 737 46 3 . This ques tion is abou t radioisot o p e s . (a) Stat e what is mea n t by the effective half- life of a radioisot o p e . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 738 (b) The function of the lungs may be monitor e d using the radioisoto p e s 133 81 5 4 X and 3 6 Kr . Infor m a t io n on thes e two radioisot o p e s is given in the table. Radi oi s o t o p e s Effe c t i v e halflife De c a y prod u c t s 133 54X 5.2 days β– and γ 81 3 6 Kr 12 secon d s γ Stat e and explain on e adva n t a g e and on e disa dva n t a g e of using 81 rat h e r than 3 6 Kr . 133 54X Advant a g e : .............................................................................................. .................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... Disadv a n t a g e : .......................................................................................... ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (4) (Tota l 6 mark s ) 46 4 . This ques tion is abou t qua r k s. The table below gives the elect ric cha r g e of the thr e e light e s t qua r k s in ter m s of e , the char g e of the proton. Quark flavo u r IB Questionbank Physics up u down d str a n g e s 739 Elec t r i c ch ar g e / e IB Questionbank Physics 2 3 1 3 1 3 740 (a) Using the dat a in the table, dete r m i n e the (i) quar k conte n t of a meson with cha r g e +1 and str a n g e n e s s 0 and that of a baryon with cha r g e –1 and str a n g e n e s s –3. Meso n: ............................................................................................ .................. Baryon: ............................................................................................ ................. (2) (ii) possible spin values of the meson in (a)(i). ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (b) Stat e the Pauli exclusion principle. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (c) 3 Explain how the baryon with qua r k cont e n t uuu and spin 2 does not violate the Pauli exclusion principle. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (d) In the Feyn m a n diagr a m show n a blue down qua r k emits a gluon and prod u c e s a red qua r k. IB Questionbank Physics 741 Deduc e the (i) quar k flavour (type) of the prod u c e d qua r k. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) colour quan t u m num b e r s of the emitt e d gluon. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (e) The positive kaon K + (qua r k cont e n t u s ) dec ays into an anti- muon and a neut ri no accor di n g to the rea c tion below. K+ → µ + + ν Explain how it may be dedu c e d that this dec ay is a weak inter a c ti o n proce s s . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (f) The diagr a m shows thre e of the inter a c ti o n vertic e s for the wea k inter a c ti o n. IB Questionbank Physics 742 Using the app r o p r i a t e vert ex, dra w a Feyn m a n diag r a m for the dec ay K + → µ + + ν labelling all particl e s involve d. (3) (Tot al 11 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 743 46 5 . This ques tion is abou t the bubbl e cha m b e r . The diagr a m is a copy of a bubbl e cha m b e r photog r a p h of the dec ay of a neut r al pion (π 0 ) into two photon s , π 0 → 2 γ. Each of the photon s prod u c e d mat e ri alizes into an elect r o n–po sit r o n pair. The path s show n belong to the two elect r o n–posi t r o n pairs. (a) Stat e why the track s of the photo n s do not show up in the photog r a p h . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (b) On the diag r a m above, (i) draw lines to indicat e the path of eac h of the photo n s . (1) (ii) label with the lette r P the point whe r e the pion dec ay e d . (1) IB Questionbank Physics 744 (c) Outline whet h e r the pion was moving or whe t h e r it was at rest whe n it decaye d. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (d) The path of one of the elect r o n s produ c e d is a spir al. Sugg e s t a rea so n for the shap e of this pat h. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (Tota l 6 mark s ) 46 6 . This ques tion is abou t Feyn m a n diag r a m s and neut r a l cur r e n t s . (a) The diagr a m shows the inter a c t io n vert ex of the elect r o m a g n e t i c inter a c ti o n. Had r o n s may be prod u c e d via the elec t r o m a g n e t i c inte r a c ti o n in elect r o n–posi t r o n collisions thro u g h the rea c tion e– + e+ → q + q whe r e q stan d s for a quar k and q for an antiqu a r k . IB Questionbank Physics 745 (i) Draw a Feyn m a n diagr a m for the proc e s s e – + e + → u + u whe r e u stan d s for the up qua r k. (1) (ii) Outline why the reac tion in (a)(i) event u a lly leads to the produ c t io n of had ro n s rat h e r tha n individu al qua r k s . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (b) The diagr a m shows two vertic e s for the weak inter a c t io n. The solid lines repr e s e n t qua r k s or lepto n s. (i) Stat e what is mean t by a neut r a l curr e n t . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 746 (ii) Draw a Feyn m a n diagr a m for the proc e s s e – + e + → u + u , whe r e u stan d s for an up qua r k, that is media t e d by a neut r al curr e n t . (1) (c) By refer e n c e to the weak inte r a c ti o n vertic e s in (b) sugg e s t how the Z 0 may be det ec t e d . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (d) The W – decays accor di n g to W – → e – + ν . Stat e and explain, whet h e r the antine u t r i n o in this dec ay is an elect r o n , muon or tau antine u t r i n o. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tot al 10 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 747 46 7 . Which of the following is equivale n t to the joule? A. N m2 B. N m –2 C. kg m s –2 D. kg m 2 s –2 (Tot al 1 mar k ) 46 8 . An object falls for a time of 0.25 s. The accele r a t io n of free fall is 9.81 m s – 2 . The displac e m e n t is calcul at e d . Which of the following gives the corr e c t num b e r of significa n t digits for the calcula t e d value of the displ ac e m e n t of the object? A. 1 B. 2 C. 3 D. 4 (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 748 46 9 . A raind r o p falling from rest at time t = 0 rea c h e s ter mi n a l velocity. Which grap h bes t repr e s e n t s how the spe e d v varies with time t ? (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 749 47 0 . The gra p h shows how the displa c e m e n t d of an objec t varies with time t . The tang e n t to the curve at time t 1 is also show n. Which of the following gives the spe e d of the objec t at point P? A. the gradi e n t at P B. the shad e d area C. 1 g r a d ie natt P D. d1 t1 (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 750 47 1 . A ball falls vertically and bounc e s off the groun d. Imme di a t e ly befor e impact with the groun d the spe e d of the ball is u . Imme di a t ely after leaving the grou n d the speed is v . Which of the following expr e s si o n s is the ratio of k in e t ice n e r g lo y s to n c o llis io n k in e t ice n e r g im y m e d ia tyebl e fo r ec o llis ion? A. v u B. v u C. v u D. v 1 u 1 2 2 (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 751 47 2 . A railway engin e of mas s m moves along a horizont al trac k with unifor m spee d v . The total resis tive force acting on the engin e is F. Which of the following is the powe r of the engine ? A. F mv B. Fv C. mv F D. v F (Tot al 1 mar k ) 47 3 . A ball is tied to a string and rota t e d at a unifor m spe e d in a vertic al plan e. The diagr a m shows the ball at its lowest position. Which arrow shows the direction of the net force acting on the ball? (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 752 47 4 . A gas atom strikes a wall with spe e d v at an angle θ to the nor m a l to the wall. The atom rebo u n d s at the sam e spe e d v and angle θ. Which of the following gives the mag ni t u d e of the mom e n t u m cha n g e of the gas atom? A. zero B. 2 mv sin θ C. 2 mv D. 2 mv cos θ (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 753 47 5 . A syste m consist s of an ice cube plac e d in a cup of wate r . The syste m is ther m ally insulat e d from its sur r o u n di n g s . The wate r is origin ally at 20 °C. Which gra p h best show s the variation of total inte r n a l ene r gy U of the syste m with time t ? (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 754 47 6 . Ther m al ener gy is adde d at a const a n t rate to a subst a n c e which is solid at time t = 0. The gra p h shows the variation with t of the tem p e r a t u r e T . Which of the stat e m e n t s are corr e c t ? I. The specific latent hea t of fusion is gre a t e r tha n the specific laten t heat of vaporiz a tio n. II. The specific heat capa city of the solid is less tha n the specific heat capacity of the liquid. A. I only B. I and II C. II only D. Neith e r I nor II (Tot al 1 mar k ) 47 7 . Which of the following is an assu m p t i o n mad e in the kinetic model of ideal gas es ? A. Molecul e s have zero mas s. B. Forc es betw e e n molec ul e s are attr a c tive. C. Collisions betw e e n molec ul e s are elastic. D. Molecul e s move at high spe e d. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 755 47 8 . An object at the end of a spring oscillat e s vertic ally with simple har m o ni c motion. The grap h shows the varia tion with time t of the displa c e m e n t x . The amplitu d e is x 0 and the period of oscillation is T . Which of the following is the corr e c t expr e s sio n for the displa c e m e n t x ? A. B. C. D. x0 c o s x0 c o s 2π t T x 0 s in x 0 s in 2π t T 2π t T 2π t T (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 756 47 9 . An object at the end of a spring oscillat e s vertic ally with simple har m o ni c motion. The grap h shows the varia tion with time t of the displa c e m e n t x . The amplitu d e is x 0 and the period of oscillation is T . Which of the following is the corr e c t expr e s sio n for the maxim u m accele r a ti o n of the object? A. 2π x0 T 2π B. T2 x0 4π 2 x0 C. T2 D. 4π 2 x0 T (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 757 48 0 . One end of a horizont al string is fixed to a wall. A tran s v e r s e pulse moves along the string as show n. Which of the following stat e m e n t s are corr e c t for the reflect e d pulse comp a r e d to the forwa r d puls e? I. It moves mor e slowly. II. It has less ene r gy. III. It is invert e d . A. I and II only B. I and III only C. II and III only D. I, II and III (Tot al 1 mar k ) 48 1 . Monoc h r o m a t i c light travels from air into wat e r . Which of the following descri b e s the chan g e s in wavele n g t h and spe e d ? Wavel e n g t h Spe e d A. incr e a s e s decr e a s e s B. incr e a s e s incr e a s e s C. decr e a s e s incr e a s e s D. decr e a s e s decr e a s e s (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 758 48 2 . Two resis to r s , mad e of the sam e mat e ri al, are conne c t e d in serie s to a batt e r y. The lengt h of resis to r X is twice that of resisto r Y, and X has twice the cross- section al area of Y. r e s is t a n cofe X Which of the following gives r e s is t a n cofe Y ? A. 1 4 B. 1 2 C. 1 D. 4 (Tot al 1 mar k ) 48 3 . The circuit shows a resis to r R conn e c t e d in serie s with a batt e r y and a resis to r of resis tanc e 10 Ω. The e mf of the batt e r y is 20 V and it has negligible inter n al resist a n c e . The cur r e n t in the circ uit is 1.0 A. Which of the following is the resist a n c e of R? A. 1.0 Ω B. 2.0 Ω C. 10 Ω D. 20 Ω (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 759 48 4 . Three identic al resist o r s are conn e c t e d to a batt e r y as show n. Which of the following is a corr e c t stat e m e n t ? A. The cur r e n t throu g h X is gre a t e r tha n that throu g h Z. B. The poten t i al differ e n c e acros s Z is gre a t e r tha n tha t acros s Y. C. The poten t i al differ e n c e acros s resist o r X and Y toge t h e r is the sa m e as that acros s Z. D. The cur r e n t throu g h Z is less tha n the total cur r e n t throu g h X and Y. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 48 5 . A cur r e n t is est a blis h e d in a coil of wire in the dire c tion show n. The direction of the mag n e t i c field at point P is A. out of the plane of the pap e r . B. into the plane of the pap e r . C. to the left. D. to the right. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 760 48 6 . Which arr a n g e m e n t of thr e e point cha r g e s at the corn e r of an equila t e r a l trian gl e will res ul t in a zero elect ric field stre n g t h at the cent r e of the trian gl e, point P? (Tot al 1 mar k ) 48 7 . The mas s of a plan e t is twice that of Eart h. Its radius is half tha t of the radi us of Eart h. The gravit a tio n a l field stre n g t h at the surfa c e of Eart h is g. The gravit a tion al field str e n g t h at the surfac e of the plane t is A. 1 g 2 . B. g. C. 2g. D. 8g. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 761 48 8 . An elect r o n ente r s the vacuu m betw e e n two opposit ely cha r g e d plat e s with velocity v . The elect r o n is followe d by an alpha particle moving with the sam e initial velocity as the elect r o n . A unifor m ma gn e t i c field is direc t e d out of the plan e of the pape r. The elect r o n’s pat h is undeflec t e d . The path of the alph a particle will be A. deflect e d out of the plan e of the pape r . B. und eflect e d . C. deflect e d upw a r d . D. deflect e d down w a r d . (Tot al 1 mar k ) 48 9 . The Geige r–M a r s d e n experi m e n t provide s evide n c e for A. the existe n c e of discr e t e atomic ene r gy levels. B. the existe n c e of the neut r o n . C. a dens e positively char g e d nucle u s . D. the stability of some nuclei. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 762 49 0 . A radioac tive isotop e has a half- life of two minut e s . A sam pl e cont ain s sixtee n gra m s of the isotop e. How muc h time elaps e s until one gra m of the isotop e rem ai n s ? A. 6 minut e s B. 8 minut e s C. 10 minut e s D. 12 minut e s (Tot al 1 mar k ) 49 1 . Data conce r ni n g nuclide s are plotte d using the axes below. What are the axis labels for this gra p h ? Y X A. bindin g ener gy per nucleon num b e r of nucleo n s B. bindin g ener gy num b e r of proto n s C. num b e r of proto n s bindin g ene r gy per nucle on D. num b e r of nucleo n s bindin g ene r gy (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 763 49 2 . Which of the following is true about beta minus ( β–) dec ay? A. An antin e u t r i n o is abso r b e d . B. The char g e of the daug h t e r nuclide is less tha n that of the par e n t nuclide. C. An antin e u t r i n o is emitt e d . D. The mas s num b e r of the daug h t e r nuclide is less tha n that of the par e n t nuclide. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 49 3 . A wave gene r a t o r produ c e s a powe r per unit lengt h of 4.0 kW m –1 for waves of amplit u d e A and spee d v . The efficiency of the gen e r a t o r is cons t a n t . The power per unit lengt h obtain e d from waves of amplit u d e 2 A and spee d 2 v would be A. 8.0 kW m –1 . B. 16 kW m –1 . C. 32 kW m –1 . D. 64 kW m –1 . (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 764 49 4 . The diagr a m shows the variation with wavele n g t h of the powe r per unit wavele n g t h I radi at e d from an are a of 1 m 2 of two differ e n t bodies. Which of the following is a corr e c t comp a r i s o n of the tem p e r a t u r e and of the emissivity of the two bodies? Te m p e r a t u re Emi s s i v i t y A. sam e sam e B. sam e differ e n t C. differ e n t sam e D. differ e n t differ e n t (Tot al 1 mar k ) 49 5 . Which of the following is the most likely expla n a ti o n for a rise in global sea level? A. Ther m al expan s io n of wate r B. Melting of sea ice C. Incr e a s e in rainfall D. Ther m al expan s io n of ice (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 765 49 6 . The diagr a m shows an ener gy balan c e clima t e model for a plane t. The intensiti es of the reflect e d and radia t e d radia tio n are given in ter m s of the incide n t intensity I. Which of the following is the albe d o of this plane t ? A. 0.15 B. 0.25 C. 0.40 D. 0.60 (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 766 49 7 . Data analysis ques tion. A stud e n t perfor m s an expe ri m e n t with a pap e r toy tha t rota t e s as it falls slowly throu g h the air. After rele a s e , the pape r toy quickly att ain s a cons t a n t vertic al spee d as meas u r e d over a fixed vertic al dista n c e . The aim of the expe ri m e n t was to find how the ter mi n al spe e d of the pape r toy varies with its weigh t. The weigh t of the pape r toy was chan g e d by using differ e n t num b e r s of pap e r she e t s in its const r u c t i o n. IB Questionbank Physics 767 The gra p h shows a plot of the ter mi n a l spe e d v of the pap e r toy (calcula t e d from the raw dat a) and the num b e r of pap e r she e t s n use d to const r u c t the toy. The unce r t ai n t y in v for n = 1 is show n by the erro r bar. (a) The fixed dist a n c e is 0.75 m and has an absolut e unce r t a i n t y of 0.01 m. The perc e n t a g e unce r t a i n t y in the time take n to fall throu g h the fixed dist an c e is 5 %. (i) Calculat e the absolut e unce r t a i n t y in the ter mi n al spe e d of the pap e r toy for n = 6. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) IB Questionbank Physics 768 (ii) On the grap h, draw an error bar on the point corr e s p o n di n g to n = 6. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 769 (b) On the gra p h, draw a line of best- fit for the data points. (1) (c) The stud e n t hypot h e s iz e s tha t v is propo r tio n a l to n . Use the data points for n = 2 and n = 4 from the gra p h opposit e to show tha t this hypot h e s i s is incor r e c t . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 770 (d) Anothe r stud e n t hypot h e s iz e d tha t v might be propo r tio n a l to n . To verify this hypot h e si s he plott e d a gra p h of v 2 agains t n as show n below. Explain how the gra p h verifies the hypot h e s i s tha t v is propo r tio n a l to n. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 771 (3) (Tot al 11 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 772 49 8 . In 1997 a high- spee d car of mas s 1.1 × 10 4 kg achieve d the world land spee d recor d. The car accel e r a t e d unifor mly in two sta g e s as show n in the table. The car star t e d from res t. Tim e / s Spe e d attai n e d at en d of sta g e / m s –1 Sta g e 1 0.0 – 4.0 44 Sta g e 2 4.0 – 12 280 Use the dat a to calculat e the (a) aver a g e accel e r a t io n of the car in sta g e 1. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (b) aver a g e net force req ui r e d to accel e r a t e the car in sta g e 2. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (c) total dist an c e travelled by the car in 12 s. ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 773 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 6 mark s ) 49 9 . (a) Draw the compl et e diagr a m of the circuit that uses a pote n ti al divider, am m e t e r , voltm e t e r and cell to mea s u r e the curr e n t- volta g e char a c t e r i s ti c s for compo n e n t X. (3) IB Questionbank Physics 774 (b) The grap h shows the curr e n t- volta g e cha r a c t e r i s ti c s for the compo n e n t X. Compo n e n t X is now conne c t e d acros s the ter mi n al s of a cell of emf 2.0 V and negligible inter n a l resist a n c e . Use the gra p h to show that the resist a n c e of X is 0.83 Ω. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (c) A resis to r of cons t a n t resis tanc e 1.0 Ω i s conn e c t e d in series with the cell in (b) and with X. Use the gra p h to ded uc e that the curr e n t in the circuit is 1.3 A. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 775 ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tota l 8 mark s ) 50 0 . This ques tion is abou t a simple pend ul u m . (a) A pend ul u m consist s of a bob susp e n d e d by a light inexte n si bl e string from a rigid suppo r t . The pend ul u m bob is move d to one side and the n relea s e d . The sketc h grap h show s how the displa c e m e n t of the pend ul u m bob und e r g oi n g simple har m o ni c motion varie s with time over one time period. On the sketc h grap h above, (i) label with the lette r A a point at which the accele r a t io n of the pend ul u m bob is a maxim u m . (1) (ii) label with the lette r V a point at which the spe e d of the pend ul u m bob is a maxim u m . (1) (b) Explain why the mag ni t u d e of the tension in the string at the midpoint of the oscillation is grea t e r tha n the weight of the pend ul u m bob. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 776 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 777 (c) The pend ul u m bob is moved to one side until its cent r e is 25 mm above its rest position and the n rele a s e d . (i) Show that the spee d of the pend ul u m bob at the midpoint of the oscillation is 0.70 m s –1 . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) The mas s of the pend ul u m bob is 0.057 kg. The cent r e of the pend ul u m bob is 0.80 m below the suppo r t . Calcula t e the mag ni t u d e of the tension in the string whe n the pend ul u m bob is vertically below the point of sus p e n s i o n. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 778 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) IB Questionbank Physics 779 (d) The point of susp e n s i o n of the pend ul u m bob is move d from side to side with a small amplitu d e and at a variabl e driving frequ e n c y f. For each value of the driving frequ e n c y a ste a dy cons t a n t amplitu d e A is reac h e d . The oscillations of the pend ul u m bob are lightly dam p e d . (i) On the axes below, sketc h a gra p h to show the variation of A with f. (2) (ii) Explain, with refer e n c e to the gra p h in (d)(i), wha t is me a n t by reson a n c e . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 780 ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (e) The pend ul u m bob is now imm e r s e d in wate r and the varia bl e frequ e n c y driving force in (d) is again applie d. Sugg e s t the effect this imme r s io n of the pend ul u m bob will have on the sha p e of your gra p h in (d)(i). ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tot al 16 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 781 50 1 . This ques tion is abou t the Ruthe r fo r d model of the atom. (a) Most alpha par ticles used to bomb a r d a thin gold foil pass thro u g h the foil witho u t a significa n t cha n g e in direc tion. A few alpha par ticle s are deviat e d from their original direc tion thro u g h angl es gre a t e r than 90°. Use thes e observ a tio n s to desc ri b e the Ruthe r fo r d atomic model. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 782 ..................... (5) IB Questionbank Physics 783 (b) The isotop e gold- 197 ( is not. (i) 197 7 9 Au ) is sta ble but the isotop e gold- 199 ( 199 7 9 Au ) Outline, in ter m s of the force s acting betw e e n nucleo n s , why, for large stabl e nuclei such as gold- 197, the num b e r of neut r o n s excee d s the num b e r of proton s . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (ii) 199 199 A nucle u s of 7 9 Au dec ays to a nucle u s of 8 0 H g with the emission of an elect r o n and anot h e r particle. Stat e the na m e of this othe r par ticl e. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (Tota l 9 mark s ) 50 2 . This ques tion is abou t a light ni n g disch a r g e . (a) Define electric field stren g t h . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 784 ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 785 (b) A thun d e r cl o u d can be modelle d as a neg a tively cha r g e d plat e that is par allel to the grou n d . The mag ni t u d e of the char g e on the plat e incre a s e s due to proc e s s e s in the atmo s p h e r e . Event u a lly a cur r e n t disc h a r g e s from the thun d e r cl o u d to the grou n d . On the diag r a m , draw the elect ric field patt e r n betw e e n the thun d e r cl o u d bas e and the grou n d . (3) IB Questionbank Physics 786 (c) The mag ni t u d e of the elec t ric field str e n g t h E betw e e n two infinite char g e d par allel plat es is given by the expr e s si o n σ E = ε0 whe r e σ is the char g e per unit are a on one of the plate s . A thun d e r cl o u d car rie s a cha r g e of ma g nit u d e 35 C spre a d over its bas e. The are a of the bas e is 1.2 × 10 7 m 2 . (i) Dete r mi n e the mag nit u d e of the elect ric field betw e e n the bas e of the thun d e r cl o u d and the grou n d . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (ii) Stat e two ass u m p t io n s mad e in (c)(i). 1. ..................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. 2. ..................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 787 (iii) When the thun d e r cl o u d disc h a r g e s , the aver a g e disch a r g e curr e n t is 1.8 kA. Estim a t e the disch a r g e time. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (iv) The poten ti al differ e n c e betw e e n the thun d e r c lo u d and the grou n d befor e disch a r g e is 2.5 × 10 8 V. Dete r m i n e the ene r gy relea s e d in the disch a r g e . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (4) (Tot al 17 mark s ) 50 3 . This ques tion is abou t fuel for hea tin g. (a) Define the ener gy densi ty of a fuel. IB Questionbank Physics 788 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 789 (b) A room heat e r bur n s liquid fuel and the following dat a are availabl e. Density of liquid fuel 8.0 × 10 2 kg m –3 Ener gy produ c e d by 1 m 3 of liquid fuel 2.7 × 10 10 J Rate at which fuel is cons u m e d 0.13 g s –1 Latent heat of vaporiz a tion of the fuel 290 kJ kg –1 (i) = = = = Use the dat a to calcula t e the powe r outp u t of the room hea t e r , ignorin g the power requi r e d to conve r t the liquid fuel into a gas. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (ii) Show why, in your calcula tio n in (b)(i), the powe r req ui r e d to conver t the liquid fuel into a gas at its boiling point can be ignor e d. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (c) Stat e, in ter m s of molecul a r str uc t u r e and their motion, two IB Questionbank Physics 790 differ e n c e s betw e e n a liquid and a gas. 1. ............................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... 2. ............................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 8 mark s ) 50 4 . This ques tion is abou t the produ c tio n of ene r gy in nucle a r fission. (a) A possible fission reac tio n is 235 92 U (i) 01n 93 26 Kr 15461Ba x 10 n . Stat e the value of x . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Show that the ener gy rele a s e d whe n one ura ni u m nucle u s unde r g o e s fission in the rea c tion in (a) is about 2.8 × 10 –11 J. Mass Mass Mass Mass of of of of neut r o n = 1.008 6 7 u U-235 nucle u s = 234.99 3 3 3 u Kr- 92 nucle u s = 91.90 6 4 5 u Ba- 141 nucle u s = 140.88 3 5 4 u ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 791 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (4) (iii) Stat e how the ene r gy of the neut r o n s produ c e d in the reac tion in (a) is likely to com p a r e with the ene r gy of the neut r o n that initiat e d the reac tion. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 792 (b) Outline the role of the mode r a t o r . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (c) A nuclea r powe r plant that use s U-235 as fuel has a useful powe r outpu t of 16 MW and an efficiency of 40 %. Assumi n g tha t eac h fission of U-235 gives rise to 2.8 × 10 –11 J of ene r gy, det e r m i n e the mas s of U-235 fuel used per day. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (4) (Tot al 12 mark s ) 50 5 . This ques tion is abou t collisions. (a) Stat e the principl e of cons e r v a ti o n of mom e n t u m . IB Questionbank Physics 793 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 794 (b) In an expe ri m e n t , an air- rifle pellet is fired into a block of modelling clay that res ts on a table. (not to scale) The air- rifle pellet rem ai n s inside the clay block afte r the impa c t. As a result of the collision, the clay block slides along the table in a str aig h t line and comes to res t. Furt h e r dat a relatin g to the expe ri m e n t are given below. Mass of air- rifle pellet = 2.0 g Mass of clay block = 56 g Velocity of impa c t of air- rifle pellet = 140 m s –1 Stoppi n g dista n c e of clay block = 2.8 m (i) Show that the initial spee d of the clay block afte r the air- rifle pellet strikes it is 4.8 m s –1 . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 795 (ii) Calculat e the aver a g e friction al force tha t the surfa c e of the table exert s on the clay block whilst the clay block is moving. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (4) (c) Discus s the ener gy tran sfor m a t i o n s tha t occur in the clay block and the air- rifle pellet from the mom e n t the air- rifle pellet strike s the block until the clay block come s to rest. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (d) The clay block is dropp e d from rest from the edg e of the table and falls vertically to the grou n d . The tabl e is 0.85 m above the groun d. Calcula t e the spee d with which the clay block strike s the grou n d. IB Questionbank Physics 796 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tot al 13 mark s ) 50 6 . This ques tion is abou t the eye. (a) Stat e, with refer e n c e to the definition s of nea r point and far point, what is mea n t by accom m o d a t i o n. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (b) Explain how accom m o d a t i o n is achieve d by the eye. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 797 (Tota l 5 mark s ) 50 7 . This ques tion is abou t diffrac tio n and resolution. (a) A par allel beam of monoc h r o m a t i c light is incide n t on a nar r o w rect a n g ul a r slit. After passin g throu g h the slit, the light is incide n t on a dista n t scre e n. Point X is the midpoint of the slit. (i) On the axes below, sketc h a gra p h to show how the inte n si ty of the light on the scre e n varies with the angle θ show n in the diagr a m . (3) (ii) The wavelen g t h of the light is 520 nm, the width of the slit is 0.04 mm and the scre e n is 1.2 m from the slit. Show tha t the width of the cent r al maxim u m of inte nsi ty on the scre e n is about 3 cm. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 798 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 799 (b) Points P and Q are on the circ u mf e r e n c e of a plan e t as show n. By consid e ri n g the two points, outline why diffrac tio n limits the ability of an astr o n o m i c al telesco p e to resolve the imag e of the plane t as a disc. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tota l 8 mark s ) 50 8 . This ques tion is abou t stan di n g wave s and orga n pipes. (a) Stat e on e way in which a sta n di n g wave differs from a travelling wave. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 800 (b) An organ pipe of lengt h L is close d at one end. On the diag r a m s , dra w a repr e s e n t a t i o n of the displa c e m e n t of the air in the pipe whe n the frequ e n c y of the note emitt e d by the pipe is the (i) fund a m e n t a l (first har m o ni c) freq u e n c y f 1 . (1) (ii) secon d har m o ni c frequ e n c y f 2 . (1) (c) Use your answ e r to (b) to dedu c e an expr e s sio n for the ratio f1 f2 . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 801 (d) Stat e, in ter m s of the boun d a r y conditions of the sta n di n g wave s that can be form e d in the pipe, the reas o n why the ratio of the highe r frequ e n ci e s of the har m o ni c s to tha t of the funda m e n t a l mus t always be an integ e r num b e r . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (Tota l 7 mark s ) 50 9 . This ques tion is abou t wave–pa r ti cl e duality. (a) In the photo el ec t r i c effect, elect r o n s are not emitt e d from the surf ac e of a met al if the frequ e n c y of the incide n t light is below a cert ai n value called the thr es h ol d frequ e n c y. (i) Explain, with refer e n c e to the Einst ei n model of the photo el e c t ri c effect, the exist en c e of the thre s h ol d frequ e n c y. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (4) IB Questionbank Physics 802 (ii) Stat e, with refer e n c e to your answ e r in (a)(i), the rea s o n why the thre s h ol d frequ e n c y is differ e n t for differ e n t met als. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 803 (b) Light of frequ e n cy 1.0 × 10 15 Hz is incide n t on the surfa c e of a met al. The work function of the met al is 3.2 × 10 –19 J. (i) Show that the maxim u m kine tic ene r gy of the emitt e d elect r o n s is 3.4 × 10 –19 J. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) Dete r mi n e the de Broglie wavele n g t h of the elect r o n s in (b)(i). ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (Tot al 10 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 804 51 0 . This ques tion is abou t the spec t r u m of atomic hydrog e n . (a) The diagr a m repr e s e n t s the princi p al lines in the visible spec t r u m of atomic hydro g e n . Outline how the spect r u m can be produ c e d and obse r v e d in the labor a t o r y. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 805 (b) Calcula t e the differe n c e in ene r gy in eV betw e e n the ene r gy levels in the hydro g e n atom that give rise to the red line in the spec t r u m . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 5 mark s ) 51 1 . This ques tion is abou t radioa ctive dec ay. (a) A nucleu s of a radioac tive isotop e of gold (Au- 189) emits a neut ri n o in the decay to a nucle u s of an isotop e of platin u m (Pt). In the nucle a r reaction equa tio n below, stat e the na m e of the par ticle X and identify the nucleon num b e r A and proto n num b e r Z of the nucleu s of the isotop e of platin u m . 189 A 7 9 Au Z P t X v X : ............................................................................................................. ................... A : ............................................................................................................. ................... Z : ............................................................................................................. ................... (2) (b) The half- life of Au-189 is 8.84 minut e s . A fres hly pre p a r e d sam pl e of the isotop e has an activity of 124 Bq. (i) Calculat e the decay const a n t of Au-189. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 806 (ii) Dete r mi n e the activity of the sam pl e afte r 12.0 min. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tota l 5 mark s ) 51 2 . This ques tion is abou t CDs and CCDs. (a) Analogu e signals are stor e d on a CD as a digital, bina ry signal. For an analog u e signal of str e n g t h 11 V, (i) stat e the magni t u d e of the signal stre n g t h as a bina ry num b e r . ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) descri b e how a digit al signal, such as that in (a)(i), is stor e d on the CD. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (iii) outline how the stor e d digit one (1) in a digital signal is rea d from the CD using laser light reflect e d from the surfa c e of the CD. IB Questionbank Physics 807 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 808 (b) Unlike a CD, a CCD stor es light incide n t on its surfa c e in a digital form by dividing the surf ac e into a larg e num b e r of pixels. Eac h pixel has a fixed value of capaci t a n c e . (i) Define what is mea n t by the capacitan c e of a pixel. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Pixels of a particul a r CCD have an are a of 2.8 × 10 –10 m 2 and a capacit a n c e of 20 pF. A bea m of monoc h r o m a t i c light is incide n t on the CCD. The num b e r of photo n s per squa r e met r e arriving at the CCD is 4.0 × 10 13 . The qua n t u m efficiency of a pixel is 74 %. Dete r mi n e the incre a s e in pote n ti al differ e n c e acros s a pixel as a res ult of the incide n t light. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (4) (Tot al 10 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 809 51 3 . This ques tion is abou t an oper a tio n a l amplifier use d in a Sch mit t trigg e r circuit. (a) An oper a tio n al amplifier use s a ±6. 0 V supply. The oper a ti o n a l amplifier oper a t e s in the non- inver ti n g mode. (i) On the axes below, sketc h a gra p h to show how the outp u t voltag e V OUT of the amplifier varie s with the pote n ti al differ e n c e V betw e e n the two input s of the amplifie r. (2) (ii) With refer e n c e to the gra p h sketc h e d in (a)(i), explain why the oper a tio n al amplifier is said to act as a comp a r a t o r . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (b) The diagr a m shows an oper a ti o n a l amplifier conn e c t e d as a Schmit t trigg e r . The outp u t of the amplifie r is ±6. 0 V. IB Questionbank Physics 810 IB Questionbank Physics 811 (i) Show that the upp e r switc hi n g volta g e of the trigg e r , i.e. the input voltag e V IN for which the outp u t volta g e V OUT switc h e s from –6.0 V to +6. 0 V, is 2.0 V. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) The input signal V IN to the trigg e r is show n in the gra p h. The switchin g voltag e s of the trigg e r are ±2. 0 V. On the axes above, sketc h a gra p h to show how the outpu t voltag e V OUT varies with time t . (2) IB Questionbank Physics 812 (c) Explain the use of a Sch mit t trigg e r in the tra ns m i s sio n of digital signals. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tot al 10 mark s ) 51 4 . This ques tion is abou t a Galilea n tra n sfor m a t i o n and time dilation. Ben is in a spac e s hi p that is travelling in a str ai g h t- line with const a n t spe e d v as meas u r e d by Jill who is in a spa c e station. Ben switch e s on a light puls e that bounc e s vertic ally (as obse rv e d by Ben) betw e e n two horizon t al mirror s M 1 and M 2 sepa r a t e d by a dista n c e d . At the insta n t that the mir ro r s are opposit e Jill, the pulse is just leaving the mirro r M 2 . The spee d of light in air is c . (a) On the diag r a m , sketc h the pat h of the light pulse betw e e n M 1 and M 2 as obse rv e d by Jill. IB Questionbank Physics 813 (1) (b) The time for the light pulse to travel from M 2 to M 1 as me a s u r e d by Jill is Δt . (i) Stat e, accor di n g to Jill, the dista n c e move d by the spac e s hi p in time Δt . ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Using a Galilean tran sfo r m a t i o n, derive an expr e s s io n for the lengt h of the pat h of the light betw e e n M 2 and M 1 . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (c) Stat e, accor di n g to speci al rela tivity, the lengt h of the pat h of the light betw e e n M 2 and M 1 as me a s u r e d by Jill in ter m s of c and ∆t . ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (d) The time for the puls e to travel from M 2 to M 1 as mea s u r e d by Ben is ∆t ′. Use your answ e r s to (b)(i) and (c) to derive a rela tion s hi p betw e e n ∆t and ∆t ′. ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 814 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 815 (e) Accordi n g to a clock at res t with res p e c t to Jill, a clock in the space s hi p runs slow by a factor of 2.3. Show that the spe e d v of the space s hi p is 0.90c. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tot al 10 mark s ) 51 5 . This ques tion is abou t lepton s and meson s . (a) Lepto n s are a class of elem e n t a r y particle s and eac h lepton has its own antip a r ti cl e. Stat e wha t is mea n t by an (i) elem e n t a r y particle. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) antip a r t i cl e of a lepton. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 816 (b) The elect r o n is a lepton and its antip a r t i cl e is the positro n. The following reaction can take plac e betw e e n an elect r o n and positro n. e– + e+ → γ + γ Sket ch the Feyn m a n diagr a m for this reac tion and identify on your diagr a m any virtual particl e s. (3) (c) Unlike lepton s , the π + meso n is not an elem e n t a r y particle. Sta t e the (i) quar k s truct u r e of the π + meso n. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) reas o n why the following rea c tio n does not occur. p + + p+ → p + + π+ ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (d) Stat e the Pauli exclusion principle. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 817 (e) Explain, with refer e n c e to your ans w e r to (d), why qua r k s are assig n e d the prope r t y of colour. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tot al 10 mark s ) 51 6 . This ques tion is abou t the char a c t e r i s ti c s of the sta r s Procyon A and Procyon B. (a) The star s Procyon A and Procyon B are both locat e d in the sa m e stellar clust e r in the const ell a tion Canis Minor. Disting uis h betw e e n a const ell ation and a stellar clust e r . Cons t ella tio n: .......................................................................................... .................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... Stellar clust e r : ............................................................................................ ................. ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) The table shows som e dat a for Procyon A and Procyon B. Appar e n t ma g n i t u d e Procy o n A (P A ) Procy o n B (P B ) IB Questionbank Physics +0. 4 0 0 +1 0. 7 Abso l u t e ma g n i t u d e +2. 6 8 +1 3. 0 Appar e n t bri g h t n e s s / W m –2 2.06 × 10 –8 1.46 × 10 –12 818 Explain, using dat a from the table, why (i) as viewed from Eart h, P A is muc h bright e r tha n P B . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) the luminosity of P A is muc h gre a t e r tha n that of P B . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (c) Deduc e, using dat a from the table in (b), that P A and P B are appr oxi m a t ely the sam e dista n c e from Eart h. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 819 ..................... (2) (d) Stat e, using your ans w e r s to (a) and (c), why P A and P B might be binar y star s. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (e) LA Calcula t e, using dat a from the table in (b), the ratio LB whe r e L A is the luminosi ty of P A and L B is the luminosity of P B . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (f) The surf ac e tem p e r a t u r e of both P A and P B is of the orde r of 10 4 K. The luminosity of P A is of the orde r of 10 L S , whe r e L S is the luminosity of the Sun. The diag r a m shows the grid of a Her tz s p r u n g–R u s s e ll diagr a m . IB Questionbank Physics 820 Label, on the grid above, the app r oxi m a t e position of (i) star P A with the lette r A. (1) (ii) star P B with the lette r B. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 821 (g) Identify the natu r e of star P B . ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (Tot al 15 mark s ) 51 7 . This ques tion is abou t the Big Bang model and red- shift. (a) Descri b e what is mean t by the Big Bang model. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (b) In the 1960s, Penzias and Wilson discove r e d a unifor m cosmic backg r o u n d radiation (CMB) in the microw a v e region of the elect r o m a g n e t i c spect r u m . (i) Explain how the CMB is consist e n t with the Big Bang model. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (ii) Stat e why the red- shift of light from galaxies suppo r t s the Big IB Questionbank Physics 822 Bang model. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (Tota l 5 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 823 51 8 . This ques tion is abou t modula tio n. (a) Stat e what is mea n t by the modula tio n of a car ri e r wave. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (b) The grap h shows how the volta g e signal stre n g t h V of an amplitu d e modul a t e d (AM) carri e r wave varies with time t . Use the grap h to det e r m i n e the (i) frequ e n c y of the carri e r wave. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) frequ e n c y of the signal wave. ......................................................................................................... IB Questionbank Physics 824 .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 825 (iii) amplitu d e of the signal wave. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (iv) ban d wi d t h. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (c) A car rie r wave may also be frequ e n c y modul a t e d (FM). Stat e and explain on e adva n t a g e of FM comp a r e d to AM. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 8 mark s ) 51 9 . This ques tion is abou t optical fibre s. (a) Stat e what is mea n t by mat e ri al dispe r s io n. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 826 (2) (b) Sugg e s t why mat e ri al dispe r si o n sets a limit on the bit- rat e of tran s m i s sio n. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (c) (i) fibre. The signal show n below is fed into a mono m o d e optical On the diagr a m above, show the effects of mat e ri a l dispe r s io n on the input signal by drawi n g the sha p e of the sign al afte r it has travelled a long dista n c e in the optical fibre. (1) (ii) Stat e and explain how the effect s on the signal draw n in (c)(i) may be red uc e d . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (d) Digital dat a are tran s m i t t e d in an optic al fibre with a glass core which has a refr ac tive index of 1.5. The dur a tio n of one bit in the tran s m i s sio n is 0.50 ns and eac h sam pl e in the signal consist s of 32 bits. (i) Calculat e the time requi r e d for the signal to travel a dista n c e of IB Questionbank Physics 827 500 km. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 828 (ii) Dete r mi n e the sam pling frequ e n c y. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (e) The data in (d) are confide n ti al and mus t be prot e c t e d . Without taking financi al costs into accou n t , outline whet h e r a direc t optical fibre conn e c tio n or a tran s m i s sio n thro u g h a geosync h r o n o u s satellite would be mor e suita bl e for the tra n sf e r of the s e dat a. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tot al 12 mark s ) 52 0 . This ques tion is abou t laser s. (a) With refer e n c e to the light waves emitt e d by a lase r, stat e wha t is mea n t by the ter m s (i) monoch r o m a t i c. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 829 ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) cohe r e n t . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (b) The diagr a m (not to scale) shows thr e e of the ene r gy levels of a subs t a n c e used to produ c e lase r light. The ene r gy of the grou n d stat e is E 0 . (i) Stat e what is mean t by popula tion inver sion. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Draw an arro w on the diagr a m to indic at e the tran si tion that res ults in a popula tion inver sion. Label the arro w P. (1) (iii) Draw an arro w on the diagr a m to indic at e the tran si tion that IB Questionbank Physics 830 res ults in a pulse of lase r light. Label the arro w L. (1) (iv) Deduc e that the wavel e n g t h of the emitt e d lase r light is 690 nm. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (Tota l 6 mark s ) 52 1 . This ques tion is abou t an astr o n o m i c a l telesc o p e . The diagr a m (not to scale) show s the arr a n g e m e n t of the two convex lense s in an astro n o m i c al teles co p e in nor m a l adjus t m e n t . The teles co p e is used to observ e a dista n t star. One of the focal points of the eyepiec e lens is labelled F E . (a) On the diag r a m above, (i) label, with the symbol F E , the position of the othe r focal point of the eyepiec e lens. (1) (ii) label, with the symbol F O , the position of the focal point of the objective lens that is in betw e e n the two lens e s . (1) IB Questionbank Physics 831 (iii) cons t r u c t rays to locat e the final image of the star. (3) IB Questionbank Physics 832 (b) In a particul a r astr o n o m i c a l tele sc o p e , the eyepie c e lens has a powe r of 40 diopt r e s and the objec tive lens a powe r of 0.80 diopt r e s . Deter m i n e the angul a r mag nifica tion of the telesc o p e in nor m al adjus t m e n t . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (c) In an astr o n o m i c al telesco p e the objective is ofte n mad e up from a diver gi n g and a conver gi n g lens, whe r e a s the ape r t u r e of the eyepie c e is usually rest rict e d such that only rays close to the princip al axis are viewe d. Stat e the reas o n s for this. Objective lens: ................................................................................................ ............. Eyepiec e lens: ................................................................................................ .............. (2) (Tota l 9 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 833 52 2 . This ques tion is abou t a diffraction gra ti n g. (a) A par allel beam of monoc h r o m a t i c light is incide n t nor m ally on a diffraction grati n g. After passin g thro u g h the gra tin g it is broug h t to a focus on a scre e n by a lens. The diagr a m shows a few of the slits of the diffraction gratin g and the pat h of the light that is diffra c t e d at an angle θ to each slit. The dist an c e betw e e n the slits is d and the wavele n g t h of the light is λ. (i) On the diagr a m , const r u c t a line tha t ena bl e s the path differ e n c e betw e e n the rays from two adjac e n t slits to be show n. Label the path dist a n c e L . (1) (ii) Use your answ e r to (a)(i) to derive the condition, in ter m s of d and θ, for ther e to be a maxim u m of inte n si ty at the point P on the scre e n . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 834 (b) For a partic ul a r gratin g, the dista n c e betw e e n adjac e n t slits is 2.0 × 10 –6 m. Dete r mi n e, for light of wavele n g t h 520 nm, the maxim u m theor e t i c al orde r of diffrac tio n. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 5 mark s ) 52 3 . Two lengt h s, a and b , are mea s u r e d to be 51 ± 1 cm and 49 ± 1 cm res p e c tiv ely. In which of the following qua n ti tie s is the perc e n t a g e unce r t ai n t y the large s t ? A. a + b B. a –b C. a × b D. a b (Tot al 1 mar k ) 52 4 . A net force of mag nit u d e 4.0 N acts on a body of mas s 3.0 kg for 6.0 s. The body is initially at rest. Which of the following is the spe e d of the body afte r the 6.0 s interv al? A. 0.50 m s –1 B. 2.0 m s –1 C. 4.5 m s –1 D. 8.0 m s –1 (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 835 IB Questionbank Physics 836 52 5 . A car moves from X to Y along a semicir c ul a r path. The radius of the path is 250 m and the time taken to compl e t e the trip is 50 s. Which of the following cor r e c tly shows the mag nit u d e of the aver a g e velocity and the mag nit u d e of the ave r a g e spe e d ? Avera g e velo c i t y Avera g e sp e e d A. 10 m s –1 10 m s –1 B. 10 m s –1 16 m s –1 C. 16 m s –1 10 m s –1 D. 16 m s –1 16 m s –1 (Tot al 1 mar k ) 52 6 . A ball is tied to a string and rota t e d at a unifor m spe e d in a vertic al plan e. The diagr a m shows the ball at its lowest position. Which arrow shows the direction of the net force acting on the ball? (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 837 52 7 . Two steel balls, of mas s M and 2 M , fall at const a n t spe e d s in a tube filled with oil. Which of the following cor r e c tly comp a r e s the magni t u d e s of the net force and of the drag (resist a n c e ) force on the two balls? Ne t forc e Dra g forc e A. sam e sam e B. sam e differ e n t C. differ e n t sam e D. differ e n t differ e n t (Tot al 1 mar k ) 52 8 . An ice cube and an icebe r g are both at a tem p e r a t u r e of 0 °C. Which of the following is a corr ec t comp a ri s o n of the aver a g e ran do m kine tic ene r gy and the total kinetic ener gy of the molec ul e s of the ice cube and the icebe r g ? Avera g e rand o m kin e t i c en e r g y Tot al kin e t i c en e r g y A. sam e sa m e B. sam e differ e n t C. differ e n t sa m e D. differ e n t differ e n t (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 838 52 9 . An ideal gas expa n d s isoth e r m a lly from a stat e X to a new stat e of volum e V . The work done by the gas is W . Which of the following is corr e c t for an adiab a ti c expa n sio n of the gas from stat e X to a new sta t e of volum e V ? Cha n g e in int e r n a l en e r g y Work don e A. ∆U > 0 gre a t e r tha n W B. ∆U < 0 gre a t e r tha n W C. ∆U > 0 less tha n W D. ∆U < 0 less tha n W (Tot al 1 mar k ) 53 0 . The gra p h shows the variation with absolut e tem p e r a t u r e T of the pre s s u r e p of a fixed mas s of an ideal gas. Which of the following is corr ec t conc e r ni n g the volum e and the density of the gas? Volu m e De n s i t y A. const a n t cons t a n t B. const a n t incr e a s i n g C. incr e a si n g cons t a n t D. incr e a si n g incr e a s i n g (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 839 53 1 . Which of the following grap h s shows the varia tion with displa c e m e n t x of the spee d v of a particle perfor mi n g simple har m o nic motion. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 53 2 . A particle perfor m s simple har m o ni c oscillations. Which of the following quan ti tie s will be unaffect e d by a redu c tio n in the amplitu d e of oscillations ? A. The total ene r gy B. The maxim u m spee d C. The maxim u m accele r a t i o n D. The period (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 840 53 3 . Monoc h r o m a t i c light travels from air into wat e r . Which of the following descri b e s the chan g e s in wavele n g t h and spe e d ? Wavel e n g t h Sp e e d A. incr e a s e s decr e a s e s B. incr e a s e s incr e a s e s C. decr e a s e s incr e a s e s D. decr e a s e s decr e a s e s (Tot al 1 mar k ) 53 4 . A stan di n g wave is esta blis h e d in air in a pipe with one close d and one open end. The air molecul e s near X are A. always at the cent r e of a comp r e s si o n. B. always at the cent r e of a rar ef a c tio n. C. som eti m e s at the cent r e of a comp r e s s io n and som e ti m e s at the cent r e of a rar ef a c tio n. D. neve r at the cent r e of a comp r e s si o n or a rar ef a c tio n. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 841 53 5 . In two sepa r a t e expe ri m e n t s monoc h r o m a t i c light is incide n t on a single slit. The diagr a m s show the diffra c tion patt e r n s obtain e d on a scre e n far from the slit. In the top diag r a m the wavele n g t h of light is λ 1 and the slit width is b 1 . In the botto m diag r a m the wavele n g t h of light is λ 2 and the slit width is b 2 . In each expe ri m e n t the dista n c e betw e e n the slit and the scre e n is the sam e. Which of the following may be ded uc e d ? A. λ1 λ 2 b1 b2 B. λ1 λ 2 b1 b2 C. b1 < b2 D. λ1 > λ2 (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 842 53 6 . Horizont ally polarize d light is tra n s m i t t e d throu g h a polarize r whos e tran s mi s s io n axis is horizont al. The light ent e r s a cont ai n e r with a suga r solution and is then incide n t on a secon d pola riz e r whos e tra n s m i s sio n axis is vertical. When the secon d polarizer is rotat e d by a small angle, no light is tran s mi t t e d thro u g h the secon d polariz e r . The expla n a t io n for this obse rv a tio n is that the suga r solution A. caus e s dest r u c t iv e interf e r e n c e . B. rotat e s the plane of polariz a tion of light. C. can only tran s m i t vertically pola riz e d light. D. refr ac t s light so no light is incide n t on the secon d pola riz e r. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 53 7 . A sour c e of soun d app ro a c h e s a station a r y obse rv e r . The spe e d of the emitt e d sound and its wavele n g t h , me a s u r e d at the sourc e , are v and λ res p e c tiv ely. Which of the following is the wave spe e d and the wavele n g t h , as meas u r e d by the station a r y obse rv e r ? Wave sp e e d Wavel e n g t h A. larg e r than v larg e r tha n λ B. equal to v larg e r tha n λ C. equal to v less tha n λ D. larg e r than less tha n λ IB Questionbank Physics 843 v (Tot al 1 mar k ) 53 8 . The diagr a m shows the pat h of a projec tile tha t is launc h e d with velocity v . Air resis t a n c e is negligible. A secon d projectile has doubl e the mas s of the first proje ctile and is launc h e d with the sam e velocity. Air resist a n c e is still negligible. Which of the following pat hs best repr e s e n t s the pat h of the projec tile? ( The original path is sho w n as a dott ed line ) (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 844 53 9 . The diagr a m shows equipot e n t i al lines due to two object s. The two object s could be A. elect ric char g e s of the sam e sign only. B. mas s e s only. C. elect ric char g e s of opposit e sign only. D. mas s e s or elect ric char g e s of any sign. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 845 54 0 . Two positive and two neg a tive point char g e s of equal mag ni t u d e are plac e d at the vertice s of a squa r e as show n. The origin of the axes is at the cent r e of the squa r e . The elect ric poten ti al is zero A. at the origin of the axes only. B. along both the x -axis and the y -axis. C. along the y -axis only. D. along the x -axis only. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 846 54 1 . A rect a n g ul a r loop of condu c ti n g wire rota t e s in a region of mag n e ti c field. The gra p h shows the variation with time t of the induc e d emf in the loop durin g one cycle. Which of the following gives the corr e c t time s at which the ma gni t u d e of the mag n e t i c flux linkag e and the mag nit u d e of the curr e n t in the loop are maxim u m ? Flux link a g e Curre n t A. Y Y B. Y X C. X Y D. X X (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 847 54 2 . A rect a n g ul a r loop of condu c ti n g wire rota t e s in a region of mag n e ti c field. The gra p h shows the variation with time t of the induc e d emf in the loop durin g one cycle. The resist a n c e of the coil is 5.0 Ω. Which of the following i s the aver a g e powe r dissipa t e d in the loop? A. 45 2 W 45 B. 2W C. 45 W D. 45 2 W (Tot al 1 mar k ) 54 3 . The radii of nuclei may be dete r m i n e d by A. scat t e r i n g char g e d particle s off the nuclei. B. injectin g the nuclei in a mass spec t r o m e t e r . C. mea s u ri n g the de Broglie wavele n g t h of the nuclei. D. obse rvin g the spect r u m of the nuclei. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 848 54 4 . In the photo el ec t ri c effect, the following obse rv a tio n s may be ma de . I. The kinetic ener gy of the emitt e d elect r o n s incr e a s e s with incr e a s i n g light frequ e n c y. II. The elect r o n s are emitt e d withou t time delay. Which of thes e obs erv a tio n s , if any, can be explain e d in ter m s of the wave theo ry of light? A. Neith e r I nor II B. I and II C. I only D. II only (Tot al 1 mar k ) 54 5 . A proton and an alpha par ticle have the sam e de Broglie wavele n g t h . s p e e dof a lp h ap a r t ic le s p e e do f p r o t o n ? Which of the following is appr oxi m a t e ly the ratio A. 1 4 B. 1 2 C. 2 D. 4 (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 849 54 6 . The ener gi e s of alpha particl es and of gam m a- rays emitt e d in radioa c tive decay are discr e t e . This observ a tio n is evide n c e for A. atomic ene r gy levels. B. nuclea r ener gy levels. C. nuclei having mor e neut r o n s tha n proton s . D. the existe n c e of isotop e s. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 54 7 . The diagr a m s show the variation with dista n c e x of the wave function ψ of four differ e n t elect r o n s . The scale on the horizont al axis in all four diagr a m s is the sam e. For which elect r o n is the unc e r t a i n t y in the mom e n t u m the large s t ? (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 850 54 8 . A wave gene r a t o r produ c e s a powe r per unit lengt h of 4.0 kW m –1 for waves of amplit u d e A and spee d v . The efficiency of the gen e r a t o r is cons t a n t . The power per unit lengt h obtain e d from waves of amplit u d e 2 A and spee d 2 v would be A. 8.0 kW m –1 . B. 16 kW m –1 . C. 32 kW m –1 . D. 64 kW m –1 . (Tot al 1 mar k ) 54 9 . Which of the following stat e m e n t s , relatin g to the prod u c tio n of nucle a r powe r , is corr e c t ? A. The fuel has high ener gy density. B. Supplies of nuclea r fuels are unlimit e d. C. Gree n h o u s e gas emissions are significa n t. D. Wast e produ c t s are not signific a n t . (Tot al 1 mar k ) 55 0 . Data are stor e d on an audio comp a c t disc (CD) at a rat e of f sam pl e s per secon d. Each sam pl e cont ai ns b bits. A total of N bits are stor e d on the CD. Which of the following is the playing time of the CD in secon d s ? A. Nf b B. N bf C. bN f D. bf N (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 851 55 1 . Light incide n t on the pixel of a CCD caus e s elect ric char g e to collec t in the pixel. The amou n t of char g e collect e d in a given time is propo r t io n al to which char a c t e r i s tic of the incide n t light? A. The degr e e of polariza tion B. The inten sity C. The wavele n g t h D. The frequ e n c y (Tot al 1 mar k ) 55 2 . Data analysis ques tion. A stud e n t perfor m s an expe ri m e n t with a pap e r toy tha t rota t e s as it falls slowly throu g h the air. After rele a s e , the pape r toy quickly att ain s a cons t a n t vertic al spee d as meas u r e d over a fixed vertic al dista n c e . The aim of the expe ri m e n t was to find how the ter mi n al spe e d of the pape r toy varies with its weigh t. The weigh t of the pape r toy was chan g e d by using differ e n t num b e r s of pap e r she e t s in its const r u c t i o n. IB Questionbank Physics 852 The gra p h shows a plot of the ter mi n a l spe e d v of the pap e r toy (calcula t e d from the raw dat a) and the num b e r of pap e r she e t s n use d to const r u c t the toy. The unce r t ai n t y in v for n = 1 is show n by the erro r bar. (a) The fixed dist a n c e is 0.75 m and has an absolut e unce r t a i n t y of 0.01 m. The perc e n t a g e unce r t a i n t y in the time take n to fall throu g h the fixed dist an c e is 5 %. (i) Calculat e the absolut e unce r t a i n t y in the ter mi n al spe e d of the pap e r toy for n = 6. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) IB Questionbank Physics 853 (ii) On the grap h, draw an error bar on the point corr e s p o n di n g to n = 6. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 854 (b) On the gra p h, draw a line of best- fit for the data points. (1) (c) The stud e n t hypot h e s iz e s tha t v is propo r tio n a l to n . Use the data points for n = 2 and n = 4 from the gra p h above to show that this hypot h e s i s is incor r e c t . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 855 (d) Anothe r stud e n t hypot h e s iz e d tha t v might be propo r tio n a l to n . To verify this hypot h e si s he plott e d a gra p h of lg v agains t lg n as show n below. Show that the grap h verifies the hypot h e si s that v is propo r tio n a l to n. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (4) (Tot al 12 mark s ) 55 3 . This ques tion is abou t fuel for hea tin g. IB Questionbank Physics 856 (a) Define the ener gy densi ty of a fuel. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 857 (b) A room heat e r bur n s liquid fuel and the following dat a are availabl e. Density of liquid fuel 8.0 × 10 2 kg m –3 Ener gy produ c e d by 1 m 3 of liquid fuel 2.7 × 10 10 J Rate at which fuel is cons u m e d 0.13 g s –1 Temp e r a t u r e at which air ent e r s hea t e r °C Temp e r a t u r e at which air leave s hea t e r °C Specific heat capa ci ty of air 990 J kg –1 K–1 (i) = = = = 12 = 32 = Use the dat a to calcula t e the powe r outp u t of the room hea t e r , ignorin g the power requi r e d to conve r t the liquid fuel into a gas. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (ii) All the ene r gy outp u t of the room heat e r raise s the tem p e r a t u r e of the air moving throu g h it. Use the dat a to calcul a t e the mas s of air that moves throu g h the room hea t e r in on e secon d. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 858 ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (Tota l 7 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 859 55 4 . This ques tion is abou t digital data stor a g e . (a) Descri b e, with refer e n c e to the stru c t u r e of a DVD, how stor e d digital dat a are read. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (4) (b) The Blu- ray stor a g e syste m uses a lase r diode tha t emits a wavele n g t h of 405 nm, wher e a s the olde r DVD syste m uses radia tion of wavelen g t h 650 nm. Explain the adva n t a g e s of using a smalle r wavelen g t h . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 860 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (4) (Tota l 8 mark s ) 55 5 . This ques tion is abou t elect r o m a g n e t i c induc tio n. (a) In orde r to mea s u r e the rms value of an alte r n a t i n g cur r e n t in a cable, a small coil of wire is plac e d close to the cable. The plane of the small coil is par allel to the direc tio n of the cable. The ends of the small coil are conn e c t e d to a high resist a n c e ac voltm e t e r . Use Far a d a y’s law to explain why an emf is induc e d in the small coil. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 861 (b) The grap h below show s the variatio n with time t of the cur r e n t in the cable. On the axes below, draw a sketc h gra p h to show the variatio n with time of the emf induc e d in the small coil. (2) (c) Explain how readi n g s on the high resist a n c e ac voltm e t e r can be use d to com p a r e the rms values of alte r n a t i n g curr e n t s in differ e n t cable s. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tota l 8 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 862 55 6 . This ques tion is abou t the Ruthe r fo r d model of the atom. (a) Most alpha par ticles used to bomb a r d a thin gold foil pass thro u g h the foil witho u t a significa n t cha n g e in direc tion. A few alpha par ticle s are deviat e d from their original direc tion thro u g h angl es gre a t e r than 90°. Use thes e observ a tio n s to desc ri b e the Ruthe r fo r d atomic model. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (5) IB Questionbank Physics 863 (b) The isotop e gold- 197 ( is not. (i) 197 7 9 Au ) is sta ble but the isotop e gold- 199 ( 199 7 9 Au ) Outline, in ter m s of the force s acting betw e e n nucleo n s , why, for large stabl e nuclei such as gold- 197, the num b e r of neut r o n s excee d s the num b e r of proton s . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (ii) 199 199 A nucle u s of 7 9 Au dec ays to a nucle u s of 8 0 H g . Sta t e the two par ticl es , othe r than γ-photon, e mitte d in this dec ay. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tot al 10 mark s ) 55 7 . This ques tion is abou t the simple pend ul u m . (a) A pend ul u m consist s of a bob susp e n d e d by a light inexte n si bl e string from a rigid suppo r t . The pend ul u m bob is move d to one side and the n relea s e d . The sketc h grap h show s how the displa c e m e n t of the pend ul u m bob und e r g oi n g simple har m o ni c motion varie s with time over one time period. IB Questionbank Physics 864 IB Questionbank Physics 865 On the sketc h grap h above, (i) label with the lette r A a point at which the accele r a t io n of the pend ul u m bob is a maxim u m . (1) (ii) label with the lette r V a point at which the spe e d of the pend ul u m bob is a maxim u m . (1) (b) Explain why the mag ni t u d e of the tension in the string at the midpoint of the oscillation is grea t e r tha n the weight of the pend ul u m bob. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (c) The pend ul u m bob is moved to one side until its cent r e is 25 mm above its rest position and the n rele a s e d . IB Questionbank Physics 866 (i) Show that the spee d of the pend ul u m bob at the midpoint of the oscillation is 0.70 m s –1 . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) The mas s of the pend ul u m bob is 0.057 kg. The cent r e of the pend ul u m bob is 0.80 m below the suppo r t . Calcula t e the mag ni t u d e of the tension in the string whe n the pend ul u m bob is vertically below the point of sus p e n s i o n. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (d) The point of susp e n s i o n of the pend ul u m bob is move d from side to side with a small amplitu d e and at a variabl e driving frequ e n c y f. IB Questionbank Physics 867 For each value of the driving frequ e n c y a ste a dy cons t a n t amplitu d e A is reac h e d . The oscillations of the pend ul u m bob are lightly dam p e d . IB Questionbank Physics 868 (i) On the axes below, sketc h a gra p h to show the variation of A with f. (2) (ii) Explain, with refer e n c e to the gra p h in (d)(i), wha t is me a n t by reson a n c e . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (e) The pend ul u m bob is now imm e r s e d in wate r and the varia bl e frequ e n c y driving force in (d) is again applie d. Sugg e s t the effect this imme r s io n of the pend ul u m bob will have on the sha p e of your gra p h in (d)(i). ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 869 ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tot al 16 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 870 55 8 . This ques tion is abou t the de Broglie hypot h e si s . (a) Descri b e the de Broglie hypot h e si s . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) A bea m of elect r o n s is acc ele r a t e d from res t thro u g h a pote n ti al differ e n c e of 85 V. Show that the de Broglie wavel e n g t h associa t e d with the elect r o n s in the bea m is 0.13 nm. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (c) Elect r o n s with the sam e kinetic ene r gy as thos e in (b) are incide n t on a circula r aper t u r e of diam e t e r 1.1 nm. IB Questionbank Physics 871 The elect r o n s are dete c t e d beyond the ape r t u r e . IB Questionbank Physics 872 The grap h shows the variatio n with angle θ of the num b e r n of elect r o n s det ec t e d per secon d after diffrac tion by the ape r t u r e . Use your answ e r to (b) above to explain how dat a from the gra p h suppo r t the de Broglie hypot h e s i s. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (4) (Tota l 9 mark s ) 55 9 . This ques tion is abou t a light ni n g disch a r g e . (a) Define electric field stren g t h . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 873 ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 874 (b) A thun d e r cl o u d can be modelle d as a neg a tively cha r g e d plat e that is par allel to the grou n d . The mag ni t u d e of the char g e on the plat e incre a s e s due to proc e s s e s in the atmo s p h e r e . Event u a lly a cur r e n t disc h a r g e s from the thun d e r cl o u d to the grou n d . On the diag r a m , draw the elect ric field patt e r n betw e e n the thun d e r cl o u d bas e and the grou n d . (3) (c) The cur r e n t disch a r g e s whe n the mag ni t u d e of the elect ric field betw e e n the groun d and the thun d e r c l o u d base is 0.33 MN C –1 . The thun d e r cl o u d bas e is 750 m above the groun d. (i) Calculat e, just befor e disch a r g e , the pote n ti al differ e n c e betw e e n the thun d e r cl o u d bas e and the grou n d. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) IB Questionbank Physics 875 (ii) The poten ti al differ e n c e V , betw e e n the thun d e r c l o u d bas e and the grou n d , is given by Qd V = Aε 0 wher e Q is the char g e on the thun d e r c l o u d bas e, A is the are a of the bas e, and d is the dista n c e betw e e n the bas e and the groun d. The area of the bas e is 1.2 × 10 7 m 2 . Calculat e, just befor e disch a r g e , the cha r g e on the bas e of the thun d e r cl o u d . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (iii) Dete r mi n e the ener gy rele a s e d in the disch a r g e . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (4) (Tot al 14 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 876 56 0 . This ques tion is abou t microw a v e radia tio n. A microw a v e tran s m i t t e r emits radia tio n of a single wavele n g t h towa r d s a met al plat e along a line nor m al to the plat e. The radia tio n is reflec t e d back towa r d s the tran s m i t t e r . A microw a v e det ec t o r is moved along a line nor m a l to the microw a v e tran s mi t t e r and the met al plat e. The det e c t o r recor d s a sequ e n c e of equ ally spac e d maxim a and minim a of inten sity. (a) Explain how thes e maxim a and minim a are form e d. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (4) (b) The microw av e det ec t o r is move d thro u g h 130 mm from one point of minim u m intensi ty to anot h e r point of minim u m inte n si ty. On the way it pass es thro u g h nine point s of maxim u m inte n sity. Calcula t e the (i) wavele n g t h of the microw a v e s . ......................................................................................................... IB Questionbank Physics 877 .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 878 (ii) frequ e n c y of the microw a v e s . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (c) Descri b e and explain how it could be demo n s t r a t e d that the microw av e s are polarize d. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tot al 11 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 879 IB Questionbank Physics 880 56 1 . This ques tion is abou t nuclea r fission. (a) A possible fission reac tio n is 235 92 U (i) 01 n 93 26 Kr 15461Ba x 10 n . Stat e the value of x . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Show that the ener gy rele a s e d whe n one ura ni u m nucle u s unde r g o e s fission in the rea c tion in (a) is about 2.8 × 10 –11 J. Mass Mass Mass Mass of of of of neut r o n = 1.008 6 7 u U-235 nucle u s = 234.99 3 3 3 u Kr- 92 nucle u s = 91.90 6 4 5 u Ba- 141 nucle u s = 140.88 3 5 4 u ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (4) (iii) Stat e how the ene r gy of the neut r o n s produ c e d in the reac tion in (a) is likely to com p a r e with the ene r gy of the neut r o n that initiat e d the reac tion. ......................................................................................................... IB Questionbank Physics 881 .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 882 (b) Outline the role of the mode r a t o r . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (c) (i) A nucle a r powe r plant that uses U-235 as fuel has a useful powe r outpu t of 16 MW and an efficiency of 40 %. Assumi n g that each fission of U-235 gives rise to 2.8 × 10 –11 J of ener gy, dete r m i n e the mas s of U-235 fuel used per day. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (4) (ii) Describ e how some reac t o r s are use d to prod u c e pluto ni u m- 239. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 883 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 884 (iii) Stat e the impor t a n c e of plutoniu m- 239. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (d) Some nuclea r react o r s have a hea t exch a n g e r tha t uses a gas that is kept at const a n t volum e. The first law of the r m o d y n a m i c s can be repr e s e n t e d as Q = ∆U + W . (i) Stat e the mea ni n g s of Q and W . Q: .................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. W : .................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) Describ e how the first law of the r m o dy n a m i c s applie s in the oper a tio n of the heat excha n g e r . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 885 ......................................................................................................... .................. (4) IB Questionbank Physics 886 (iii) Discus s the ent r o py chan g e s that take plac e in the gas and in the sur r o u n di n g s . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (4) (Tot al 25 mark s ) 56 2 . This ques tion is abou t collisions. (a) Stat e the principl e of cons e r v a ti o n of mom e n t u m . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 887 (b) In an expe ri m e n t , an air- rifle pellet is fired into a block of modelling clay that res ts on a table. (not to scale) The air- rifle pellet rem ai n s inside the clay block afte r the impa c t. As a result of the collision, the clay block slides along the table in a str aig h t line and comes to res t. Furt h e r dat a relatin g to the expe ri m e n t are given below. Mass of air- rifle pellet = 2.0 g Mass of clay block = 56 g Velocity of impa c t of air- rifle pellet = 140 m s –1 Stoppi n g dista n c e of clay block = 2.8 m (i) Show that the initial spee d of the clay block afte r the air- rifle pellet strikes it is 4.8 m s –1 . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 888 (ii) Calculat e the aver a g e friction al force tha t the surfa c e of the table exert s on the clay block whilst the clay block is moving. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (4) (c) The experi m e n t is repe a t e d with the clay block plac e d at the edg e of the table so that it is fired away from the table. The initial spee d of the clay block is 4.3 m s –1 horizon t ally. The table surfa c e is 0.85 m above the groun d. (not to scale) IB Questionbank Physics 889 (i) Ignorin g air resist a n c e , calcula t e the horizon t al dista n c e travelled by the clay block befor e it strike s the groun d. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (4) (ii) The diagr a m in (c) shows the pat h of the clay block negle c ti n g air resis t a n c e . On the diagr a m , dra w the app roxi m a t e shap e of the path that the clay block will take assu mi n g that air resist a n c e acts on the clay block. (3) (Tot al 15 mark s ) 56 3 . This ques tion is abou t the gravit a tio n a l field of Mar s. (a) Define gravitational poten tial ener g y of a mas s at a point. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 890 ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 891 (b) The grap h shows the variatio n with dist a n c e r from the cent r e of Mars of the gravit a tio n al poten ti al V . R is the radius of Mar s which is 3.3 Mm. (Values of V for r < R are not show n.) A rocket of mas s 1.2 × 10 4 kg lifts off from the surfa c e of Mar s. Use the grap h to (i) calcula t e the chan g e in gravit a tion a l pote n ti al ene r gy of the rocket at a dist an c e 4 R from the cent r e of Mars. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... IB Questionbank Physics 892 .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (ii) show that the magni t u d e of the gravit a tion a l field stre n g t h at a dist a n c e 4 R from the cent r e of Mars is 0.23 N kg –1 . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (c) Use the answ e r to (b)(ii) to show that the mag nit u d e of the gravit atio n al field stre n g t h at the surfa c e of Mars is 3.7 N kg –1 . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (d) The gravit a tio n al poten ti al at the surfa c e of Eart h is –63 MJ kg –1 . Without any furth e r calcula tio n, comp a r e the esca p e spee d requir e d to leave the surfac e of Eart h with that of the esca p e spe e d requi r e d to leave the surf ac e of Mars. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 893 ..................... (2) (Tot al 10 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 894 56 4 . This ques tion is abou t the char a c t e r i s ti c s of the sta r s Procyon A and Procyon B. (a) The star s Procyon A and Procyon B are both locat e d in the sa m e stellar clust e r in the const ell a tion Canis Minor. Disting uis h betw e e n a const ell ation and a stellar clust e r . Cons t ella tio n: .......................................................................................... .................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... Stellar clust e r : ............................................................................................ .................. ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) The table shows som e dat a for Procyon A and Procyon B. Appar e n t ma g n i t u d e Pro cy o n A (P A ) Pro cy o n B (P B ) Abs ol u t e ma g n i t u d e +2. 6 8 +0. 4 0 0 +1 0. 7 +1 3. 0 Appar e n t bri g h t n e s s / W m –2 2.06 × 10 –8 1.46 × 10 –12 Explain, using dat a from the table, why (i) as viewed from Eart h, P A is muc h bright e r tha n P B . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 895 (ii) the luminosity of P A is muc h gre a t e r tha n that of P B . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (c) Deduc e, using dat a from the table in (b), that P A and P B are appr oxi m a t ely the sam e dista n c e from Eart h. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (d) Stat e, using your ans w e r s to (a) and (c), why P A and P B might be binar y star s. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 896 (e) LA Calcula t e, using dat a from the table in (b), the ratio LB whe r e L A is the luminosi ty of P A and L B is the luminosity of P B . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (f) The surf ac e tem p e r a t u r e of both P A and P B is of the orde r of 10 4 K. The luminosity of P A is of the orde r of 10 L S , whe r e L S is the luminosity of the Sun. The diag r a m shows the grid of a Her tz s p r u n g–R u s s e ll diagr a m . Label, on the grid above, the app r oxi m a t e position of (i) star P A with the lette r A. (1) (ii) star P B with the lette r B. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 897 (g) Identify the natu r e of star P B . ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (h) On the grid provide d in (f), dra w the evolution a r y pat h of the sta r P A. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 898 (i) The luminosity of the main sequ e n c e sta r Regul us is 150 L S . Assumin g that, in the mas s–lu mi n o sity relation s hi p, n = 3.5 show tha t the mass of Regulus is 4.2 M S wher e M S is the mas s of the Sun. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (j) The star Betelg e u s e is about five times the mass of Regulus. One possible outco m e of the final sta g e of the evolution of Betelg e u s e is for it to beco m e a black hole. Sta t e the (i) othe r possible outco m e of the final sta g e of the evolution of Betelg e u s e . ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) reas o n why the final sta g e in (j)(i) is stabl e. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (Tot al 21 mark s ) 56 5 . This ques tion is abou t the Big Bang model and red- shift. (a) Descri b e what is mean t by the Big Bang model. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 899 ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 900 (b) In the 1960s, Penzias and Wilson discove r e d a unifor m cosmic backg r o u n d radiation (CMB) in the microw a v e region of the elect r o m a g n e t i c spect r u m . (i) Explain how the CMB is consist e n t with the Big Bang model. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (ii) Stat e why the red- shift of light from galaxies suppo r t s the Big Bang model. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (c) Many galaxies are a grea t dista n c e from Eart h. Explain, with refer e n c e to Hubbl e’s law, how the mea s u r e m e n t of the red- shift of light from such galaxies ena bl e s their dist a n c e from Eart h to be dete r m i n e d . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 901 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 902 (d) Stat e on e proble m associ a t e d with using Hubbl e’s law to det e r m i n e the dista n c e of a galaxy a gre a t dista n c e from Eart h. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (Tota l 9 mark s ) 56 6 . This ques tion is abou t modula tio n. (a) Stat e what is mea n t by the modula tio n of a car ri e r wave. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (b) The grap h shows how the volta g e signal stre n g t h V of an amplitu d e modul a t e d (AM) carri e r wave varies with time t . IB Questionbank Physics 903 Use the grap h to det e r m i n e the (i) frequ e n c y of the carri e r wave. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) frequ e n c y of the signal wave. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (iii) amplitu d e of the signal wave. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (iv) ban d wi d t h. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (c) A car rie r wave may also be frequ e n c y modul a t e d (FM). Stat e and explain on e adva n t a g e of FM comp a r e d to AM. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 904 ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 8 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 905 56 7 . This ques tion is abou t optical fibre s. (a) Outline what is mean t by mat e r i al dispe r s io n. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) Sugg e s t why mat e ri al dispe r si o n sets a limit on the bit- rat e of tran s m i s sio n. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (c) (i) fibre. The signal show n below is fed into a mono m o d e optical On the diagr a m above, show the effects of mat e ri a l dispe r s io n on the input signal by drawi n g the sha p e of the sign al afte r it has travelled a long dista n c e in the optical fibre. (1) (ii) Stat e and explain how the effect s on the signal draw n in (c)(i) may be red uc e d . ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 906 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 907 (d) Digital dat a are tran s m i t t e d in an optic al fibre with a glass core which has a refr ac tive index of 1.5. The dur a tio n of one bit in the tran s m i s sio n is 0.50 ns and eac h sam pl e in the signal consist s of 32 bits. (i) Calculat e the time requi r e d for the signal to travel a dista n c e of 500 km. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) Dete r mi n e the sam pling frequ e n c y. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (e) The data in (d) are confide n ti al and mus t be prot e c t e d . Without taking financi al costs into accou n t , outline whet h e r a direc t optical fibre conn e c tio n or a trans m i s si o n throu g h a geosync h r o n o u s satellite would be mor e suita bl e for the tra n sf e r of the s e dat a. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 908 ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tot al 12 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 909 56 8 . This ques tion is abou t an oper a tio n a l amplifier use d in a Sch mit t trigg e r circuit. (a) An oper a tio n al amplifier use s a ±6. 0 V supply. The oper a ti o n a l amplifier oper a t e s in the non- inver ti n g mode. (i) On the axes below, sketc h a gra p h to show how the outp u t voltag e V OUT of the amplifier varie s with the pote n ti al differ e n c e V betw e e n the two input s of the amplifier. (2) (ii) With refer e n c e to the gra p h sketc h e d in (a)(i), explain why the oper a tio n al amplifier is said to act as a comp a r a t o r . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (b) The diagr a m shows an oper a ti o n a l amplifier conn e c t e d as a Schmit t trigg e r . The outp u t of the amplifie r is ±6. 0 V. IB Questionbank Physics 910 IB Questionbank Physics 911 (i) Show that the upp e r switc hi n g volta g e of the trigg e r , i.e. the input voltag e V IN for which the outp u t volta g e V OUT switc h e s from –6.0 V to +6. 0 V, is 2.0 V. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) The input signal V IN to the trigg e r is show n in the gra p h. The switchin g voltag e s of the trigg e r are ±2. 0 V. On the axes above, sketc h a gra p h to show how the outpu t voltag e V OUT varies with time t . (2) IB Questionbank Physics 912 (c) Explain the use of a Sch mit t trigg e r in the tra ns m i s sio n of digital signals. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tot al 10 mark s ) 56 9 . This ques tion is abou t laser s. (a) With refer e n c e to the light waves emitt e d by a lase r, stat e wha t is mea n t by the ter m s (i) monoch r o m a t i c. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) cohe r e n t . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 913 (b) The diagr a m (not to scale) shows thr e e of the ene r gy levels of a subs t a n c e used to produ c e lase r light. The ene r gy of the grou n d stat e is E 0 . (i) Stat e what is mean t by popula tion inver sion. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Draw an arro w on the diagr a m to indic at e the tran si tion that res ults in a popula tion inver sion. Label the arro w P. (1) (iii) Draw an arro w on the diagr a m to indic at e the tran si tion that res ults in a pulse of lase r light. Label the arro w L. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 914 (iv) Deduc e that the wavel e n g t h of the emitt e d lase r light is 690 nm. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (Tota l 6 mark s ) 57 0 . This ques tion is abou t an astr o n o m i c a l telesc o p e . The diagr a m (not to scale) show s the arr a n g e m e n t of the two convex lense s in an astro n o m i c al teles co p e in nor m a l adjus t m e n t . The teles co p e is used to observ e a dista n t star. One of the focal points of the eyepiec e lens is labelled F E . (a) On the diag r a m above, (i) label, with the symbol F E , the position of the othe r focal point of the eyepiec e lens. (1) (ii) label, with the symbol F O , the position of the focal point of the objective lens that is in betw e e n the two lens e s . (1) IB Questionbank Physics 915 (iii) cons t r u c t rays to locat e the final image of the star. (3) (b) In a particul a r astr o n o m i c a l tele sc o p e , the eyepie c e lens has a powe r of 40 diopt r e s and the objec tive lens a powe r of 0.80 diopt r e s . Deter m i n e the angul a r mag nifica tion of the telesc o p e in nor m al adjus t m e n t . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (c) In an astr o n o m i c al telesco p e the objective is ofte n mad e up from a diver gi n g and a conver gi n g lens, whe r e a s the ape r t u r e of the eyepie c e lens is usually res t ric t e d suc h tha t only rays close to the princip al axis are viewed. Stat e the reas o n s for this. Objective lens: ................................................................................................ ............ Eyepiec e lens: ................................................................................................ ............. (2) (Tota l 9 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 916 57 1 . This ques tion is abou t a diffraction gra ti n g. (a) A par allel beam of monoc h r o m a t i c light is incide n t nor m ally on a diffraction grati n g. After passin g thro u g h the gra tin g it is broug h t to a focus on a scre e n by a lens. The diagr a m shows a few of the slits of the diffraction gratin g and the pat h of the light that is diffra c t e d at an angle θ to each slit. The dist an c e betw e e n the slits is d and the wavele n g t h of the light is λ. (i) On the diagr a m , const r u c t a line tha t ena bl e s the path differ e n c e betw e e n the rays from two adjac e n t slits to be show n. Label the path dist a n c e L . (1) (ii) Use your answ e r to (a)(i) to derive the condition, in ter m s of d and θ, for ther e to be a maxim u m of inte n si ty at the point P on the scre e n . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 917 (b) For a partic ul a r gratin g, the dista n c e betw e e n adjac e n t slits is 2.0 × 10 –6 m. Dete r mi n e, for light of wavele n g t h 520 nm, the maxim u m theor e t i c al orde r of diffrac tio n. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 5 mark s ) 57 2 . This ques tion is abou t X-ray diffrac tion. (a) The diagr a m repr e s e n t s som e of the atom s in two layer s of a cubic cryst al lattice. Use the diagr a m to outline how diffra c tio n arise s from the scat t e ri n g of X-rays by a cryst al. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 918 ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (b) X-rays of wavele n g t h 87 pm are scat t e r e d by a cryst al whos e atom s are arr a n g e d in a cubic lattic e. The smalles t scat t e ri n g angle for which a maxim u m of the scat t e r e d X-ray is obs e rv e d is 18°. Calcula t e the spacin g betw e e n adjac e n t atom s in the cryst al. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 5 mark s ) 57 3 . This ques tion is abou t thin- film inte rf e r e n c e . The diagr a m (not to scale) repr e s e n t s an expe ri m e n t a l set- up desig n e d to meas u r e the diam e t e r of a hum a n hair. A hair is used to sepa r a t e two micros c o p e slide s. A monoc h r o m a t i c bea m of light is reflect e d onto the two slides by the glass plate. The light is the n reflect e d from the two slides and tra n s m i t t e d throu g h the glass plat e and is viewed by the travelling micros c o p e . IB Questionbank Physics 919 (a) Stat e why the light reflect e d from the two micros c o p e slide s prod u c e s a syst e m of interfe r e n c e fringe s. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 920 (b) The condition that a brigh t fringe is obs e rv e d in the field of view of the travelling micros co p e is given by the relation s hi p 1 m λ 2 2t = whe r e t is the thickn e s s of the air film form e d by the wedg e at the point wher e the brigh t fringe is obse rv e d , m is an inte g e r and λ is the wavelen g t h of the incide n t light. 1 Stat e the reas o n for the factor 2 in the relation s hi p. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (c) In the diagr a m , the lengt h of the slides is 5.00 cm. The wavele n g t h of the monoc h r o m a t i c light is 5.92 × 10 –7 m. Using the travelling micros c o p e it is observ e d tha t 50 fringe s occupy a lengt h of 0.940 cm. Show that the diam e t e r of the hair use d to sepa r a t e the slide s is about 80 µm. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tota l 5 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 921 57 4 . This ques tion is abou t a Galilea n tra n sfor m a t i o n and time dilation. Ben is in a spac e s hi p that is travelling in a str ai g h t- line with const a n t spe e d v as meas u r e d by Jill who is in a spa c e station. Ben switch e s on a light puls e that bounc e s vertic ally (as obse rv e d by Ben) betw e e n two horizon t al mirror s M 1 and M 2 sepa r a t e d by a dista n c e d . At the insta n t that the mir ro r s are opposit e Jill, the pulse is just leaving the mirro r M 2 . The spee d of light in air is c . (a) On the diag r a m , sketc h the pat h of the light pulse betw e e n M 1 and M 2 as obse rv e d by Jill. (1) (b) The time for the puls e to travel from M 2 to M 1 as mea s u r e d by Jill is ∆t . (i) Stat e, accor di n g to Jill, the dista n c e move d by the spac e s hi p in time ∆t . ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 922 (ii) Using a Galilean tran sfo r m a t i o n, derive an expr e s s io n for the lengt h of the pat h of the light betw e e n M 2 and M 1 . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (c) Stat e, accor di n g to speci al rela tivity, the lengt h of the pat h of the light betw e e n M 2 and M 1 as me a s u r e d by Jill in ter m s of c and ∆t . ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (d) The time for the puls e to travel from M 2 to M 1 as mea s u r e d by Ben is ∆t ′. Use your answ e r s to (b)(i) and (c) to derive a rela tion s hi p betw e e n ∆t and ∆t ′. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (e) Accordi n g to a clock at res t with res p e c t to Jill, a clock in the space s hi p runs slow by a factor of 2.3. Show that the spe e d v of the space s hi p is 0.90c. ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 923 ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 924 (f) The lengt h of a table in the spac e s hi p is mea s u r e d by Ben to be 1.8 m. Calcula t e the lengt h of the table as mea s u r e d by Jill. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (g) The ques tion s (e) and (f) introd u c e the conc e p t s of time dilation and lengt h cont r a c t io n. Discus s how muon dec ay in the atmo s p h e r e provides expe ri m e n t a l evide n c e for the s e conc e p t s . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (5) (Tot al 16 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 925 57 5 . This ques tion is abou t pair prod u c tio n and rela tivistic mech a ni c s . A γ-photon of ener gy 2.46 MeV i s travelling close to the nucle u s of a gold atom. It conver t s into an elect r o n (e –)–positro n (e + ) pair. Each particle travels at 45° to the original direc tion of the photo n. Imme di a t ely after the conve r sio n, the kinetic ene r gi e s of the elect r o n and positr o n are equ al. The mag nit u d e of the recoil mom e n t u m of the gold nucle u s is 0.880 MeV c –1 and is in the direc tion of the photo n. (a) Calcula t e, imme di a t ely afte r the dec ay, the ma g nit u d e of the mom e n t u m of the elect r o n. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (4) IB Questionbank Physics 926 (b) Calcula t e the value V of the pote n ti al differ e n c e thro u g h which an elect r o n at rest must be accele r a t e d in orde r to have the sam e magni t u d e of mom e n t u m as tha t in (a). ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 6 mark s ) 57 6 . This ques tion is abou t gene r a l relativity. Bob is stan di n g on the floor of a spac e s hi p and he throw s a ball in a direction par allel to the floor. Betw e e n leaving Bob’s hand and landin g on the floor, the ball follows the path show n. (a) Stat e and explain whet h e r , from the path followe d by the ball, Bob can ded uc e that the space s hi p is at res t on the surfa c e of a plane t. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 927 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 928 (b) Outline how the concep t of spac e ti m e can be use d to explain the (i) traject o r y of the ball if the spa c e s hi p is at rest on the surfa c e of a plane t. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) natu r e of a black hole. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (c) Calcula t e the radius that Eart h would have to have in orde r for it to behave as a black hole. The mass of Eart h is 6.0 × 10 24 kg. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (Tota l 8 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 929 57 7 . This ques tion is abou t soun d inte nsi ty. (a) Define (i) inten si t y of sound . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) soun d inten sit y level . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (b) Stat e two ways by which the soun d pre s s u r e at the ear dru m is amplified befor e reac hi n g the cochle a r fluid. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (c) A stud e n t with a hea ri n g proble m can hea r sound s clea rly whe n the sound intensity level is 65 dB or high e r . In a large lectu r e hall, at a dista n c e of 25 m from the lectu r e r , the sound inte n si ty level is 55 dB. Deter m i n e the maxim u m dista n c e from the lectu r e r at which the stud e n t can hea r clearly. The inte n si ty of sound a dista n c e d from a P 2 sourc e of powe r P is given by I = 4πd . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 930 ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (4) (Tota l 8 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 931 57 8 . This ques tion is abou t X-rays. (a) Define half- value thickn e s s . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (b) The half- value thickn e s s in tiss ue for X-rays of a specific ene r gy is 3.50 mm. Deter m i n e the fraction of the incide n t inten sity of X-rays that has bee n tran s m i t t e d throu g h tiss ue of thickn e s s 6.00 mm. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (c) For X-rays of high e r ener gy tha n thos e in (b), the half- value thickn e s s is grea t e r than 3.50 mm. Stat e and explain the effect, if any, of this chan g e on your answ e r in (b). ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (d) X-ray imag e s are often blur r e d des pit e the patie n t re m a i ni n g IB Questionbank Physics 932 station a r y during expos u r e . (i) Stat e on e possible physic al mec h a ni s m for the blur rin g of an Xray imag e. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 933 (ii) For the physical mec h a ni s m stat e d in (d)(i) sugg e s t how X-ray imag es can be mad e mor e distinc t. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (e) The expos u r e time of photo g r a p h i c film to X-rays is longe r than that for visible light. The expos u r e time for X-rays may be red uc e d with the use of enh a n c e m e n t tech ni q u e s , such as that of an inte nsifying scre e n. Outline how an intensifying scr e e n redu c e s the expos u r e time. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tot al 11 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 934 57 9 . This ques tion is abou t laser s in medicin e. In a proce d u r e called pulse oxime t ry, lase r s are use d to mea s u r e the perc e n t a g e of oxygen in the blood. Outline how laser s are use d in this proce d u r e . ......................................................................................................................... ........................ ......................................................................................................................... ........................ ......................................................................................................................... ........................ ......................................................................................................................... ........................ ......................................................................................................................... ........................ ......................................................................................................................... ........................ (Tota l 3 mark s ) 58 0 . This ques tion is abou t dosim et r y. (a) Disting ui s h betw e e n the ter m s abso r b e d dos e and dos e equivale n t. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) A bet a sour c e is inject e d into a tum ou r in a patie n t . The following dat a are availabl e. Mass of tumo u r = 65 g Activity of sour c e = 4.8 × 10 8 Bq Averag e ene r gy of emitt e d elect r o n s MeV IB Questionbank Physics = 1.2 935 Quality factor of bet a radia tion IB Questionbank Physics = 1.0 936 (i) Dete r mi n e the dose equivale n t over a period of fiftee n minut e s after the beta sour c e is inject e d into the tumo u r . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (4) (ii) Stat e on e reas o n why the dose equivale n t det e r m i n e d in (b)(i) is only appr oxi m a t e . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (iii) Stat e on e reas o n why patie n t s might be willing to subjec t them s elve s to such a conside r a b l e amou n t of radia tio n as det e r m i n e d in (b)(i). ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (Tota l 8 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 937 58 1 . This ques tion is abou t lepton s and meson s . (a) Lepto n s are a class of elem e n t a r y particle s and eac h lepton has its own antip a r ti cl e. Stat e wha t is mea n t by an (i) elem e n t a r y particle. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) antip a r t i cl e of a lepton. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (b) The elect r o n is a lepton and its antip a r t i cl e is the positro n. The following reaction can take plac e betw e e n an elect r o n and positro n. e– + e+ → γ + γ Sket ch the Feyn m a n diagr a m for this reac tion and identify on your diagr a m any virtual particl e s. (3) (c) Unlike lepton s , the π + meso n is not an elem e n t a r y particle. Sta t e the (i) quar k s truct u r e of the π + meso n. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 938 (ii) reas o n why the following rea c tio n does not occur. ρ+ + ρ+ → ρ+ + π + ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 939 (d) Stat e the Pauli exclusion principle. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (e) Explain, with refer e n c e to your ans w e r to (d), why qua r k s are assig n e d the prope r t y of colour. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (f) The pion was sugg e s t e d to be the media ti n g particle of the stron g inter a c ti o n betw e e n nucleon s . Given that the rang e of the stron g nuclea r inter a c tio n betw e e n nucleo n s is about 10 –15 m, show tha t the rest mas s of the pion is about 100 MeV c –2 . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tot al 13 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 940 IB Questionbank Physics 941 58 2 . This ques tion is abou t particle acc el e r a t o r s . (a) The diagr a m (not to scale) rep r e s e n t s a view from above of the esse n ti al featu r e s of a cyclotr o n. The positive par ticles emitt e d by the sour c e , travel in an anticlock wis e directio n arou n d the Ds. (i) Stat e the direction of the mag n e ti c field tha t is use d in this cyclot ro n. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) On the diagr a m , draw the pat h of a positive particle betw e e n the sour c e and the det ec t o r . (1) IB Questionbank Physics 942 (iii) Explain why an alter n a ti n g pote n ti al of a partic ul a r frequ e n c y is applied to the Ds as show n. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (b) Outline why much highe r ene r gi e s can be achieve d in a synch r o t r o n than in a cyclotr o n. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (c) In a particul a r expe ri m e n t , proton s in a synch r o t r o n are accel e r a t e d to an ene r gy of 2.0 GeV. Calcula t e the kinetic ene r gy of the proton s in GeV. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 943 (d) In the Large Had r o n Collider , proto n s can be accel e r a t e d to ene r gi e s of 7 TeV. Deduc e whet h e r this value of ene r gy is sufficie nt to mimic the tem p e r a t u r e of the unive r s e , 10 32 K, shor tly afte r the Big Bang. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tot al 12 mark s ) 58 3 . This ques tion is abou t the stan d a r d model. (a) Stat e what is mea n t by the sta n d a r d model. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (b) Use the cons e r v a ti o n of lepton num b e r and cha r g e to dedu c e the nat u r e of the par ticle x in the following rea c tion. νe + μ– → e – + x ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 944 (c) Stat e what is mea n t by dee p inelas tic scatt e r i n g. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 945 (d) Outline how deep inelas tic scat t e ri n g expe ri m e n t s provide evide n c e for asym p t o ti c freedo m . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tota l 5 mark s ) 58 4 . A volum e is mea s u r e d to be 52 mm 3 . This volum e in m 3 is A. 5.2 × 10 3 m 3 . B. 5.2 × 10 1 m 3 . C. 5.2 × 10 –1 m 3 . D. 5.2 × 10 –8 m 3 . (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 946 58 5 . The mas s e s and weight s of differ e n t object s are inde p e n d e n t ly me a s u r e d . The gra p h is a plot of weight vers u s mas s that includ e s erro r bars. These experi m e n t al res ult s sugg e s t tha t the A. mea s u r e m e n t s show a significa n t syste m a t i c erro r but small ran do m erro r. B. mea s u r e m e n t s show a significa n t rand o m erro r but small syste m a t i c erro r. C. mea s u r e m e n t s are preci s e but not acc u r a t e . D. weight of an object is propo r ti o n al to its mas s. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 58 6 . A skydive r jumpe d out of an airpla n e . On reac hi n g a ter mi n a l spe e d of 60 m s –1 , she open e d her par a c h u t e . Which of the following desc ri b e s her motion after openin g her par a c h u t e ? A. She went upwa r d s for a shor t time, befor e falling to Eart h at a spe e d of 60 m s –1 . B. She contin u e d downw a r d s at 60 m s –1 , but hit the grou n d with less force. C. She contin u e d to fall but reac h e d a new ter mi n al spe e d of less than 60 m s –1 . D. She went upwa r d s for a shor t time, befor e falling to Eart h at a spe e d of less than 60 m s –1 . (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 947 58 7 . The gra p h is a spee d vers u s time gra p h for an objec t tha t is moving in a str ai g h t line. The dista n c e travelled by the objec t durin g the first 4.0 secon d s is A. 80 m. B. 40 m. C. 20 m. D. 5 m. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 948 58 8 . The diagr a m shows a girl att e m p ti n g (but failing) to lift a heavy suitc a s e of weigh t W. The mag ni t u d e of the vertic al upw a r d s pull of the girl on the suitca s e is P and the mag nit u d e of the vertic al reac tio n of the floor on the suitca s e is R . Which equa tio n corr e c tly relat e s W , P and R ? A. W = P+ R B. W > P+ R C. W < P+ R D. W = P= R (Tot al 1 mar k ) 58 9 . Objects A and B collide toget h e r . They end up joined toge t h e r and station a r y. During the collision, a force + F is exert e d on object A by objec t B. Accor din g to New to n’s third law, the r e will also be a force of A. –F acting on object B . B. –F acting on object A . C. + F acting on object B . D. + F acting on object A . (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 949 59 0 . A lift (elevato r ) is oper a t e d by an elect ric motor. It moves betw e e n the 10th floor and the 2nd floor at a const a n t spee d. One main ene r gy tran sfor m a t i o n during this journ e y is A. gravit atio n al poten ti al ene r gy → kinetic ene r gy. B. elect ric al ener gy → kinetic ene r gy. C. kinetic ener gy → ther m a l ene r gy. D. elect ric al ener gy → ther m a l ene r gy. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 59 1 . A com m u ni c a ti o n s satellit e is moving at a cons t a n t spee d in a circul a r orbit arou n d Eart h. At any given insta n t in time, the res ult a n t force on the satellite is A. zero. B. equal to the gravit a tion al force on the satellit e. C. equal to the vector sum of the gravit a tio n a l force on the satellite and the cent ri p e t a l force. D. equal to the force exer t e d by the sat ellite’s rocke t s . (Tot al 1 mar k ) 59 2 . A tem p e r a t u r e of 23 K is equival e n t to a tem p e r a t u r e of A. –300 °C. B. –250 °C. C. +2 5 0 °C. D. +3 0 0 °C. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 950 59 3 . The ratio t h e r m acla p a c itoyf a s a m p leo f c op p e r s p e c ifich e a tc a p a c itof y copp e r A. does not have any unit. B. has unit J kg –1 K–1 . C. has unit J kg –1 . D. has unit kg. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 59 4 . In the kinetic model of an ideal gas, it is assu m e d tha t A. the forces betw e e n the molec ul e s of the gas and the cont ai n e r are always zero. B. the inter m ol e c ul a r pot en ti al ene r gy of the molec ul e s of the gas is const a n t . C. the kinetic ener gy of a given molec ul e of the gas is const a n t . D. the mom e n t u m of a given molec ul e of the gas is const a n t . (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 951 59 5 . Which gra p h corr e c tly shows how the accele r a ti o n, a of a particl e unde r g oi n g SHM varies with its displac e m e n t , x from its equilibriu m position? (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 952 59 6 . A mas s on the end of a horizon t al sprin g is displa c e d from its equilibri u m position by a dista n c e A and rele a s e d . Its subs e q u e n t oscillation s have total ene r gy E and time period T. An identical mas s is attac h e d to an identic al sprin g. The maxim u m displac e m e n t is 2 A . Assumin g this sprin g obeys Hooke’s law, which of the following gives the corr ec t time period and total ene r gy? New ti m e peri o d New en e r g y A. T 4E B. T 2E C. 2T 4E D. 2T 2E (Tot al 1 mar k ) 59 7 . In which of the following regions of the elect r o m a g n e t i c spec t r u m is radi ation of wavele n g t h 600 nm locat e d ? A. microw av e s B. radio waves C. visible light D. X-rays (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 953 59 8 . What is the best esti m a t e for the refra c tiv e index of a mediu m in which light travels at a spee d of 2.7 × 10 8 m s –1 ? A. 0.9 B. 1.0 C. 1.1 D. 2.7 (Tot al 1 mar k ) 59 9 . Two rect a n g ul a r blocks, X and Y, of the sa m e mat e ri al have differ e n t dime n sio n s but the sam e over all resist a n c e . Which of the following equ a tio n s is corr ec t ? A. resistivity of X × lengt h of X = resistivity of Y × lengt h of Y B. le n g t hof X le n g t ho f Y c r os s e c t io n a lr e ao f X c r o s s e c t io n a lr e ao f Y C. D. resistivity of X × cross section a l are a of X = resistivity of Y × cross section al area of Y le n g t hof X le n g t hof Y c r os s e c t io n a lr e ao f Y c r o s ss e c t io n a lr e ao f X (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 954 60 0 . Two 6 Ω resis to r s are conn e c t e d in serie s with a 6 V cell. A stud e n t inc orr e c t l y conne c t s an am m e t e r and a voltm e t e r as show n below. The readi n g s on the am m e t e r and on the voltm e t e r are Am m e t e r readi n g / A Volt m e t e r read i n g / V A. 0.0 0.0 B. 0.0 6.0 C. 1.0 0.0 D. 1.0 6.0 (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 955 60 1 . The diagr a m shows a pote n ti al divide r circuit. In orde r to incre a s e the readi n g on the voltm e t e r the A. tem p e r a t u r e of R should be incr e a s e d . B. tem p e r a t u r e of R should be decr e a s e d . C. light intensity on R should be incr e a s e d . D. light intensity on R should be decr e a s e d . (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 956 60 2 . The mas s of Eart h is M E , its radius is R E and the mag nit u d e of the gravit a tion al field stre n g t h at the surfa c e of Eart h is g . The univer s a l g gravit a tion al cons t a n t is G. The ratio G is equal to ME A. R E2 B. R E2 ME C. M ER E D. 1 (Tot al 1 mar k ) 60 3 . Which diagr a m best repr e s e n t s the elect ric field due to a nega tively char g e d cond u c ti n g sphe r e ? (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 957 60 4 . A point mas s carrie s a positive cha r g e + Q and is at rest in a ma gn e t i c field. The field is in the direction show n. The mag n e t i c force acting on the cha r g e is A. from left to right in the plan e of the page . B. from top to botto m in the plan e of the page . C. into the plane of the pag e. D. zero. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 60 5 . The num b e r of neut r o n s and the num b e r of proto n s in a nucle u s of an atom 235 of the isotop e of urani u m 9 2 U are Ne u t r o n s Prot o n s A. 92 143 B. 143 92 C. 235 92 D. 92 235 (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 958 60 6 . A sam pl e cont ai n s an amou n t of radioa c tive mat e ri a l with a half- life of 3.5 days. After 2 weeks the fraction of the radioa c tiv e mat e ri al rem ai ni n g is A. 94 %. B. 25 %. C. 6 %. D. 0 %. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 60 7 . The rest mas s of a proto n is 938 MeV c –2 . The ene r gy of a proton at res t is A. 9.38 J. B. 9.38 × 10 8 × (3 ×1 0 8 ) 2 J. C. 9.38 × 10 8 eV. D. 9.38 × 10 8 × (3 × 10 8 ) 2 eV. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 60 8 . The efficiency of a mode r n natu r a l gas powe r station is appr oxi m a t e l y A. 10 %. B. 50 %. C. 5 %. D. 90 %. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 959 y @60 9 . The ene r gy sourc e that cur r e n tly provide s the gre a t e s t propo r tio n of the world’s total ener gy dem a n d is A. coal. B. oil. C. nat u r al gas. D. urani u m . (Tot al 1 mar k ) 61 0 . In a nuclea r powe r station, ura ni u m is use d as the ene r gy sour c e and plutoni u m- 239 is produ c e d . Which of the following is true? A. Plutoni u m- 239 is produ c e d by nucle a r fusion. B. A mode r a t o r is used to abso r b plutoni u m- 239. C. Cont r ol rods are used to slow down pluto ni u m- 239. D. Plutoni u m- 239 can be use d as a fuel in anot h e r type of nucle a r reac t o r . (Tot al 1 mar k ) 61 1 . One dis a d v a n t a g e of using photovolt aic cells to powe r a dom e s tic wat e r heat e r is that A. solar ene r gy is a ren e w a b l e sourc e of ene r gy. B. the powe r radiat e d by the Sun varies significa n tly depe n di n g on the weat h e r . C. a large are a of photovolt aic cells would be nee d e d . D. photovolt aic cells cont ai n CFCs, which cont ri b u t e to the gre e n h o u s e effect. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 960 61 2 . Gree n h o u s e gas es A. reflect infrar e d radiation but absor b ultr aviole t radia tion. B. reflect ultr aviolet radia tio n but absor b infra r e d radia tion. C. tran s m i t infra r e d radiation but absor b ultraviole t radia tion. D. tran s m i t ultr aviolet radiation but absor b infra r e d radia tion. (Tot al 1 mar k ) 61 3 . The rat e of global war mi n g might be redu c e d by A. replaci n g the use of coal and oil with nat u r a l gas. B. a redu c tio n in the Eart h’s albe do. C. a redu c tio n in car bo n fixation. D. an incr e a s e in defor e s t a t io n. (Tot al 1 mar k ) IB Questionbank Physics 961 61 4 . This ques tion is abou t elect ri ca l resist a n c e of the met al mer c u r y. The resist a n c e R of a sam pl e of me rc u r y was mea s u r e d as a function of the tem p e r a t u r e T of the sam pl e. The sam pl e was cooled and dat a points wer e take n at tem p e r a t u r e interval s of 0.2 K. The unc e r t a i n ti e s in R and T are too small to be show n on the gra p h. The hypot h e s i s is that resist a n c e is propo r tio n a l to absolut e tem p e r a t u r e for tem p e r a t u r e s grea t e r than 4.5 K. (a) (i) Sugg e s t whet h e r the dat a suppo r t s the hypot h e s i s . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Draw a line of best fit throu g h the dat a. (2) (b) Stat e the value of R for which the rat e of cha n g e of resist a n c e of the sam pl e with tem p e r a t u r e is least. ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 962 (c) At a tem p e r a t u r e T C the resist a n c e sudd e nly beco m e s zero. (i) Use the grap h to dete r m i n e the possibl e rang e of the tem p e r a t u r e T C . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Stat e, to the corr e c t num b e r of signific a n t figur e s , the value of T C and its unce r t ai n t y. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (iii) Outline how the tem p e r a t u r e T C could be me a s u r e d more precis ely. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (d) Outline two reas o n s why you could not use the dat a to det e r m i n e an accu r a t e value for R at room tem p e r a t u r e . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 963 ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tot al 10 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 964 61 5 . This ques tion is abou t impuls e. (a) A net force of magni t u d e F acts on a body. Define the impuls e I of the force. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (b) A ball of mas s 0.075 0 kg is travelling horizont a lly with a spe e d of 2.20 m s –1 . It strike s a vertical wall and rebo u n d s horizon t ally. Due to the collision with the wall, 20 % of the ball’s initial kinetic ener gy is dissip a t e d . (i) Show that the ball rebou n d s from the wall with a spee d of 1.97 m s –1 . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) Show that the impuls e given to the ball by the wall is 0.313 N s. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 965 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 966 (c) The ball strikes the wall at time t = 0 and leave s the wall at time t = T . The sketc h gra p h shows how the forc e F that the wall exert s on the ball is assu m e d to vary with time t . The time T is meas u r e d elect r o ni c ally to equ al 0.089 4 s. Use the impuls e given in (b)(ii) to estim a t e the aver a g e value of F. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (4) (Tota l 9 mark s ) 61 6 . This ques tion is abou t ener gy tra n sf e r s . (a) Ener gy degr a d a t i o n takes plac e in the ene r gy tra n sfo r m a t i o n s which occur in the gene r a t i o n of elect ric al powe r. Explain wha t is mea n t in this context by ener gy degr a d a t i o n . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 967 ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 968 Som e of the ene r gy tran sfo r m a t i o n s that take plac e in a coal- fired powe r station are repr e s e n t e d by the Sank ey diag r a m below. (b) (i) Stat e what is repr e s e n t e d by the width w . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) At the thre e places ma rk e d A, B and C on the diagr a m , ene r gy is degr a d e d . Identify the proce s s by which the ene r gy is degr a d e d in eac h of the places. A: ..................................................................................................... ................. ......................................................................................................... .................. B: ..................................................................................................... ................. ......................................................................................................... .................. C: ..................................................................................................... ................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (Tota l 6 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 969 IB Questionbank Physics 970 61 7 . This ques tion is abou t gree n h o u s e effect (a) The grap h shows part of the absor p ti o n spec t r u m of nitrog e n oxide (N 2 O) in which the intensity of absor b e d radia tio n A is plott e d agains t frequ e n c y f. (i) Stat e the region of the elect r o m a g n e t i c spec t r u m to which the reson a n t frequ e n cy of nitrog e n oxide belong s. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Using your ans w e r to (a)(i), explain why nitrog e n oxide is classified as a gree n h o u s e gas. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... IB Questionbank Physics 971 .................. (2) IB Questionbank Physics 972 (b) Define emis si vit y and albedo . Emissivity: ............................................................................................... .................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... Albedo: .................................................................................................... .................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (c) The diagr a m shows a simple ene r gy bala nc e climat e model in which the atmo s p h e r e and the surfa c e of Eart h are two bodie s eac h at const a n t tem p e r a t u r e . The surfa c e of the Eart h rec eive s both solar radiatio n and radiation emitt e d from the atmo s p h e r e . Assum e tha t the Eart h’s surfac e beh av e s as a black body. The following data are availa ble for this model. aver a g e tem p e r a t u r e of the atmo s p h e r e of Eart h emissivity, e of the atmos p h e r e of Eart h aver a g e albed o, α of the atm os p h e r e of Eart h solar inten sity at top of atmo s p h e r e m –2 aver a g e tem p e r a t u r e of the surfa c e of Eart h IB Questionbank Physics = = = = 242 K 0.720 0.280 344 W = 288 K 973 Use the data to show that the (i) powe r radia t e d per unit are a of the atmo s p h e r e is 140 W m –2 . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) solar powe r absor b e d per unit are a at the surfa c e of the Eart h is 248 W m –2 . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (d) It is hypot h e s iz e d that, if the produ c tio n of gre e n h o u s e gas e s wer e to stay at its pres e n t level the n the tem p e r a t u r e of the Ear t h’s atmo s p h e r e would event u a lly rise by 6.0 K. Calcula t e the powe r per unit are a that would then be (i) radi at e d by the atmos p h e r e . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) abso r b e d by the Eart h’s surfa c e . ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 974 ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 975 (e) Estim a t e , using your ans w e r to (d)(ii), the incr e a s e in tem p e r a t u r e of Eart h’s surfac e. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tot al 14 mark s ) 61 8 . This ques tion is abou t motion of a ball falling in oil. (a) Disting ui s h betw e e n aver a g e spee d and insta n t a n e o u s spe e d. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 976 (b) A small steel ball of mass M is dropp e d from rest into a long vertic al tube that cont ain s oil. The sketc h gra p h shows how the spe e d v of the ball varies with time t . Explain how you would use the gra p h to find the aver a g e spe e d of the ball betw e e n t = 0 and t = t 1 . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (c) The gradi e n t of the grap h at t = t 1 is k . Deduc e an expr e s s io n in ter m s of k , M and g , the accel e r a t io n of free fall, for the ma g nit u d e of the friction al force F acting on the ball at t = t 1 . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 977 ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 978 (d) Stat e and explain the mag nit u d e of the friction al force acting on the ball at t = t 2 . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (Tot al 11 mark s ) 61 9 . This ques tion is abou t simple har m o ni c motion and wave s. (a) A particle of mas s m that is att a c h e d to a light spring is execu ti n g simple har m o ni c motion in a hori z o n t a l dire c t i o n . Stat e the condition relati n g to the net force acting on the particle that is neces s a r y for it to execut e simple har m o ni c motion. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 979 (b) The grap h shows how the kine tic ene r gy E K of the par ticle in (a) varies with the displac e m e n t x of the par ticle from equilibri u m . (i) Using the axes above, sket c h a gra p h to show how the pote n ti al ene r gy of the particle varie s with the displa c e m e n t x . (2) (ii) The mas s of the par ticle is 0.30 kg. Use dat a from the gra p h to show that the frequ e n c y f of oscillation of the par ticle is 2.0 Hz. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (4) IB Questionbank Physics 980 (c) The par ticles of a mediu m M 1 throu g h which a tra n sv e r s e wave is travelling, oscillat e with the sam e frequ e n c y and amplit u d e as that of the par ticle in (b). (i) Describ e, with refer e n c e to the prop a g a t i o n of ene r gy thro u g h the mediu m , what is me a n t by a tran s v e r s e wave. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) The spee d of the wave is 0.80 m s –1 . Calcula t e the wavele n g t h of the wave. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (d) The diagr a m shows wavefro n t s of the waves in (c) incide n t on a boun d a r y XY betw e e n mediu m M 1 and anot h e r mediu m M 2 . IB Questionbank Physics 981 The angle betw e e n the nor m a l, and the dire c tion of travel of the wavefro n t s is 30°. IB Questionbank Physics 982 (i) The spee d of the wave in M 1 is 0.80 m s –1 . The spe e d of the waves in M 2 is 1.2 m s –1 . Calculat e the angle betw e e n the dire c tion of travel of the wavefro n t s in M 2 and the nor m al. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (ii) On the diagr a m , sket c h the wavefro n t s in M 2 . (1) (Tot al 15 mark s ) 62 0 . This ques tion is abou t decay of radiu m- 226. (a) A nucleu s of the isotop e radiu m- 226 (Ra) unde r g o e s α-dec ay with a half- life of 1.6 × 10 3 yr to form a nucle u s of rado n (Rn). Define the ter m s isotop e and half- life . Isotop e: ................................................................................................... ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... Halflife: .................................................................................................. .................... ................................................................................................................. IB Questionbank Physics 983 ..................... (2) IB Questionbank Physics 984 (b) Using the grid below, sketc h a gra p h to show how the activity A of a sam pl e of radiu m- 226 (Ra) would be expe c t e d to vary with time t over a period of about 5.0 × 10 3 yr. The activity of the sam pl e at time t = 0 is A 0 . (3) (c) The nucle a r reaction equa tio n for the dec ay of radiu m- 226 (Ra) may be writt e n as 226 8 8 Ra (i) Rn α Stat e the value of the proto n num b e r and neut r o n num b e r of the isotop e of rado n (Rn). Proto n num b e r : .................................................................................. ............... Neut r o n num b e r : .................................................................................. ............. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 985 (ii) Outline why the binding ene r gy of Ra is less tha n that of Rn. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (d) The following data are availa ble. mas s of Ra mas s of Rn mas s of α = 226.02 5 4 u = 222.01 7 5 u = 4.002 6 u Show that the ene r gy rele a s e d in the decay of a Ra nucle u s is 4.94 MeV. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (Tot al 10 mark s ) 62 1 . This ques tion is abou t inter n al ene r gy, hea t and ideal gas e s . (a) The inter n al ene r gy of a piec e of coppe r is incr e a s e d by hea tin g. (i) Explain what is mea n t, in this cont ext, by inte r n a l ene r gy and heati n g. Inte r n al ener gy: .................................................................................... ............. IB Questionbank Physics 986 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. Heatin g: .......................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (ii) The piece of copp e r has mass 0.25 kg. The incre a s e in inte r n a l ene r gy of the coppe r is 1.2 × 10 3 J and its incr e a s e in tem p e r a t u r e is 20 K. Estim a t e the specific heat capa city of coppe r . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (b) An ideal gas is kept in a cylinde r by a piston tha t is free to move. The gas is heat e d such that its inte r n a l ene r gy incr e a s e s and the pres s u r e rem ai n s const a n t . Use the molec ul a r model of ideal gase s to explain (i) the incr e a s e in inter n a l ene r gy. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) how the pres s u r e rem ai n s cons t a n t . ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 987 ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (Tota l 9 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 988 62 2 . This ques tion is abou t elect ri c fields and elect ri c circuits. (a) Two par allel, char g e d met al plate s A and B are in a vacuu m . At a par ticul a r insta n t an elect r o n is at point P. On the diag r a m , draw (i) the elect ric field patt e r n due to the plate s . (3) (ii) an arrow to repr e s e n t the dire c tion of the force on the elect r o n at P. (1) (b) The accele r a ti o n of the elect r o n at P is 8.8 × 10 14 m s –2 . Dete r m i n e the mag nit u d e of the elect ric field str e n g t h at the point P. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (c) The elect ric pote n ti al ener gy of the elect r o n cha n g e s by 1.9 × 10 –17 J as it moves from one plat e to the othe r. Show tha t the pote n ti al IB Questionbank Physics 989 differ e n c e betw e e n the plate s is 120 V. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (d) A resis to r R and a filam e n t lamp L are conne c t e d in serie s with a batt e r y. The batt e r y has an emf of 12 V and inte r n a l resis t a n c e 4.0 Ω. The poten t i al differ e n c e acros s the filam e n t of the lamp is 3.0 V and the cur r e n t in the filam e n t is 0.25 A. (i) Define emf and desc ri b e the conc e p t of inte r n a l resis t a n c e . emf: ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. Inte r n al resist a n c e : ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (ii) Calculat e the total powe r supplie d by the batt e r y. ......................................................................................................... IB Questionbank Physics 990 .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 991 (iii) Calculat e the powe r dissip a t e d in the exte r n a l circuit. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (iv) Dete r mi n e the resist a n c e of the resisto r R. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (Tot al 16 mark s ) 62 3 . This ques tion is abou t vision and resolution. (a) Comp a r e scotopic with photopic vision. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... IB Questionbank Physics 992 (2) IB Questionbank Physics 993 (b) The grap h shows the variation with wavele n g t h λ of the sensitivity I, of the rod and the cone cells of a hum a n eye. A red piece of pape r and a blue piece of pape r are both viewe d in very low inten si ty light. Each piece of pap e r reflec t s the sam e inte nsi ty of light. With refer e n c e to the grap h, sta t e and explain which one of the two pieces of pap e r will be mor e clearly visible. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) IB Questionbank Physics 994 (c) The diam e t e r of the pupil of a hum a n eye is 1.5 mm. (i) Calculat e the minim u m angul a r sepa r a ti o n of two point s tha t can be resolved by the hum a n eye for light of wavele n g t h 680 nm. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Two star s , the sam e dista n c e from Eart h, are sepa r a t e d by a dist a n c e of 4.0 × 10 13 m. Both star s emit light of wavele n g t h 680 nm. The two star s are just resolve d by an obse rv e r on Eart h. Estim a t e the dista n c e to the two sta r s . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tota l 8 mark s ) 62 4 . This ques tion is abou t polarizatio n. (a) Stat e what is mea n t by polariz e d light. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) IB Questionbank Physics 995 (b) A ray of light is inciden t on the surfac e of a lake. The angle of inciden c e is φ. The reflect e d light is comple t e ly polariz e d horizont a lly. The refra ctive index of wate r is n . (i) On the diagr a m above draw the refr a c t e d ray. (1) (ii) Use the diagr a m to deduc e the relation s hi p betw e e n φ and n . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (iii) The refr ac tive index of the wat e r is 1.3. Calcula t e the value of φ. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 996 (1) (Tota l 6 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 997 62 5 . This ques tion is abou t the Dopple r effect. (a) Stat e what is mea n t by the Dopple r effect. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (2) (b) Ultra s o u n d of frequ e n c y 5.2 MHz is direc t e d from a station a r y sourc e towar d s red blood cells in an art e r y. A simplified diag r a m is show n below in which the blood cells are travelling in the sam e direc tion. The ultr a s o u n d is reflect e d from the cells and is rec eive d back at the sourc e. The meas u r e d frequ e n cy shift is 3.5 kHz. The spe e d of ultr a s o u n d in blood is Δf 2v c . c = 1.5 × 10 3 m s –1 . The freq u e n c y shift is det e r m i n e d from f (i) Stat e the significan c e of the factor of 2 in the form ul a for the frequ e n c y shift. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) (ii) Dete r mi n e the spee d of the red blood cells. ......................................................................................................... .................. IB Questionbank Physics 998 ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 999 (iii) Stat e two reas o n s why, in prac tic e, the frequ e n c y shift will have a rang e of values. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (Tota l 6 mark s ) 62 6 . This ques tion is abou t the photo el e c t r i c effect. (a) In the photo el ec t r i c effect, elect r o n s are emitt e d from a met allic surfac e only if the wavele n g t h of the light incide n t on the surfa c e is below a cert ai n value called the thr e s h ol d wavele n g t h . Explain this obse rv a tio n. ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (3) (b) A monoch r o m a t i c sour c e of powe r 3.0 W emits light of wavele n g t h 4.60 × 10 –7 m. All of the light is incide n t on a met al surfa c e and caus e s elect r o n s to be emitt e d at a rat e of 4.0 × 10 10 s –1 . The thre s h ol d wavele n g t h of the met al is 5.50 × 10 –7 m. Calcula t e the IB Questionbank Physics 1000 (i) photo el e c t r i c cur r e n t . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (1) IB Questionbank Physics 1001 (ii) work function of the met al. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (2) (iii) the ratio of the rate of elect r o n emission to the rat e at which the photo n s are incide n t on the met al. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. (3) (c) Light from a differ e n t sour c e is incide n t on the met al in (b). The new sourc e has power 6.0 W and emits light of wavele n g t h 9.00 × 10 –7 m. Stat e the effect of thes e cha n g e s , if any, on your ans w e r to (b)(i). ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (Tot al 10 mark s ) IB Questionbank Physics 1002 62 7 . This ques tion is abou t qua n t u m aspe c t s of the elect r o n . The gra p h shows the variation with dist a n c e x of the wavefu n c tio n Ψ of an elect r o n at a par tic ul a r inst a n t of time. The elect r o n is confine d within a region of lengt h 2.0 × 10 –10 m. (a) Stat e what is mea n t by the wavefun c tio n of an elec t r o n . ................................................................................................................. ..................... ................................................................................................................. ..................... (1) (b) Using data from the grap h esti m a t e , for this elect r o n , (i) its mom e n t u m . ......................................................................................................... .................. ......................................................................................................... .................. .........................................................................................................